Contents

Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual PDF

1 of 706
1 of 706

Summary of Content for Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual PDF

GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Utility)

-GT27 model -GT25 model -GT25 open frame model -GT25 wide model -GT25 rugged model -GT23 model -GT21 model -GT21 wide model -Handy GOT

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS (Be sure to read these instructions before using this product.) Before using this product, please read this manual and the relevant manuals introduced in this manual carefully and pay full attention to safety to handle the product correctly. The precautions given in this manual are concerned with this product. In this manual, the safety precautions are ranked as "WARNING" and "CAUTION".

Note that the caution level may lead to a serious accident according to the circumstances. Always follow the instructions of both levels because they are important to personal safety. Please save this manual to make it accessible when required and always forward it to the end user.

[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]

WARNING Some failures of the GOT, communication unit or cable may keep the outputs on or off.

Some failures of a touch panel may cause malfunction of the input objects such as a touch switch. An external monitoring circuit should be provided to check for output signals which may lead to a serious accident. Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.

Do not use the GOT as the warning device that may cause a serious accident. An independent and redundant hardware or mechanical interlock is required to configure the device that displays and outputs serious warning. Failure to observe this instruction may result in an accident due to incorrect output or malfunction.

When the GOT backlight has a failure, the GOT status will be as follows. Failure to observe this instruction may result in an accident due to incorrect output or malfunction. [GT27, GT25, GT23] The POWER LED blinks (orange/blue), the display section dims, and inputs by a touch switch are disabled. [GT2105-Q] The POWER LED blinks (orange/blue), and the display section dims. However, inputs by a touch switch are still available. [GT2107-W, GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] The display section dims. However, inputs by a touch switch are still available. Even if the display section dims, inputs by a touch switch may still be available. This may cause an unintended operation of the touch switch. For example, if an operator assumes that the display section has dimmed because of the screen save function and touches the display section to cancel the screen save, a touch switch may be activated. The GOT backlight failure can be checked with a system signal of the GOT. (This system signal is not available on GT2107-W, GT2104-R, GT2104-P, and GT2103-P.)

WARNING

CAUTION

Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous conditions, resulting in death or severe injury.

Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous conditions, resulting in minor or moderate injury or property damage.

1

2

[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]

WARNING The display section of the GOT is an analog-resistive type touch panel.

When multiple points of the display section are touched simultaneously, an accident may occur due to incorrect output or malfunction. [GT27] Do not touch three points or more simultaneously on the display section. Doing so may cause an accident due to an incorrect output or malfunction. [GT25,GT23,GT21] Do not touch two points or more simultaneously on the display section. Doing so may cause a touch switch near the touched points to operate unexpectedly, or may cause an accident due to an incorrect output or malfunction.

When programs or parameters of the controller (such as a PLC) that is monitored by the GOT are changed, be sure to reset the GOT, or turn on the unit again after shutting off the power as soon as possible. Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.

If a communication fault (including cable disconnection) occurs during monitoring on the GOT, communication between the GOT and PLC CPU is suspended and the GOT becomes inoperative. For bus connection (GT27 and GT25 only): The GOT becomes inoperative. Power on the PLC CPU again to reestablish communication. For other than bus connection: The GOT becomes inoperative. A system where the GOT is used should be configured to perform any significant operation to the system by using the switches of a device other than the GOT on the assumption that a GOT communication fault will occur. Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.

To maintain the security (confidentiality, integrity, and availability) of the GOT and the system against unauthorized access, DoS*1 attacks, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks from unreliable networks and devices via network, take appropriate measures such as firewalls, virtual private networks (VPNs), and antivirus solutions. Mitsubishi Electric shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving GOT trouble and system trouble by unauthorized access, DoS attacks, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. *1 DoS: A denial-of-service (DoS) attack disrupts services by overloading systems or exploiting vulnerabilities, resulting in a denial-of-service (DoS) state.

[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]

[MOUNTING PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION Do not bundle the control and communication cables with main-circuit, power or other wiring.

Run the above cables separately from such wiring and keep them a minimum of 100mm apart. Not doing so noise can cause a malfunction.

Do not press the GOT display section with a pointed material as a pen or driver. Doing so can result in a damage or failure of the display section.

When the GOT connects to an Ethernet network, the IP address setting is restricted according to the system configuration. [GT27, GT25, GT23] When a GOT2000 series model and a GOT1000 series model are on an Ethernet network, do not set the IP address 192.168.0.18 for the GOTs and the controllers on this network. Doing so can cause IP address duplication at the GOT startup, adversely affecting the communication of the device with the IP address 192.168.0.18. The operation at the IP address duplication depends on the devices and the system. [GT21] When multiple GOTs are connected to the Ethernet network, do not set the IP address (192.168.3.18) for the GOTs and the controllers in the network. When one GOT is connected to the Ethernet network, do not set the IP address (192.168.3.18) for the controllers other than the GOT in the network. Doing so can cause IP address duplication at the GOT startup, adversely affecting the communication of the device with the IP address 192.168.3.18. The operation at the IP address duplication depends on the devices and the system.

When using the Ethernet interfaces, set an IP address for each interface to access a different network. Turn on the controllers and the network devices to be ready for communication before they communicate with the GOT. Failure to do so can cause a communication error on the GOT.

When the GOT is subject to shock or vibration, or some colors appear on the screen of the GOT, the screen of the GOT might flicker.

WARNING Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before mounting or

removing the GOT main unit to/from the panel. Not doing so can cause the unit to fail or malfunction.

Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before mounting or removing the option unit onto/from the GOT. (GT27,GT25 Only)

3

4

[MOUNTING PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION Use the GOT in the environment that satisfies the general specifications described in this manual.

Not doing so can cause an electric shock, fire, malfunction or product damage or deterioration. When mounting the GOT to the control panel, tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque

range with a Phillips-head screwdriver No.2. [GT27, GT25-W, GT2512-S, GT2510-V, GT2508-V, GT23, GT2107-W] Specified torque range (0.36 N.m to 0.48 N.m) [GT2505, GT2105-Q] Specified torque range (0.30 N.m to 0.50 N.m) [GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] Specified torque range (0.20 N.m to 0.25 N.m) Undertightening can cause the GOT to drop, short circuit or malfunction. Overtightening can cause a drop, short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or the GOT.

When mounting a unit on the GOT, tighten the mounting screws in the following specified torque range. [GT27, GT25 (except GT25-W)] When loading the communication unit or option unit other than wireless LAN unit to the GOT, fit it to the connection interface of the GOT and tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque range (0.36 N.m to 0.48 N.m) with a Phillips-head screwdriver No.2. When loading the wireless LAN unit to the GOT, fit it to the side interface of GOT and tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque range (0.10 N.m to 0.14 N.m) with a Phillips-head screwdriver No.1. When the GOT is installed vertically, its side interface is positioned on the bottom. To prevent the falling of the wireless LAN communication unit from the side interface, install or remove the unit while holding it with hands. [GT25-W] When mounting the wireless LAN communication unit on the GOT, fit it to the wireless LAN communication unit interface and tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque range (0.10 N.m to 0.14 N.m) with a Phillips-head screwdriver No.1. [GT2103-P] When mounting the SD card unit on the GOT, fit it to the side of the GOT and tighten the tapping screws in the specified torque range (0.3 N.m to 0.6 N.m) with a Phillips-head screwdriver No.2. Under tightening can cause the GOT to drop, short circuit or malfunction. Overtightening can cause a drop, failure or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.

When closing the USB environmental protection cover, note the following points to ensure the IP rating. [GT27, GT25 (except GT25-W and GT2505-V)] Push the [PUSH] mark on the latch firmly to fix the cover to the GOT. [GT2512-WX, GT2510-WX, GT2507-W, GT2505-V, GT2107-W] Push the USB mark on the latch firmly to fix the cover to the GOT. [GT2105-Q] Tighten the lower fixing screws of the cover in the specified torque range (0.36 N.m to 0.48 N.m) to fix the cover to the GOT.

[MOUNTING PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION Remove the protective film of the GOT.

When the user continues using the GOT with the protective film, the film may not be removed. In addition, for the models equipped with the human sensor function, using the GOT with the protective film may cause the human sensor not to function properly. For GT2512F-S, GT2510F-V, and GT2508F-V, attach an environmental protection sheet dedicated to the open frame model (sold separately) to the display section. Or, attach a user-prepared environmental protection sheet. Not doing so may damage or soil the GOT or cause foreign matter to enter the GOT, resulting in a failure or malfunction. When installing the supplied fittings on GT2512F-S, GT2510F-V, or GT2508F-V, tighten screws in the specified torque range (0.8 Nm to 1.0 Nm). Meld studs on the control panel to fasten the fittings. The studs must have strength adequate to withstand a tightening torque of 0.9 Nm or more. Make sure that no foreign matter such as welding waste is at and around the bases of the studs. Tighten nuts on the studs in the specified torque range (0.8 Nm to 0.9 Nm) with a wrench for M4 nuts. Undertightening a screw or nut may cause the GOT to drop, short-circuit, or malfunction. Overtightening a screw or nut may damage it or the GOT, causing the GOT to drop, short-circuit, or malfunction.

Do not operate or store the GOT in the environment exposed to direct sunlight, rain, high temperature, dust, humidity, or vibrations.

Although GT2507T-W is ruggedized for environments such as UV rays, temperatures and vibrations, its operation is not guaranteed in all conditions and environments. Make sure to use or store the GOT in an appropriate environment.

When using the GOT in the environment of oil or chemicals, use the protective cover for oil. Failure to do so may cause failure or malfunction due to the oil or chemical entering into the GOT.

Do not operate the GOT with its display section frozen. The water droplets on the display section may freeze at a low temperature. Touch switches and other input objects may malfunction if the display section is frozen.

5

6

[WIRING PRECAUTIONS]

[WIRING PRECAUTIONS]

WARNING Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before wiring.

Failure to do so may result in an electric shock, product damage or malfunctions. After installation, wiring, or other work, make sure to attach the back cover to the Handy GOT before

turning on the power and starting operation. Not doing so may cause an electrical shock.

The Handy GOT is designed to operate on DC power. Supply power to the power supply, operation switch, and emergency stop switch within the specifications. Not doing so may cause a failure due to a reverse power connection.

Correctly wire the 24 V DC power cable (terminal) of the Handy GOT and [+]/[-] of the DC power supply equipment as shown in this manual. Not doing so may cause a failure.

Ground the FG terminal of the Handy GOT with a ground resistance of 100 or less by using a drain wire that has a cross-sectional area of 2 mm2 or more. Do not use common grounding with higher voltage systems. Failure to observe these instructions may cause an electric shock or malfunction.

When making a connection cable or installing wiring, make sure that no chips or wire offcuts enter the Handy GOT. Not doing so may cause a fire, failure or malfunction.

CAUTION When grounding the FG terminal and LG terminal of the GOT power supply section, note the following

points. Not doing so may cause an electric shock or malfunction. [GT27, GT25, GT23, GT2107-W, GT2105-Q] Make sure to ground the FG terminal and LG terminal of the GOT power supply section solely for the GOT (ground resistance: 100 or less, ground cable diameter: 1.6 mm or more). (GT2705-V, GT25- W, GT2505-V, GT2107-W, and GT2105-Q do not have the LG terminal.) [GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] Make sure to ground the FG terminal of the GOT power supply section with a ground resistance of 100 or less. (For GT2104-PMBLS and GT2103-PMBLS, grounding is unnecessary.)

When tightening the terminal screws, use the following screwdrivers. [GT27, GT25, GT23, GT2107-W, GT2105-Q] Use a Phillips-head screwdriver No. 2. [GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] For the usable screwdrivers, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

Tighten the terminal screws of the GOT power supply section in the following specified torque range. [GT27, GT25, GT23] Specified torque range (0.5 N.m to 0.8 N.m)

[WIRING PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION For a terminal processing of a wire to the GOT power supply section, use the following terminal.

[GT27, GT25, GT23, GT2107-W, GT2105-Q] Use applicable solderless terminals for terminal processing of a wire and tighten them with the specified torque. Not doing so can cause a fire, failure or malfunction. [GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] Connect a stranded wire or a solid wire directly, or use a rod terminal with an insulation sleeve.

Correctly wire the GOT power supply section after confirming the rated voltage and terminal arrangement of the product. Not doing so can cause a fire or failure.

Tighten the terminal screws of the GOT power supply section in the following specified torque range. [GT27, GT25, GT23, GT2107-W, GT2105-Q] Specified torque range (0.5 N.m to 0.8 N.m) [GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P] Specified torque range (0.22 N.m to 0.25 N.m)

Exercise care to avoid foreign matter such as chips and wire offcuts entering the GOT. Not doing so can cause a fire, failure or malfunction.

Some models have an ingress prevention label on their top to prevent foreign matter, such as wire offcuts, from entering the GOT during wiring. Do not peel this label during wiring. Before starting system operation, be sure to peel this label because of heat dissipation.

Plug the communication cable into the GOT interface or the connector of the connected unit, and tighten the mounting screws and the terminal screws in the specified torque range. Undertightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction. Overtightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.

Plug the QnA/ACPU/Motion controller(A series) bus connection cable by inserting it into the connector of the connected unit until it "clicks". After plugging, check that it has been inserted snugly. Not doing so can cause a malfunction due to a contact fault.

When you use the Handy GOT, run the connected cable in ducts or clamp the cable. Not doing so can cause the unit or cable to be damaged due to the dangling, motion or accidental pulling of the cables or can cause a malfunction due to a cable connection fault.

When you remove a cable from the Handy GOT, do not pull the cable portion. Doing so can cause the unit or cable to be damaged or can cause a malfunction due to a cable connection fault.

7

8

[TEST OPERATION PRECAUTIONS]

[STARTUP/MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS]

[STARTUP/MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS]

WARNING Before testing the operation of a user-created screen (such as turning on or off a bit device, changing

the current value of a word device, changing the set value or current value of a timer or counter, and changing the current value of a buffer memory), thoroughly read the manual to fully understand the operating procedure. During the test operation, never change the data of the devices which are used to perform significant operation for the system. False output or malfunction can cause an accident.

WARNING When power is on, do not touch the terminals.

Doing so can cause an electric shock or malfunction. Correctly connect the battery connector.

Do not charge, disassemble, heat, short-circuit, solder, or throw the battery into the fire. Doing so will cause the battery to produce heat, explode, or ignite, resulting in injury and fire.

Before starting cleaning or terminal screw retightening, always switch off the power externally in all phases. Not switching the power off in all phases can cause a unit failure or malfunction. Undertightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction. Overtightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.

CAUTION Do not disassemble or modify the unit.

Doing so can cause a failure, malfunction, injury or fire. Do not touch the conductive and electronic parts of the unit directly.

Doing so can cause a unit malfunction or failure. The cables connected to the unit must be run in ducts or clamped.

Not doing so can cause the unit or cable to be damaged due to the dangling, motion or accidental pulling of the cables or can cause a malfunction due to a cable connection fault.

When unplugging the cable connected to the unit, do not hold and pull from the cable portion. Doing so can cause the unit or cable to be damaged or can cause a malfunction due to a cable connection fault.

Do not drop the module or subject it to strong shock. A module damage may result.

Do not drop or give an impact to the battery mounted to the unit. Doing so may damage the battery, causing the battery fluid to leak inside the battery. If the battery is dropped or given an impact, dispose of it without using.

Before touching the unit, always touch grounded metals, etc. to discharge static electricity from human body, etc. Not doing so can cause the unit to fail or malfunction.

[STARTUP/MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS]

[TOUCH PANEL PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION Use the battery manufactured by Mitsubishi Electric Corporation.

Use of other batteries may cause a risk of fire or explosion. Dispose of used battery promptly.

Keep away from children.Do not disassemble and do not dispose of in fire. Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply before replacing the battery or using the dip

switch of the terminating resistor. Not doing so can cause the unit to fail or malfunction by static electricity.

Before cleaning the GOT, be sure to turn off the power. Before cleaning, check the following items. Ensure that there are no problems with the installation condition of the GOT to the control panel. Ensure that there are no damages on the environmental protection sheet (not replaceable). If the environmental protection sheet peels or the cleaning solution enters between the sheet and the display section during cleaning, stop the cleaning immediately. In such a case, do not use the GOT.

CAUTION For the analog-resistive film type touch panels, normally the adjustment is not required.

However, the difference between a touched position and the object position may occur as the period of use elapses.When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, execute the touch panel calibration.

When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, other object may be activated. This may cause an unexpected operation due to incorrect output or malfunction.

9

10

[PRECAUTIONS FOR USING A DATA STORAGE]

WARNING If the SD card is removed from drive A of the GOT while being accessed by the GOT, the GOT may

stop processing data for about 20 seconds. The GOT cannot be operated during this period.The functions that run in the background including a screen updating, alarm, logging, scripts, and others are also interrupted. Before removing the SD card, check the following items. [GT27, GT25, GT23(Excluding GT2505 and GT25HS-V)] Before removing the SD card, check that the SD card access LED is off. [GT2505, GT25HS-V] Make sure to turn off the SD card access switch before removing the SD card. Not doing so may damage the SD card or files. [GT21] Disable the SD card access in the GOT utility, and then check that the SD card access LED is off before removing the SD card.

Do not remove the data storage from the file server (drive N) that is being accessed by the GOT, or the system operation may be affected. Before removing the data storage, check the relevant system signal to make sure that the data storage is not being accessed.

[PRECAUTIONS FOR USING A DATA STORAGE]

CAUTION If the data storage is removed from the GOT while being accessed by the GOT, the data storage and

files may be damaged. Before removing the data storage from the GOT, check the SD card access LED, system signal, or others to make sure that the data storage is not accessed.

Turning off the GOT while it accesses the SD card results in damage to the SD card and files. When using the GOT with an SD card inserted, check the following items.

[GT27, GT25, GT23(Excluding GT2505 and GT25HS-V)] After inserting an SD card into the GOT, make sure to close the SD card cover. Otherwise, data cannot be read or written. [GT2505-V, GT25HS-V] After inserting an SD card into the GOT, make sure to turn on the SD card access switch. Otherwise, data cannot be read or written. [GT21] After inserting an SD card into the SD card unit, make sure to enable the SD card access in the GOT utility. Otherwise, data cannot be read or written.

When removing the SD card from the GOT, make sure to support the SD card by hand as it may pop out. Not doing so may cause the SD card to drop from the GOT, resulting in a failure or break.

When inserting a USB device into a USB interface of the GOT, make sure to insert the device into the interface firmly. Not doing so may cause the USB device to drop from the GOT, resulting in a failure or break.(GT27, GT25, and GT2107-W)

Before removing the data storage from the GOT, follow the procedure for removal on the utility screen of the GOT. After the successful completion dialog is displayed, remove the data storage by hand carefully. Not doing so may cause the data storage to drop from the GOT, resulting in a failure or break.

11

12

[PRECAUTIONS FOR USE]

CAUTION When you operate the Handy GOT while holding it, slide your hand through the hand strap on the

back of the GOT to prevent falling. The hand strap length is adjustable.

When you remove a cable from the Handy GOT, do not pull the cable portion. Doing so may damage the unit or cable, or cause a malfunction due to a cable connection fault.

Do not drop or strike the Handy GOT. Doing so may damage the GOT.

When you carry or operate the Handy GOT, hold its body. Carrying or operating the Handy GOT while holding its cable may damage the unit or cable.

Determine whether to use the emergency stop switch of the Handy GOT according to your risk assessment.

If you use a parallel circuit (to avoid entering the emergency stop status while the Handy GOT is removed), the system may not conform to the safety standards. Check the safety standards required for your system before use.

If the Handy GOT is exposed to any impact beyond the general specifications, chattering may occur in the emergency stop switch for its structural reasons. Check that your use conditions are proper.

Do not touch the edges of the touch panel (display section) repeatedly. Doing so may result in a failure.

Do not turn off the GOT while data is being written to the storage memory (ROM) or SD card. Doing so may corrupt the data, rendering the GOT inoperative.

The GOT rugged model uses the environmental protection sheet (not replaceable) with UV protection function on the front surface. Therefore, it is possible to suppress deterioration of the touch panel or the liquid crystal display panel that may be caused by ultraviolet rays. Note that if the rugged model is exposed to ultraviolet rays for an extended period of time, the front surface may turn yellow. If the rugged model is likely to be exposed to ultraviolet rays for an extended period of time, it is recommended to use a UV protective sheet (option).

[PRECAUTIONS FOR REMOTE CONTROL]

[PRECAUTIONS FOR EXCLUSIVE AUTHORIZATION CONTROL]

[DISPOSAL PRECAUTIONS]

WARNING Remote control is available through a network by using GOT functions, including theSoftGOT-GOT

link function, the remote personal computer operation function, the VNC server function, and the GOT Mobile function. If you remotely operate control equipment using such functions, the field operator may not notice the remote operation, leading to an accident. In addition, a communication delay or interruption may occur depending on the network environment, and remote control of control equipment cannot be performed normally in some cases. Before using the above functions to perform remote control, fully grasp the circumstances of the field site and ensure safety.

When operating the server (GOT) of the GOT Mobile function to disconnect a client, notify the operator of the client about the disconnection beforehand. Not doing so may cause an accident.

WARNING Before using the GOT network interaction function to prevent simultaneous operations from multiple

pieces of equipment, make sure you understand the function. You can enable or disable the exclusive authorization control of the GOT network interaction function for each screen. (For all screens, the exclusive authorization control is disabled by default.) Properly determine the screens for which the exclusive authorization control is required, and set the control by screen. A screen for which the exclusive authorization control is disabled is operable simultaneously from multiple pieces of equipment. Make sure to determine the operation period for each operator, fully grasp the circumstances of the field site, and ensure safety to perform operations.

CAUTION When disposing of this product, treat it as industrial waste.

When disposing of batteries, separate them from other wastes according to the local regulations. (Refer to GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) for details of the battery directive in the EU member states.)

13

14

[TRANSPORTATION PRECAUTIONS]

CAUTION When transporting lithium batteries, make sure to treat them based on the transport regulations.

(Refer to GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) for details of the regulated models.) Make sure to transport the GOT main unit and/or relevant unit(s) in the manner they will not be

exposed to the impact exceeding the impact resistance described in the general specifications of this manual, as they are precision devices. Failure to do so may cause the unit to fail.Check if the unit operates correctly after transportation.

When fumigants that contain halogen materials such as fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine are used for disinfecting and protecting wooden packaging from insects, they cause malfunction when entering our products. Please take necessary precautions to ensure that remaining materials from fumigant do not enter our products, or treat packaging with methods other than fumigation (heat method).Additionally, disinfect and protect wood from insects before packing products.

C O

N TE

N TS

CONTENTS SAFETY PRECAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 INTRODUCTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Manuals for GT Works3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 Abbreviations, Generic Terms, and Model Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27

PART 1 UTILITY FOR GT27/GT25/GT23

CHAPTER 1 UTILITY FUNCTION 36 1.1 Utility Execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 1.2 Utility Function List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 1.3 Utility Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42

Display operation of main menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Utility basic configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Basic operation to change the settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

CHAPTER 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 49 2.1 Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

Display setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Display operation of display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Display setting operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

2.2 Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Language setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Display operation of language display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Setting operation of language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57

2.3 Unique Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Unique information setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Display operation of unique information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Setting procedure for unique information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59

2.4 IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 IP address setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Display operation of IP address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Setting procedure for the IP address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66

2.5 IP Filter Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 IP filter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Display operation of the IP filter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Setting procedure for the IP filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69

2.6 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Operation setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Display operation of operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Setting operation of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73

2.7 Utility Call Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Utility call key setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Display operation of the utility call key setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Utility call key setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

2.8 USB Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 USB host setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

15

16

Display operation of the USB host setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Setting operation of USB host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78

2.9 Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Clock synchronization method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Time setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Adjusting the clock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Broadcasting the clock data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Local time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96

2.10 Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Controller setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Communication detail setting display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Controller contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Controller setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Communication detail setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

2.11 Ethernet Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Ethernet setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Display operation of the Ethernet setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Display contents of Ethernet setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117

2.12 Transparent Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Transparent mode setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Display operation of the transparent mode setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Operation the transparent mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123

2.13 GOT Internal Device Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 GOT internal device monitor setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Display operation of the GOT internal device monitor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Setting procedure for the GOT internal device monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125

2.14 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Security level authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

2.15 Operator Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Operator management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Password change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151

CHAPTER 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 157 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158

SoftGOT-GOT link function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Display operation of the SoftGOT-GOT link function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 SoftGOT-GOT link function setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160

3.2 VNC Server Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 VNC server function setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Display operation of the VNC server function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 VNC server function setting operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164

3.3 Sequence Program Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Sequence program monitor setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Display operation of the sequence program monitor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Sequence program monitor setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166

3.4 Backup/Restoration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Backup/restoration setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Display operation of backup/restoration setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Backup/restoration setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169

C O

N TE

N TS

3.5 Trigger Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Trigger backup setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Display operation of the trigger backup setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Trigger backup setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Trigger time setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173

3.6 License Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 License management setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Display operation of the license management setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Setting operation of license management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175

3.7 Video/RGB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Video unit setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Video display setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 RGB display setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182

3.8 Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Video unit setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Video setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Long time recording setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Version control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 Network setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Multimedia screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196

3.9 Wireless LAN Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Wireless LAN function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Display operation of the wireless LAN function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Display contents when [Action Mode] is set to [Access point]. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Display contents when [Action Mode] is set to [Station] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202

3.10 System Launcher. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 System launcher setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Display operation of the system launcher setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Setting procedure for the system launcher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205

3.11 iQSS Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 iQSS utility setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Display operation of the iQSS utility setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Setting procedure for the iQSS utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207

3.12 ANDON Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 ANDON connection setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Display operation of the ANDON connection setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Setting procedure for the ANDON connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210

3.13 Ethernet Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Ethernet printer setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Display operation of the Ethernet printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Procedure for setting an Ethernet printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212

3.14 Network drive setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Setting the network drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Displaying the network drive setting screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Procedure for setting the network drive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214

CHAPTER 4 MAINTENANCE 215 4.1 Batch Self Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216

Batch self check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216

17

18

Display operation of batch self check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 Operation of batch self check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217

4.2 USB Device Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Function of the USB device management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Display operation of the USB device management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 USB device status display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

4.3 Screen Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Screen cleaning function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Display operation of the screen for cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Operation of clean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222

4.4 Touch Panel Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Touch panel calibration setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Display operation of the touch panel calibration setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Touch panel calibration operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224

4.5 System Alarm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 System alarm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Display operation of system alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Operation of system alarm display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227

4.6 Drawing Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Drawing check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Display operation of drawing check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Drawing check operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229

4.7 Font Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Font check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Display operation of Font check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Font check operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233

4.8 Touch Panel Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Touch panel check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Display operation of Touch panel check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Touch panel check operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235

4.9 I/O Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 I/O check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 Display operation of I/O Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 I/O check operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238

4.10 Ethernet Status Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Ethernet status check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Display operation of Ethernet status check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Operation of Ethernet status check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242

4.11 GOT Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 GOT information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Display operation of GOT information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 Display of GOT information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

4.12 GOT Mobile Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 GOT Mobile information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Display operation of the GOT Mobile information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Displaying the GOT Mobile information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

CHAPTER 5 MONITOR 247 5.1 Monitor Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247

Function of monitor screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248

C O

N TE

N TS

Display operation of monitor screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

CHAPTER 6 DATA CONTROL 251 6.1 Data Type and Storage Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 6.2 Alarm Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Function of alarm information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255 The display operation of alarm information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255 The display example of alarm information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 Alarm information operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257

6.3 Image File Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Function of image file management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Display operation of image file management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Display example of image file management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Operation of image file management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264

6.4 Recipe Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Function of recipe information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Display operation of recipe information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Example of advanced recipe information display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Recipe information operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302

6.5 Logging Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 Function of logging information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 Display operation of logging information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 Example of logging information display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 Logging information operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316

6.6 Operation Log Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Function of operation log information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Display operation of operation log information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 Example of operation log information display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Operation log information operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340

6.7 File Manager. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Required system application (extended function) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Display operation of the file manager screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 Display example of the file manager screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343 Operations on the file manager screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354

6.8 File Print . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 Required system application (extended function) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 Display operation of the file print . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 Display example of the file print screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358 Operation of the file print . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362

6.9 Package Data Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Function of package data management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Display operation of package data management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Display example of package data management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 Operation of package data management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373

19

20

6.10 Backup/Restore Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Backup/restore function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Display operation of backup/restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Operation of backup/restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

6.11 SRAM management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 Function of SRAM management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 Display operation of SRAM management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 Display example of SRAM management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 SRAM management operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

6.12 Memory Card Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Display operation of memory card format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Operating the memory card format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382

6.13 Memory Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 Memory check function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 Display operation of memory check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 Memory check operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385

6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 GOT data package acquisition function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 Display operation of GOT data package acquisition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 Display example of GOT data package acquisition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 GOT data package acquisition operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389

CHAPTER 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 391 7.1 Preparation before Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393

Installing when starting the GOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 Installing using the data control function (Utility) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396

7.3 When Installing the Different Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398

CHAPTER 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 401 8.1 Display on the GOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403

PART 2 UTILITY FOR GT21

CHAPTER 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 422 9.1 Utility Execution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422 9.2 Utility Function List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423 9.3 Utility Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425

Display operation of main menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 Utility basic configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429 Basic operation of settings change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430

CHAPTER 10 LANGUAGE SETTING 433 10.1 Display Language Setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433

Display language setting function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433 Language setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433

C O

N TE

N TS

CHAPTER 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 435 11.1 Standard I/F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435

Standard I/F functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435 Standard I/F display operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436 Display contents of standard I/F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438 Detail information setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445 Channel setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448 Driver setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450

11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451 Standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451 Display operation of GOT IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451 Setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454

11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456 Setting function for Ethernet communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456 Display operation of Ethernet communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456 Display contents of Ethernet setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459

11.4 Communication Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464 Communication monitor functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464 Communication monitor display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464 Screen display content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467

11.5 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469 11.6 Setting the Transparent Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471 11.7 Keyword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472

Keyword functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472 Keyword display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472 Regist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473 Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476 Clear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478 Protect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479

11.8 Ethernet Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480 Ethernet printer setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480 Display operation of the Ethernet printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480 Procedure for setting an Ethernet printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483

CHAPTER 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 485 12.1 Display Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486

Display functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486 Display operation of display setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487 Display setting operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489

12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492 Operation setting functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492 Display operation of operation setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493 Setting operation of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495 Position correction of the touch panel (touch panel calibration setting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497 Setting the utility call keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499

12.3 Inherent Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 Setting function for inherent information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 Display operation of inherent information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502 Setting operation for inherent information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502

21

22

12.4 USB Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503 USB host setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503 Display operation of the USB host setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503 Setting operation of USB host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504

12.5 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506 Backup/restoration setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506 Display operation for setting the storage location for backup and restoration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506 Backup/restoration setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507

12.6 GOT Internal Device Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508 Setting the GOT internal device monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508 GOT internal device monitor display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508 GOT internal device monitor setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509

12.7 VNC Server Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 VNC server function setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 Display operation of the VNC server function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510 VNC server function setting operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511

12.8 License Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512 License management setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512 Display operation of the license management setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512 Setting operation of license management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513

12.9 IP filter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514 IP filter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514 Display operation of the IP filter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514 Setting procedure for the IP filter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515

CHAPTER 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 521 13.1 Security Level Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521 13.2 Operator Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523

Operator information management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523 Password change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532 Function setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534

13.3 Login/Logout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536

CHAPTER 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 537 14.1 Time Setting and Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537

Time setting and display functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537 Clock synchronization method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538 Time setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539 Adjusting the clock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542 Broadcasting the clock data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 546 Local time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550

CHAPTER 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 553 15.1 Data Storage Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553

Data type and storage location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553 Checking version of BootOS and basic system application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 557

15.2 OS information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558 15.3 Resource Data Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559

Alarm information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559 Recipe information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569

C O

N TE

N TS

Logging information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 580 Image file management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587 Operation log information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594

15.4 SD Card Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600 Functions of SD card access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600 Display operation of SD card access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600 Operation of SD card access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600

15.5 SD Card Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601 15.6 Clear Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605

Clear data functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605 Clear data display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605 Clear data operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608

15.7 Data Copy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609 Display operation of data copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609 Operation of data copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611

15.8 Backup and Restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614 Backup and restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614 System configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615 Access range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 619 Security and password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 622 Display operation of backup and restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 628 Backup operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 629 Restoration operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631 Keyword operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 633 Errors and corrective actions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634

15.9 USB Device Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636 Function of the USB device management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636 Display operation of the USB device management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636 USB device status display operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637

CHAPTER 16 DEBUG 639 16.1 Device Monitor Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639

System configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639 Devices that can be monitored . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640 Display operation of device monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641 Information displayed on the device monitor screen and key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 645 Basic operation of device monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647 Device registration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 648 Quick test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650

16.2 FX List Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 653 Display operation of FX list editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 653 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 656 Access range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 657 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 658 Display operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 659 Operation procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 662 Selection and operation of modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 664 Displaying sequence programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 665

23

24

Searching commands/devices. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 667 Writing commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 669 Changing operands, set values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 672 Deleting commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 673 Sequence program all clear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 674 PLC diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 675 Parameter setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 676 Keyword. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 678 List monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 680 Action for an incorrect key input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682 Error messages and corrective actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 682

16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 683 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 683 Display operation of FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 684 Setting operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 685

CHAPTER 17 MAINTENANCE 687 17.1 Touch Panel Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 687 17.2 Touch Panel Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 690 17.3 Clean. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 692

CHAPTER 18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 693 18.1 Preparation before Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 694 18.2 Installation Using Data Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 695

Installing when starting the GOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 696 Installing using the data copy function (Utility) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 696

CHAPTER 19 ERROR MESSAGE LIST 697 19.1 GOT Error Messages and Corrective Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 697 Revisions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .698 Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .701 Intellectual Property Rights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .702

INTRODUCTION Thank you for choosing Mitsubishi Electric Graphic Operation Terminal (GOT). Before using the product, read this manual carefully and make sure you understand the functions and performance of the GOT for correct use. Manuals for GT Works3 Abbreviations, Generic Terms, and Model Icons

Manuals for GT Works3 The electronic manuals related to this product are installed together with the screen design software. If you need the printed manuals, consult your local sales office.

Manuals for GT Designer3 (GOT2000)

e-Manual refers to the Mitsubishi Electric FA electronic book manuals that can be browsed using a dedicated tool. e-Manual has the following features: Required information can be cross-searched in multiple manuals. Other manuals can be accessed from the links in the manual. Hardware specifications of each part can be found from the product figures. Pages that users often browse can be bookmarked. Sample programs can be copied to the engineering tool.

Screen design software-related manuals

Connection manuals

Manual name Manual number (Model code)

Format

GT Works3 Installation Instructions - PDF

GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual SH-081220ENG (1D7ML9)

PDF e-Manual

GT Converter2 Version3 Operating Manual for GT Works3 SH-080862ENG (1D7MB2)

PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series MES Interface Function Manual for GT Works3 Version1 SH-081228ENG PDF e-Manual

Manual name Manual number (Model code)

Format

GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Electric Products) For GT Works3 Version1 SH-081197ENG (1D7MJ8)

PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1) For GT Works3 Version1

SH-081198ENG PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2) For GT Works3 Version1

SH-081199ENG PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Microcomputers, MODBUS/Fieldbus Products, Peripherals) For GT Works3 Version1

SH-081200ENG PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series Handy GOT Connection Manual For GT Works3 Version1 SH-081867ENG (1D7MS9)

PDF e-Manual

25

26

GT SoftGOT2000 manuals

GOT2000 series user's manuals

GOT SIMPLE series user's manuals

Manuals related to GT Works3 add-on projects

Manuals for GT Designer3 (GOT1000) Refer to the Help and manuals for GT Designer3 (GOT1000).

Manual name Manual number (Model code)

Format

GT SoftGOT2000 Version1 Operating Manual SH-081201ENG PDF e-Manual

MELSOFT GT OPC UA Client Operating Manual SH-082174ENG PDF

Manual name Manual number (Model code)

Format

GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) SH-081194ENG (1D7MJ5)

PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Utility) SH-081195ENG (1D7MJ6)

PDF e-Manual

GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor) SH-081196ENG (1D7MJ7)

PDF e-Manual

Manual name Manual number Format GOT SIMPLE Series User's Manual JY997D52901 PDF

e-Manual

Manual name Manual number (Model code)

Format

GT Works3 Add-on License for GOT2000 Enhanced Drive Control (Servo) Project Data Manual (Fundamentals)

SH-082072ENG (1D7MV1)

PDF e-Manual

GT Works3 Add-on License for GOT2000 Enhanced Drive Control (Servo) Project Data Manual (Screen Details)

SH-082074ENG (1D7MV3)

PDF e-Manual

Abbreviations, Generic Terms, and Model Icons The following shows the abbreviations, generic terms, and model icons used in this manual.

GOT GOT2000 series Abbreviations and generic terms Description Meaning of icon

Available Unavailable GT27 GT27-X GT2715-X GT2715-XTBA

GT2715-XTBD

GT27-S GT2712-S GT2712-STBA GT2712-STWA GT2712-STBD GT2712-STWD

GT2710-S GT2710-STBA GT2710-STBD

GT2708-S GT2708-STBA GT2708-STBD

GT27-V GT2710-V GT2710-VTBA GT2710-VTWA GT2710-VTBD GT2710-VTWD

GT2708-V GT2708-VTBA GT2708-VTBD

GT2705-V GT2705-VTBD

GT25 All GT25 models

GT25-W GT2512-WX GT2512-WXTBD GT2512-WXTSD

GT2510-WX GT2510-WXTBD GT2510-WXTSD

GT2507-W GT2507-WTBD GT2507-WTSD

GT2507T-W GT2507T-WTSD

GT25-S GT2512-S GT2512-STBA GT2512-STBD

GT2512F-S GT2512F-STNA GT2512F-STND

GT25-V GT2510-V GT2510-VTBA GT2510-VTWA GT2510-VTBD GT2510-VTWD

GT2510F-V GT2510F-VTNA GT2510F-VTND

GT2508-V GT2508-VTBA GT2508-VTWA GT2508-VTBD GT2508-VTWD

GT2508F-V GT2508F-VTNA GT2508F-VTND

GT2505-V GT2505-VTBD

GT25HS-V Handy GOT

GT2506HS-V GT2506HS-VTBD

GT2505HS-V GT2505HS-VTBD

GT23 GT23-V GT2310-V GT2310-VTBA GT2310-VTBD

GT2308-V GT2308-VTBA GT2308-VTBD

27

28

GOT SIMPLE series

GOT1000 series, GOT900 series, and GOT800 series

GT21 All GT21 models

GT21-W GT2107-W GT2107-WTBD GT2107-WTSD

GT21-Q GT2105-Q GT2105-QTBDS GT2105-QMBDS

GT21-R GT2104-R GT2104-RTBD

GT21-P GT2104-P GT2104-PMBD

GT2104-PMBDS

GT2104-PMBDS2

GT2104-PMBLS

GT2103-P GT2103-PMBD

GT2103-PMBDS

GT2103-PMBDS2

GT2103-PMBLS

GT SoftGOT2000 GT SoftGOT2000 Version1

Abbreviations and generic terms Description Meaning of icon

Available Unavailable GS21 GS21-W-N GS2110-WTBD-N

GS2107-WTBD-N

GS21-W GS2110-WTBD GS2107-WTBD

Abbreviations and generic terms Description Meaning of icon

Available Unavailable GOT1000 Series GOT1000 Series -

GOT900 Series GOT-A900 Series GOT-F900 Series

-

GOT800 Series GOT-800 Series -

Abbreviations and generic terms Description Meaning of icon

Available Unavailable

Communication unit

Option unit

Abbreviations and generic terms Description Bus connection unit GT15-QBUS

GT15-QBUS2 GT15-ABUS GT15-ABUS2 GT15-75QBUSL GT15-75QBUS2L GT15-75ABUSL GT15-75ABUS2L

Serial communication unit GT15-RS2-9P GT15-RS4-9S GT15-RS4-TE

MELSECNET/H communication unit GT15-J71LP23-25 GT15-J71BR13

CC-Link IE TSN communication unit GT25-J71GN13-T2

CC-Link IE Controller Network communication unit GT15-J71GP23-SX

CC-Link IE Field Network communication unit GT15-J71GF13-T2

CC-Link communication unit GT15-J61BT13

Wireless LAN communication unit GT25-WLAN

Serial multi-drop connection unit GT01-RS4-M

Connection conversion adapter GT10-9PT5S

Field network adapter unit GT25-FNADP

Ethernet communication unit GT25-J71E71-100

RS-232/485 signal conversion adapter GT14-RS2T4-9P

Abbreviations and generic terms Description Printer unit GT15-PRN

Video input unit GT27-V4-Z (A set of GT16M-V4-Z and GT27-IF1000)

RGB input unit GT27-R2 GT27-R2-Z (A set of GT16M-R2-Z and GT27-IF1000)

Video/RGB input unit GT27-V4R1-Z (A set of GT16M-V4R1-Z and GT27-IF1000)

RGB output unit GT27-ROUT GT27-ROUT-Z (A set of GT16M-ROUT-Z and GT27-IF1000)

Digital video output unit GT27-VHOUT

Multimedia unit GT27-MMR-Z (A set of GT16M-MMR-Z and GT27-IF1000)

Video signal conversion unit GT27-IF1000

External I/O unit GT15-DIO GT15-DIOR

Sound output unit GT15-SOUT

SD card unit GT21-03SDCD

29

30

Option Abbreviations and generic terms Description SD card NZ1MEM-2GBSD

NZ1MEM-4GBSD NZ1MEM-8GBSD NZ1MEM-16GBSD L1MEM-2GBSD L1MEM-4GBSD

Battery GT11-50BAT GT15-BAT

Protective sheet GT27-15PSGC GT25-12WPSGC GT25-12PSGC GT25-10WPSGC GT25-10PSGC GT25-08PSGC GT21-07WPSGC GT25T-07WPSVC GT25-05PSGC GT25-05PSGC-2 GT21-05PSGC GT21-04RPSGC-UC GT21-03PSGC-UC GT21-04PSGC-UC GT27-15PSCC GT25-12WPSCC GT25-12PSCC GT25-10WPSCC GT25-10PSCC GT25-08PSCC GT25-05PSCC GT25-05PSCC-2 GT25-12PSCC-UC GT25-10PSCC-UC GT25-08PSCC-UC GT21-07WPSCC GT21-05PSCC GT21-04RPSCC-UC GT21-04PSCC-UC GT21-03PSCC-UC GT16H-60PSC GT14H-50PSC

Antibacterial/antiviral protective sheet GT25-12PSAC GT25-10PSAC GT25-08PSAC

Environmental protection sheet GT25F-12ESGS GT25F-10ESGS GT25F-08ESGS

Protective cover for oil GT20-15PCO GT20-12PCO GT20-10PCO GT20-08PCO GT21-12WPCO GT21-10WPCO GT21-07WPCO GT25T-07WPCO GT25-05PCO GT25-05PCO-2 GT05-50PCO GT21-04RPCO GT10-30PCO GT10-20PCO

USB environmental protection cover GT25-UCOV GT25-05UCOV GT21-WUCOV

Software Software related to GOT

Software related to iQ Works

Stand GT15-90STAND GT15-80STAND GT15-70STAND GT05-50STAND GT25-10WSTAND GT21-07WSTAND GT25T-07WSTAND

Attachment GT15-70ATT-98 GT15-70ATT-87 GT15-60ATT-97 GT15-60ATT-96 GT15-60ATT-87 GT15-60ATT-77 GT21-04RATT-40

Panel-mounted USB port extension GT14-C10EXUSB-4S GT10-C10EXUSB-5S

Connector conversion box GT16H-CNB-42S GT16H-CNB-37S GT11H-CNB-37S

Emergency stop switch guard cover GT16H-60ESCOV GT14H-50ESCOV

Wall-mounting attachment GT14H-50ATT

Abbreviations and generic terms Description GT Works3 SW1DND-GTWK3-J, SW1DND-GTWK3-E, SW1DND-GTWK3-C

GT Designer3 Version1 Screen design software GT Designer3 for GOT2000 and GOT1000 series

GT Designer3 Screen design software for GOT2000 series included in GT Works3

GT Designer3 (GOT2000)

GT Designer3 (GOT1000) Screen design software for GOT1000 series included in GT Works3

Speech synthesis license GT Works Text to Speech License (SW1DND-GTVO-M)

Add-on license GT Works3 add-on license for GOT2000 enhanced drive control (servo) project data (SW1DND- GTSV-MZ)

GENESIS64 Advanced GENESIS64 server application (GEN64-APP)

GENESIS64 Basic SCADA GENESIS64 server application (GEN64-BASIC)

GENESIS64 Generic term of GENESIS64 Advanced and GENESIS64 Basic SCADA

GOT Mobile function license for GT SoftGOT2000 License required to use the GOT Mobile function with GT SoftGOT2000 (SGT2K-WEBSKEY-)

GT Simulator3 Screen simulator GT Simulator3 for GOT2000, GOT1000, and GOT900 series

GT SoftGOT2000 GOT2000 compatible HMI software GT SoftGOT2000

GT OPC UA Client MELSOFT GT OPC UA Client (SW1DNN-GTOUC-MD)

GT Converter2 Data conversion software GT Converter2 for GOT1000 and GOT900 series

GT Designer2 Classic Screen design software GT Designer2 Classic for GOT900 series

GT Designer2 Screen design software GT Designer2 for GOT1000 and GOT900 series

DU/WIN Screen design software FX-PCS-DU/WIN for GOT-F900 series

Abbreviations and generic terms Description iQ Works iQ Platform compatible engineering environment MELSOFT iQ Works

MELSOFT Navigator Integrated development environment software included in SWDND-IQWK (iQ Platform compatible engineering environment MELSOFT iQ Works) ( represents a version.)

MELSOFT iQ AppPortal SWDND-IQAPL-M type integrated application management software ( represents a version.)

Abbreviations and generic terms Description

31

32

Other software

License key (for GT SoftGOT2000)

Abbreviations and generic terms Description GX Works3 SWDND-GXW3-E (-EA, -EAZ) type programmable controller engineering software

( represents a version.)

GX Works2 SWDNC-GXW2-E (-EA, -EAZ) type programmable controller engineering software ( represents a version.)

Controller simulator GX Simulator3 Simulation function of GX Works3

GX Simulator2 Simulation function of GX Works2

GX Simulator SWD5C-LLT-E (-EV) type ladder logic test tool function software package (SW5D5C-LLT (-V) or later versions) ( represents a version.)

GX Developer SWD5C-GPPW-E (-EV)/SWD5F-GPPW (-V) type software package ( represents a version.)

GX LogViewer SWDNN-VIEWER-E type software package ( represents a version.)

MI Configurator Configuration and monitor tool for Mitsubishi Electric industrial computers (SWDNNMICONF-M) ( represents a version.)

PX Developer SWD5C-FBDQ-E type FBD software package for process control ( represents a version.)

MT Works2 Motion controller engineering environment MELSOFT MT Works2 (SWDND-MTW2-E) ( represents a version.)

MT Developer SWRNC-GSV type integrated start-up support software for motion controller Q series ( represents a version.)

CW Configurator Setting/monitoring tools for the C Controller module and MELSECWinCPU (SWDND-RCCPU-E) ( represents a version.)

MR Configurator2 SWDNC-MRC2-E type servo configuration software ( represents a version.)

MR Configurator MRZJW-SETUP type servo configuration software ( represents a version.)

FR Configurator2 Inverter setup software (SWDND-FRC2-E) ( represents a version.)

FR Configurator Inverter setup software (FR-SW-SETUP-WE) ( represents a version.)

NC Configurator2 CNC parameter setting support tool (FCSB1221)

NC Configurator CNC parameter setting support tool

FX Configurator-FP Parameter setting, monitoring, and testing software package for FX3U-20SSC-H (SWD5CFXSSCE) ( represents a version.)

FX3U-ENET-L Configuration tool FX3U-ENET-L type Ethernet module setting software (SW1D5-FXENETL-E)

RT ToolBox2 Robot program creation software (3D-11C-WINE)

RT ToolBox3 Robot program creation software (3F-14C-WINE)

MX Component MX Component Version (SWD5C-ACT-E, SWD5C-ACT-EA) ( represents a version.)

MX Sheet MX Sheet Version (SWD5C-SHEET-E, SWD5C-SHEET-EA) ( represents a version.)

CPU Module Logging Configuration Tool CPU module logging configuration tool (SW1DNN-LLUTL-E)

Abbreviations and generic terms Description License key GT27-SGTKEY-U

Others Abbreviations and generic terms Description IAI IAI Corporation

AZBIL Azbil Corporation

OMRON OMRON Corporation

KEYENCE KEYENCE CORPORATION

KOYO EI KOYO ELECTRONICS INDUSTRIES CO., LTD.

JTEKT JTEKT Corporation

SHARP Sharp Corporation

SHINKO Shinko Technos Co., Ltd.

CHINO CHINO CORPORATION

TOSHIBA TOSHIBA CORPORATION

SHIBAURA MACHINE SHIBAURA MACHINE CO.,LTD.

PANASONIC Panasonic Corporation

PANASONIC IDS Panasonic Industrial Devices SUNX Co., Ltd.

HITACHI IES Hitachi Industrial Equipment Systems Co., Ltd.

HITACHI Hitachi, Ltd.

HIRATA Hirata Corporation

FUJI FUJI ELECTRIC CO., LTD.

MURATEC Muratec products manufactured by Murata Machinery, Ltd.

YASKAWA YASKAWA Electric Corporation

YOKOGAWA Yokogawa Electric Corporation

RKC RKC INSTRUMENT INC.

ALLEN-BRADLEY Allen-Bradley products manufactured by Rockwell Automation, Inc.

CLPA CC-Link Partner Association

GE GE Intelligent Platforms, Inc.

HMS HMS Industrial Networks

LS IS LS Industrial Systems Co., Ltd.

MITSUBISHI INDIA Mitsubishi Electric India Pvt. Ltd.

ODVA Open DeviceNet Vendor Association, Inc.

SCHNEIDER Schneider Electric SA

SICK SICK AG

SIEMENS Siemens AG

SCHNEIDER EJH Schneider Electric Japan Holdings Ltd.

PLC Programmable controller manufactured by its respective company

Control equipment Control equipment manufactured by its respective company

Temperature controller Temperature controller manufactured by its respective company

Indicating controller Indicating controller manufactured by its respective company

Controller Controller manufactured by its respective company

TSN Switch CC-Link IE TSN Class B (Synchronized Realtime Communication) hub certified by CC-Link Partner Association

General-purpose Switch CC-Link IE TSN Class A (Realtime Communication) hub certified by CC-Link Partner Association

CC-Link IE TSN-equipped module Generic term for the following CC-Link IE TSN master/local modules and CC-Link IE TSN Plus master/local module RJ71GN11-T2 RJ71GN11-EIP FX5-CCLGN-MS

33

34

MEMO

PART 1 UTILITY FOR GT27/ GT25/GT23

1 UTILITY FUNCTION

2 GOT BASIC SETTING

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING

4 MAINTENANCE

5 MONITOR

6 DATA CONTROL

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST

35

36

1 UTILITY FUNCTION Page 36 Utility Execution Page 37 Utility Function List Page 42 Utility Display Utility is a function, which carries out connection of GOT and controller, screen display and operation method settings, program/data control and self-check etc. Refer to the following for the utility function list. Page 37 Utility Function List

1.1 Utility Execution For utility execution, utility has to be displayed by installing BootOS and basic system application in the C drive (built in flash memory). There are following three types for the installing BootOS and basic system application methods.

*1 When installing the BootOS and basic system application, standard monitor OS has to be installed in GOT in advance. Refer to the following for the installation which uses GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Refer to the following for the installation which uses GOT. Page 391 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION

Install directly from GT Designer3

Via a USB interface or RS-232 interface or Ethernet interface

GT Designer3

GT Designer3

Writing system applications to a file

2) GT Designer3 Data storage GOT

GOT

GOT

GOT

GOT

*1

*1

*1

Installing BootOS or basic system application

Installing BootOS or basic system application

When GOT is remote, install using a data storage easily

Install a data storage to the GOT

Install a data storage to the GOT

Data storage

Data storage

Install from the GOT to the GOT using a data storage

Uploading system application files

1) GT Designer3GOT

3) GOT Data storage GOT

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.1 Utility Execution

1

1.2 Utility Function List The items in the following list can be set/operated on the utility screens. For GT Designer3 of an old version, displayed screens, setting items and others may differ from those described in the manual. The sequence program monitor (R ladder) will be supported soon.

Item Functions overview Applicable GOT Reference

GT27 GT25 GT23 GOT basic setting

Display Setting the startup screen display time and screen saving time

Page 50 Display

Setting the battery alarm display to ON or OFF

Setting the detect level/detect time of human sensor

Adjusting brightness

Language Switching message languages Page 56 Language

Unique information Setting the GOT ID number Page 58 Unique Information

IP address Setting the GOT IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway Setting the GOT operation when a device with the same IP address as that of the GOT is added to the network afterwards.

Page 60 IP Address

IP filter setting Setting IP addresses from which access to the GOT is allowed or blocked

Page 67 IP Filter Setting

Operation Setting the buzzer volume and window move buzzer Page 71 OperationSetting a musical interval for the buzzer sound

Setting the key sensitivity and key reaction speed

Setting the access switch for the drive A

Utility call key Setting the utility call keys Page 74 Utility Call Key

USB host Setting the USB mouse and keyboard *6 Page 77 USB Host

Time Displaying and setting the clock current time Page 80 Time

Controller Assign Ethernet I/F Setting the assign Ethernet I/F Page 99 ControllerChannel - Driver

assign Displaying the communication driver assigned to each channel

- Changing assignment

Changing the assigned communication driver

5 V power supply Setting 5 V power supply for channel No. 1

Communication detail setting

Setting communication parameters, setting or deleting sequence program protection key words, canceling sequence program protection status (When connecting to FX series CPU)

Ethernet communication Displaying the contents of Ethernet setting, changing the host

Page 116 Ethernet Communication

Transparent mode Setting the channel No. to be used for the communication for the FA transparent function

Page 122 Transparent Mode

GOT internal device monitor Setting whether to use the GOT internal device monitor of the GOT diagnostics function

Page 124 GOT Internal Device Monitor

Security Security level authentication

Authenticating security levels Page 126 Security

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.2 Utility Function List 37

38

Maintenance Operator authenticat ion

Operator management

Managing operator Page 128 Operator AuthenticationPassword change Changing a password

Function setting Setting the operator authentication function

Extended function setting

SoftGOT-GOT link function Setting the SoftGOT-GOT link function Page 158 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function

VNC server function Setting the VNC server function Page 163 VNC Server Function

Sequence program monitor Starting the sequence program monitor Page 165 Sequence Program Monitor

Backup/restoration setting Setting the backup and restoration Page 167 Backup/ Restoration

- Trigger backup setting

Setting the trigger backup Page 171 Trigger Backup

- Trigger time setting

Setting the trigger time

License management Displaying the screen for registering and releasing the license

Page 174 License Management

Video/RGB Displaying the screen for setting the video/RGB I/O unit *3 Page 176 Video/RGB

Multimedia Displaying the screen for setting the multimedia *3 Page 184 Multimedia

Wireless LAN connection function Setting the wireless LAN connection function *5 Page 199 Wireless LAN Function

System launcher Configuring a setting to enable the online module change in the system launcher function

Page 204 System Launcher

iQSS utility Setting a drive for a data storage containing the profile data of iQSS-compatible equipment

Page 206 iQSS Utility

ANDON connection Setting the IP address of a client targeted for the ANDON connection

Page 208 ANDON Connection

Ethernet printer Setting the IP address of the Ethernet printer Page 211 Ethernet Printer

Network drive setting Setting the network drive Page 213 Network drive setting

Item Functions overview Applicable GOT Reference

GT27 GT25 GT23

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.2 Utility Function List

1

Maintenance Batch self check Executing various diagnostics collectively and copying the result to a data storage

Page 216 Batch Self Check

USB device management Displaying the status of USB device Page 219 USB Device Management

Cleaning Displaying the screen for cleaning the display Page 221 Screen Cleaning

Touch panel calibration Adjusting the touch panel Page 223 Touch Panel Calibration

System alarm Displaying the system alarm Page 226 System Alarm

Drawing check Checking the drawing Page 228 Drawing Check

Font check Checking the font Page 232 Font Check

Touch panel check Checking the touch panel Page 234 Touch Panel Check

I/O check Checking the I/O of RS-232 interface Page 236 I/O Check

Ethernet status check Checking the connection status of Ethernet Page 241 Ethernet Status Check

GOT information Displaying the GOT information Page 243 GOT Information

GOT Mobile information Displaying the GOT Mobile function settings Page 245 GOT Mobile Information

Item Functions overview Applicable GOT Reference

GT27 GT25 GT23

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.2 Utility Function List 39

40

Monitor System launcher Starting the system launcher Page 247 Monitor Screens

Device monitor Starting the device monitor

Sequence program monitor (Ladder)

Starting the QCPU or LCPU sequence program monitor

Sequence program monitor (iQ-R ladder)

Starting the RCPU sequence program monitor

Sequence program monitor (iQ-F ladder)

Starting the FX5CPU sequence program monitor

FX ladder monitor Starting the FX ladder monitor

Network monitor Starting the network monitor

Intelligent module monitor Starting the intelligent module monitor

Servo amplifier monitor Starting the servo amplifier monitor

Q motion monitor Starting the Q motion monitor

R motion monitor Starting the R motion monitor

CNC monitor Starting the CNC monitor *1 *2

CNC monitor 2 Starting the CNC monitor 2 *4

Sequence program monitor (SFC) Starting the SFC monitor

Q Motion SFC monitor Starting the Q motion SFC monitor

R Motion SFC monitor Starting the R motion SFC monitor

Log viewer Starting the log viewer

Network status display Starting the network status display *7

FX list editor Starting the FX list editor *4

CNC machining program edit Starting the CNC machining program edit *1 *2

CNC data I/O Starting the CNC data I/O *1 *2

Motion Program Editor Starting the motion program editor *1 *8

Motion Program I/O Starting the motion program I/O *1 *8

MELSEC-L troubleshooting Starting the MELSEC-L troubleshooting

iQSS utility Starting the iQSS utility

Drive recorder Starting the drive recorder

CC-Link IE diagnostics Starting the CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field Network diagnostics

Servo amplifier graph Starting the servo amplifier graph

Vision sensor monitor Starting the vision sensor monitor

Item Functions overview Applicable GOT Reference

GT27 GT25 GT23

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.2 Utility Function List

1

*1 Available to GT27-X and GT27-S. *2 Only available to GT25-S. *3 GT2705-V does not support. *4 Not available to GT25-W. *5 Not available to GT2505-V and GT25HS-V. *6 Not available to GT25HS-V. *7 Not available to GT25-W, GT2505-V, and GT2505HS-V. *8 Available to GT25-S, GT2512-WX, and GT2510-WX.

Data management

Alarm information Deleting or copying alarm log files Page 255 Alarm Information

Converting alarm log files in G2A format CSV/TXT format

Image file management Deleting/copying image files, changing image file names Page 262 Image File Management

Recipe information Converting recipe files in G2P CSV/TXT format, deleting/copying/moving/creating recipe files, deleting/ moving/changing recipe folder names, writing/reading/ verifying record values with the recipe record list, deleting device values

Page 269 Recipe Information

Logging information Converting logging files in G2L format CSV/TXT format

Page 304 Logging InformationDeleting/copying/moving logging files, changing logging

file names

Operation log information Converting operation log files in G20 CSV/TXT format Page 318 Operation Log Information

Deleting, copying, moving, or renaming an operation log file, deleting or creating an operation log folder

File manager Deleting, copying, moving or renaming a folder or file, sorting the list of folders and files, or creating a folder

Page 341 File Manager

File Print Printing or previewing a report file Page 356 File Print

Package data management Installing/uploading package data, checking the property Page 363 Package Data Management

Backup/restoration Starting the backup/restoration function Page 374 Backup/ Restore Function

SRAM management Confirming the SRAM user area usage, backing up or restoring the data in the SRAM user area, and initializing the SRAM user area

Page 375 SRAM management

Memory card format Formatting a data storage Page 381 Memory Card Format

Memory check Write/read check of a data storage and built-in flash memory

Page 384 Memory Check

GOT data package acquisition Copying the data stored in the GOT to an SD card in a batch

Page 387 GOT Data Package Acquisition

Item Functions overview Applicable GOT Reference

GT27 GT25 GT23

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.2 Utility Function List 41

42

1.3 Utility Display To display each setting screen of the utility, the main menu has to be displayed first. Even when the GOT is installed vertically, the utility screen appears horizontally. In the utility main menu, message dialogs appear according to the vertical installation.

1)Main menu The menu items that can be set at the GOT utility are displayed. Touching a menu item in the main menu will display the setting screen or subsequent selection screen for the item. 2)System message switch button This button switches the language used for the utility or system alarms. When touching the [Language] button, the Select Language screen is displayed.

1. Touch the button of the language to be displayed.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT for the selected language to take effect in the utility. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

(1)

(2)

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display

1

When starting the GOT without selecting any language or the selected language and the installed fonts are not matched The following screen will be displayed. Touching the button of a desired language restarts the GOT and the language is switched to the selected one.

Selectable languages The system message switch button is displayed only for the selectable languages. The selectable languages differ depending on the fonts installed in the GOT. For the relation between the selectable languages and the fonts, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual System language switching using the device The system language can be switched using the system language switching device set with GT Designer3. For the setting method of the system language switching device, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display 43

44

Display operation of main menu The following three types of operation can display the main menu. (Display the main menu after installing the basic system application from GT Designer3 to the GOT built in flash memory.)

When project data is undownloaded If the power supply of GOT turns ON, the main menu is displayed automatically after title display.

When touching menu call key If you touch the menu call key while user-created screen is displayed, the main menu is displayed. The menu call key is set in the position on the GOT screen upper left corner at factory shipment.

The menu call key can be set by the GOT utility or GT Designer3. For the setting method of the utility call key, refer to the following. Page 75 Utility call key setting operation GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Prohibited simultaneous 2-point presses Do not touch 2 points or more on the GOT screen simultaneously. Touching 2 points or more simultaneously may activate a part other than the touched point. When setting menu call key to 1-point When having set [Pressing time] of the menu call key setting screen to other than "0 (s)", keep pressing the touch panel for the period set to [Pressing time] or more before leaving the finger from the touch panel. For menu call key setting, refer to the following. Page 75 Utility call key setting operation

Turning on the power supply of the GOT

GOT basic setting

GOT basic setting Utility call key

Touch a top left corner.

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display

1

When touching special function switch (utility) If you touch the special function switch (utility) while user-created screen is displayed, the main menu is displayed. The special function switch (utility) can be set as a touch switch that is displayed on a user-created screen by GT Designer3.

For the details of the special function switch, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Locking the utility display by password When you try to display the utility main menu while the password is set to the GOT by GT Designer3, the display for password input will be appeared. (Set a password from the common setting menu.)

When the password is not matched, displays the error message.

When touching the [OK] button, the screen returns to the monitor screen.

Input operation of password 1. Input the password after touching [0] to [9], [A] to [F] key.

2. Define the password by touching [Enter] key, after password input.

3. To correct the input character, touch [Del] key to delete the correcting character and reinput/retype the new character.

Password input cancel operation When the [] button is touched, it returns to the monitor screen. Refer to the following for the details related to the password setting. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

GOT basic setting

Special function switch (Utility)

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display 45

46

Utility basic configuration The basic configuration of utility is as follows.

Title display The screen title name is displayed in title display part. As the screen is composed of multiple layers, the title including these layers is displayed.

Close/Return button When a middle screen of the layers is displayed, if the (Close/return) button in the right corner of screen is touched, returns to the previous screen. If this button is touched when directly displayed from monitor screen, the screen is closed and returns to monitor screen.

Scroll button For screens in which the content does not fit on one screen page, there is a right or down scroll button on the screen.

/ / / / Scroll one line/column. / / / / Scroll window.

Title display Close/Return button

Scroll button

Screen

Title display

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display

1

Basic operation to change the settings

Change of setting value

Setting item, select button Touch a select button to change the setting. The setting methods differ depending on the setting items. The following setting methods are available. Changing the setting Touch the select button to change the setting. Enter the setting value with a keyboard. Touch the button to display a keyboard on the GOT screen. Move to another setting screen. Touch the button to move to another setting screen. For the setting method of each setting item, refer to the setting operation of each setting screen.

[OK] button, [Cancel] button, [] (Close/Return) button Reflect or cancel the changed settings. [OK] button Touch this button to reflect the changed settings and return to the previous screen. Depending on the setting item, the GOT restarts. [Cancel] button Touch this button to cancel the changed settings and return to the previous screen. [] (Close/Return) button Touch this button to display the following dialog. (If no setting is changed, the dialog is not displayed.) Operate following the message of the dialog.

Setting item

Select button

Close/Return button

Example: [Operation] screen

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display 47

48

MEMO

1 UTILITY FUNCTION 1.3 Utility Display

2

2 GOT BASIC SETTING Page 50 Display Page 56 Language Page 58 Unique Information Page 60 IP Address Page 67 IP Filter Setting Page 71 Operation Page 74 Utility Call Key Page 77 USB Host Page 80 Time Page 99 Controller Page 116 Ethernet Communication Page 122 Transparent Mode Page 124 GOT Internal Device Monitor Page 126 Security Page 128 Operator Authentication Setting screen for display and setting screen for operation can be displayed from the GOT utility screen. In the setting screen for display and the setting screen for operation, the following settings can be set.

Item Description Reference Display Opening screen time, screen save time, battery alarm display, human sensor,

sensor detect level, sensor detect time, sensor off delay, brightness adjustment mode, brightness adjustment, POWER LED

Page 50 Display

Language Language setting Page 56 Language

Unique information Number setting, GOT name display, GOT description display Page 58 Unique Information

IP address Ethernet communication unit, IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, peripheral software port No., transparent port No., behavior of duplicate IPs

Page 60 IP Address

IP filter setting Settings of the IP filter usage, filtering method, target IP address, and exception IP address

Page 67 IP Filter Setting

Operation Buzzer sound, musical interval, window move buzzer volume, Key sensitivity, Access switch for the drive A

Page 71 Operation

Utility call key Call key setting, pressing time setting Page 74 Utility Call Key

USB host USB mouse setting, interlock with mouse cursor touch operation, USB keyboard setting, USB keyboard type setting

Page 77 USB Host

Time Time setting Current time, GOT internal battery voltage status Page 80 Time

Adjust Adjust the clock, mode, reference CH No., SNTP IP address, trigger type, specify the time zone of target unit, time zone, time difference from GMT

Broadcast Broadcast the clock data, broadcast CH No., trigger type, specify the time zone of target unit, time zone, time difference from GMT

Local time Specify time zone, time zone, time difference from GMT

Controller The setting contents of the communication interface can be checked or changed. Page 99 Controller

Ethernet communication The contents of the Ethernet setting can be checked and the host can be changed. Page 116 Ethernet Communication

Transparent mode Channel No. setting Page 122 Transparent Mode

GOT internal device monitor Setting whether to use the GOT internal device monitor of the GOT diagnostics function

Page 124 GOT Internal Device Monitor

Security Security level authentication Page 126 Security

Operator authentication Operator management, password change function setting Page 128 Operator Authentication

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 49

50

2.1 Display Display setting Configure display settings. The items which can be set are shown below. When each item part is touched, the respective setting becomes possible.

*1 If setting 0, the title screen is not hidden. The title screen is always displayed for 4 seconds or longer (which changes depending on the project data contents).

*2 The monitoring time corresponding to the sensor detect level (0 to 10) is as follows. As the sensor detect level becomes greater, the sensitivity of the human sensor becomes higher.

*3 For BootOS version D or earlier, the [Standard] mode is specified. *4 For GT23, the brightness can be adjusted in 16 levels.

The following table shows the correspondences between values set in the utility and the brightness in 16 levels.

*5 GT23 does not support.

Item Description Setting range Opening screen time The title display period at the main unit boot can be set. 0 to 60 seconds *1

Screen save time The period from the user stops the touch panel operation till the screen save function starts can be set.

0 to 60 minutes *1

Battery alarm display Whether to display system alarm when the voltage of the GOT internal battery has dropped can be specified.

ON/OFF

Human sensor Screen saver status cancel by human sensor can be set to Effective or Invalid.

Valid/Invalid

Sensor detect level *2 The sensor detect level can be set. 0 to 10

Sensor detect time *2 The time corresponding to the [Sensor detect level] is displayed. (setting is disabled) When the [Sensor detect level] is changed, the corresponding time is reflected by touching [OK] button.

0 to 4

Sensor off delay The time period from when the human sensor detects no human movement until the Human Sensor Detection Signal (System Signal 2-1.b5) turns OFF can be set.

0Min 10Sec to 60Min 0Sec

Brightness adjustment mode*3 The brightness adjustment mode can be set to the standard or low intensity mode.

Standard/Low

Brightness adjustment The brightness can be adjusted. 1 to 32*4

POWER LED*5 Turning on/off the POWER LED can be set. Turning on/off

Sensor detect level 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0

Sensor detect time [s] 0 0.1 0.2 0.4 0.8 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 4

Setting value 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32

Brightness adjustment (16 levels) 1 2 3 4 13 14 15 16

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display

2

Display setting by GT Designer3 Set the title display period and screen save time in [GOT setup] in [Environmental Setting] of GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Screen save time Using the system information function can compulsorily switch the controller to the screen saving status (Forced Screen Saver Disable Signal) or disable the screen save time (Automatic Screen Saver Disable Signal) set with Utility. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Display control by human sensor The human sensor is a function that releases the GOT from the screen saving mode without the necessity to touch the GOT. This function releases the GOT from the screen saving mode when the operator has come closer to the GOT.

Refer to the following for the Human Sensor Detection Signal (System Signal 2-1.b5). GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual When setting the human sensor to invalid Even if setting the human sensor to invalid by the utility, the Human Sensor Detection Signal (System Signal 2-1.b5) turns ON when the human sensor detects human movement. Unintended operation may result, therefore, if controlling the Forced Screen Saver Enable Signal (System Signal 1-1.b1) and Human Sensor Detection Signal associating them with each other by a sequence program, etc. When setting the human sensor to invalid, review the related sequence program, etc. Restrictions when a backlight failure is detected When the brightness adjustment mode is set to [Low] mode, the GOT cannot detect the backlight failure. To detect the backlight failure, set the brightness adjustment mode to [Standard]. Restrictions on the screen display in the [Low] mode In the [Low] mode, the screen may flicker, or the screen display may turn off. If you do not use the GOT in a dark place, set the brightness adjustment mode to [Standard]. When the utility screen is difficult to see in the [Low] mode Touch the upper-left corner of the main menu for two seconds to change the mode to the [Standard] mode. When the utility screen transitions to a user-created screen, the mode is returned to the [Low] mode.

ON OFF

Operator motion [Sensor detect level]

Human Sensor Detection Signal [System Signal 2-1.b5]

[Sensor detect time]

Approach Go away Approach Go away

[Sensor off delay]

Screen saver

Screen saving mode released Screen saver mode activated

[Screen save time]

[Sensor off delay]

When there is no operator around the GOT for the time set as "Sensor OFF delay", the "Human Sensor Detection Signal" turns OFF. When the time set as the "Screen save time" elapses after the "Human Sensor Detection Signal" turns OFF, the GOT enters the screen saving mode.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display 51

52

Display operation of display

Display setting operations

Opening screen, screen save time 1. Touch the setting item (numeral) to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

Display

Touch [Display].

GOT basic setting

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display

2

Battery alarm display 1. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

Human sensor 1. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display 53

54

Sensor detect level, sensor off delay 1. Touch the setting item (numeral) to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard. To move the cursor, touch the or button.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

Brightness adjustment mode 1. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display

2

Brightness adjustment 1. Touch the [+] or [-] key to adjust the brightness.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Display] screen. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Display] screen.

POWER LED 1. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.1 Display 55

56

2.2 Language Language setting Configure language settings.

*1 Only selectable languages are displayed. The selectable languages differ depending on the fonts installed in the GOT. For details of the fonts, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of language display

Item Description Setting range Language*1 Confirmation of the current language and switching language can be performed

regarding with the language displayed by utdility and dialog. (Japanese) (English) (Chinese (Simplified)) (Chinese (Traditional)) (Korean)

Language

GOT basic setting

Touch [Language].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.2 Language

2

Setting operation of language

Language 1. If touch the language to be displayed, the language is selected.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Selectable languages The system message switch button is displayed only for the selectable languages. The selectable languages differ depending on the fonts installed in the GOT. For the relation between the selectable languages and the fonts, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual System language switching using the device The system language can be switched using the system language switching device set with GT Designer3. For the setting method of the system language switching device, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.2 Language 57

58

2.3 Unique Information Unique information setting Configure unique information settings.

Display operation of unique information

Item Description Setting range GOT ID No. Set the ID No. as the unique information for the GOT. 0 to 32767

Unique information

GOT basic setting

Touch [Unique info].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.3 Unique Information

2

Setting procedure for unique information

GOT ID No. 1. Touch the setting item to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.3 Unique Information 59

60

2.4 IP Address IP address setting Set the IP address and others.

Item Description Setting range Ethernet comm. unit Set whether to use the Ethernet communication unit. Effective/Invalid

IP Address Check or set the IP address. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 Ethernet standard port, Ethernet standard port 1

Ethernet extension port, Ethernet standard port 2

Wireless LAN I/F

Subnet Mask Check or set the subnet mask. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Default Gateway Check or set the router address of the default gateway. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Per. S/W wireless port No. Set the port number for the GOT to use peripheral software. 1024 to 5010, 5014 to 49152, 49171 to 65534

Transparent port No. Set the port number for the GOT to use the FA transparent function. 1024 to 5010, 5014 to 49152, 49171 to 65534

Behavior of duplicate IPs Set the behavior of the GOT to be performed when a device with the same IP address as the GOT is connected to the network afterwards.

Maintain a network connection (rec)/Do not maintain a network connection

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address

2

Display operation of IP address

If the Ethernet setting is changed with applicable GOT special registers (GS), the GOT may not operate with the new Ethernet setting displayed in the utility. Therefore, restart the GOT to reflect the new setting.

IP address(For GT27)

GOT basic setting

Touch [IP address].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address 61

62

Setting procedure for the IP address

Ethernet standard port, Ethernet standard port 1, and wireless LAN I/F IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, peripheral software port No., and transparent port

No. 1. Touch the entry box for the setting item to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard. Example) For GT27

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

Settings of [Per. S/W port No.] and [Transparent port No.] You cannot set the same port number for [Per. S/W port No.] and [Transparent port No.]. Set a different port number for each setting item.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address

2

Behavior of duplicate IPs This item is settable in [Ethernet standard port] or [Ethernet standard port 1].

1. Touch the selection for the setting item to switch the selection. This setting determines the behavior of the GOT when a device with the same IP address connects to the network on which the GOT resides. [Maintain a network connection (rec)] Displays a system alarm, and maintains the network connection for the GOT. [Do not maintain a network connection] Disconnects the GOT from the network. Example) For GT27

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address 63

64

Ethernet extension port and Ethernet standard port 2 IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, peripheral software port No., and transparent port

No. 1. Touch the selection for [Ethernet comm. unit] to switch to [Effective].

2. Touch the entry box for the setting item to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard. Example) For GT27

3. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

Assignment to an extension interface The Ethernet extension port is assigned to an unused extension interface with the lowest stage number. If all extension interfaces are occupied, the Ethernet extension port cannot be assigned.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address

2

Behavior of duplicate IPs 1. Touch the selection for the setting item to switch the selection. This setting determines the behavior of the GOT when a device with the same IP address connects to the network on which the GOT resides. [Maintain a network connection (rec)] Displays a system alarm, and maintains the network connection for the GOT. [Do not maintain a network connection] Disconnects the GOT from the network. Example) For GT27

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address 65

66

Precautions

IP address setting Set an IP address for each interface to access a different network.

When the GOT connects to the network on which a device with the same IP address resides The GOT goes into an offline state, and displays the following dialog. Example) For GT27

Change the IP address of the GOT or the device. When changing the IP address of the device Specify a new IP address for the device, and touch the [Reboot GOT] button to restart the GOT. When changing the IP address of the GOT Touch the [Clear IP Address] button to clear the GOT IP address. Then, touch the [Reboot GOT] button to restart the GOT, and specify a new IP address for the GOT.

Selection for [Behavior of duplicate IPs] When [Do not maintain a network connection] is selected for [Behavior of duplicate IPs], if a device with the same IP address as the GOT connects to the same network, the GOT becomes disconnected from the network. Thus, incorrect setting of IP addresses or any malicious action may disable the relevant GOT to communicate, affecting the system control. Make sure to consider the necessity to change the selection for [Behavior of duplicate IPs] before doing so.

Using a switching hub compatible with the Spanning Tree Protocol For the switching hub port connected with the GOT, configure the setting (PortFast or others) that makes the GOT be ready for communications (forwarding state). Thus, the Spanning Tree Protocol does not cause a delay upon connection. Without the setting, the Ethernet IP address duplication is detected incorrectly. Additionally, the GOT may not connect to the Ethernet network correctly. For the setting that makes the GOT be ready for communications (forwarding state), refer to the users manual for the switching hub used.

[Ethernet port 1]: [Ethernet standard port] tab [Ethernet port 2]: [Ethernet extension port] tab

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.4 IP Address

2

2.5 IP Filter Setting IP filter setting IP addresses from which access to the GOT is allowed or blocked can be set. For the details of the IP filter setting, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

*1 Leave the boxes blank if you do not set any IP addresses.

Item Description Setting range IP filter usage You can set whether to use or not the IP filter function. Yes/No

Access from the following address You can set whether to allow or block access from the IP addresses that set in the filtering list. If [Transmit] is selected

Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Target IP address] is blocked. Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Exception IP address] is disallowed. If [Block] is selected

Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Target IP address] is blocked. Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Exception IP address] is allowed.

Transmit/Block

Range You can set whether to register IP addresses by specifying a range. To specify a range, set the start IP address and the end IP address for [Target IP address].

Selected/Not selected

Target IP address You can set IP addresses or IP address ranges to be filtered. Up to 32 ranges can be set.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255*1

Exception IP address This item can be set only when [Range] is selected. For an IP address range specified in [Target IP address], set IP addresses excluded from being filtered. Up to 32 addresses can be set for one range specified in [Target IP address].

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255*1

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.5 IP Filter Setting 67

68

Display operation of the IP filter setting

IP filter setting

Touch [IP filter setting].

GOT basic setting

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.5 IP Filter Setting

2

Setting procedure for the IP filter

Setting IP addresses 1. Touch the down arrow of the [IP filter usage] list box and select [Yes].

2. Touch the down arrow of the [Access from the following address] list box and select [Transmit] or [Block].

3. Touch a start IP address entry box in the [Target IP address] section in the filtering list to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

4. For specifying an IP address range and setting an IP address excluded from a specified range, refer to the following. Specifying IP address ranges Page 69 Specifying IP address ranges Setting exception IP addresses Page 70 Setting exception IP addresses

5. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button. To change the setting for each item to its default, touch the [Default] button.

Specifying IP address ranges 1. Touch the checkbox in the filtering list to display the end IP address entry boxes in the [Target IP address] section.

2. In the filtering list, touch any IP address entry box in [Target IP address] to display a software keyboard. Input a value for each box with the keyboard.

1.

3. 2.

5.

1. 2. 2.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.5 IP Filter Setting 69

70

Setting exception IP addresses [Exception IP address] can be set only when [Range] is selected.

1. Touch the exception IP address display button to open the exception IP address list.

2. Touch an exception IP address entry box to display a software keyboard. Input a value for each box with the keyboard.

3. Touch the exception IP address display button to close the exception IP address list.

1.3.2.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.5 IP Filter Setting

2

2.6 Operation Operation setting Setting regarding GOT operation can be set. The items which can be set are described below. If touch the each item part, the respective setting becomes possible.

*1 Relation between the [Key sensitivity] setting and reaction speed The larger the set value in [Key sensitivity] is, the shorter the time taken from touching the touch panel until the GOT responds becomes. E.g. decrease the value set for [Key sensitivity] when double-touch is made when touching the GOT screen only once. (Decrease the reaction speed.)

Operation setting by GT Designer3 Set buzzer volume and window move buzzer volume by [GOT setup] in [Environmental Setting] of GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Setting range Buzzer volume setting Buzzer volume setting can be changed. OFF/SHORT/LONG

Musical interval setting The setting of the musical interval for the buzzer sound can be changed. 1 to 5

Window move buzzer volume setting Whether turn ON/OFF buzzer when move window can be selected. ON/OFF

Key sensitivity setting The touch panel sensitivity when touching the GOT screen can be set. E.g. a setting can be changed when double-touch is made when touching the GOT screen only once. (For preventing chattering)

1 to 8*1

Access switch for the drive A Set whether to access drive A or not while the cover of an SD card interface is open.

Unignore/Ignore

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.6 Operation 71

72

Display operation of operation

Operation

GOT basic setting

Touch [Operation].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.6 Operation

2

Setting operation of operation

Buzzer sound, musical interval, window move buzzer volume, access switch for the drive A 1. If touch the setup item, the setup contents is changed.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Key sensitivity setting 1. If touching the setting items, keyboard is displayed. Input numeric with the keyboard.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.6 Operation 73

74

2.7 Utility Call Key Utility call key setting The key position for calling the main menu of the utility can be specified. For the key position, the specification of 1 point from 4 corners on the screen, or no specification, can be set. (No specification can be set when GT Designer3 is used.) By keeping pressing the screen, a setting to switch the screen to the utility is available. This prevents a switching to the utility by an unintentional operation.

Operation setting by GT Designer3 Set the utility call key at [GOT set up] in [Environmental Setting] of GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of the utility call key setting

Utility call key

GOT basic setting

Touch [Utility call key].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.7 Utility Call Key

2

Utility call key setting operation 1. Touch or displayed at the 4 corners of the setting screen. The button repeats with every

touch Set the corner to be specified as a key position to . For the key position, up to 1 point can be specified. When the key position is not specified, displaying the utility with the utility call key is not available.

2. When setting 1 point, specify the time to switch to the utility in case of keeping pressing the key position. Touch the time input area.

3. Touching the input area displays a keyboard. Input numeric with the keyboard.

4. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Operation] screen. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Operation] screen.

5. In the [Operation] screen, touching the [OK]/[Cancel]/[] button restarts and operates the GOT with the changed settings.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.7 Utility Call Key 75

76

When the utility call key is not specified The followings are the method for displaying the utility without using the utility call key.

Changing the project data in GT Designer3 1. Read the project data in GT Designer3.

2. Set either of the followings in GT Designer3. Set the utility call key in the [Display/Operation] tab of the [Environmental Setting] dialog. Set a special function switch to display the utility at the user-created screen.

3. Write the project data whose setting is changed to the GOT.

Operating the forced start-up of the utility with the GOT After powering on the GOT, pressing the S.MODE switch during [Booting] displayed on the upper left displays the utility in the screen. To display the utility on GT2505-V, power on the GOT, and press the lower right of the screen while [Booting] is being displayed on the upper left of the screen. When restricting the display of the utility, set a password in GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Precautions on using the alarm popup display When [Display Position Switching] is set to [Switch] in the alarm popup display setting, set either of the following for the utility call key. Setting the position of the utility call key to the upper-right or lower-left corner Setting [Pressing Time] of the utility call key to 1 or more seconds When [Pressing Time] is set to 0 and the key position is set to the lower-left corner, the operation is as described below. If the positions of the key and the alarm popup display overlap, the utility screen appears by switching the display position of the alarm popup display. For the alarm popup display, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.7 Utility Call Key

2

2.8 USB Host USB host setting To install and use the USB mouse/keyboard on the GOT, set the USB mouse/keyboard.

Display operation of the USB host setting

Item Description Setting range Use USB mouse Set whether to use a USB mouse. YES/NO

Interlock with mouse cursor touch operation

The mouse cursor can be moved to the touched position. YES/NO

Use USB keyboard/USB barcode Set whether to use a USB keyboard or a USB barcode reader. YES/NO

USB keyboard type Set the USB keyboard type. Japanese 106 keyboard/English 101 keyboard

USB host

GOT basic setting

Touch [USB host].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.8 USB Host 77

78

Setting operation of USB host 1. To use a USB mouse, touch the current selection of [Use USB mouse]. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. To move the mouse cursor to a touched position, touch the current selection of [Interlock with mouse cursor touch operation].

Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

3. To use a USB keyboard or a USB barcode reader, touch the current selection of [Use USB keyboard/USB barcode]. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.8 USB Host

2

4. To use a USB keyboard, touch the current selection of [USB keyboard type]. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

5. Touch the [OK] button to reflect the new settings and return to the [USB Host] screen. To cancel the new settings, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [USB Host] screen.

6. In the [Operation] screen, touch the [OK] button, [Cancel] button, or [] button to restart the GOT to operate with the new settings.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.8 USB Host 79

80

2.9 Time Clock synchronization method The following shows the clock synchronization method on the GOT.

Clock synchronization method Description Time setting function Acquire the clock data of the controller or the SNTP server and change the clock data of the GOT.

When the GOT is powered on, set the clock data of the GOT to that of the controller or the SNTP server. Since the GOT does not have to hold the clock data while the GOT is powered off, no battery is required. (If the GOT needs to hold the clock data at startup, install a battery in the GOT.) To set the controller clock data of the controller, refer to the manual of the controller you use.

Time notification function Notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller to change that of the controller.

At the timing of the trigger, set the clock data of the controller to that of the GOT. Since the GOT must hold the clock data while the GOT is powered off, a battery is required. Set the clock data of the GOT in the utility.

Using the clock adjustment function and the time notification function together

Acquire the clock data of the controller or the SNTP server by the clock adjustment function. Then change the clock data of other controllers by the time notification function. Then change the clock data of other controllers by the time notification function.

Clock data

2013/4/1 12:45:07

2013/4/1 12:45:07

Clock data

2013/4/1 12:45:07

2013/4/1 12:45:07

SNTP server GOT

PLC GOT

Clock data

2013/4/1 12:45:07

2013/4/1 12:45:07

adjustment Clock

2013/4/1 12:45:07

2013/4/1 12:45:07

SNTP server GOT

Time

2013/4/1 12:45:07

function notification

function

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

When connecting to an external device which does not have clock function If the GOT is connected to an external device (such as a PLC or microcomputer) that has no clock function, setting [Adjust] or [Broadcast] does not synchronize the clock data between the GOT and external device. For the list of the PLCs having the clock function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used Details of the clock synchronization method For the details of the clock synchronization method, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 81

82

Time setting Set the current time.

Time setting and battery The GOT built-in battery is not connected to the GOT at factory default. To use the time notification function, connect the GOT built-in battery and then configure the time setting. For information on how to connect the GOT built-in battery, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

Time setting

Display operation of the time setting

Item Description Reference Current time Carry out the display and setup of GOT clock data. Page 83 Current time

GOT internal battery voltage status Displays GOT internal battery voltage status. Page 84 GOT internal battery voltage status

Time (Time setting)

GOT basic setting

Touch [Time].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Setting procedure for the time setting Current time Carry out the display and setting of GOT clock data. The setup methods of clock data are shown below.

1. Touch the current date and time to display the keyboard and stop the clock update.

2. Input date and time with the keyboard by referring to the table below. The input date and time are reflected after step 3 is performed. The day of the week on the input date is displayed automatically. The following shows the setting range of the date. Jan. 1, 2000 to Dec. 31, 2099

3. To reflect the new setting and return to the Main Menu, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the new setting and return to the Main Menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

Time display The GOT displays the current time to which the local time setting is reflected. For the local time setting, refer to the following. Page 96 Local time Changing times If you have changed the present time of the GOT where the time setting function or the time notification function was being used, the new time setting will be written to the PLC. Thus, you can change the time of the PLC from the GOT even when the time setting function is being used. For details of [Adjust] and [Broadcast], refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Key Description [0] to [9] Input numeric value in cursor position.

Move the cursor.

[Del] Move the cursor to the left by one character when [Del] Key is touched while inputting year, month, day, time, minutes, seconds.

[Enter] Close the keyboard after the input time is displayed in clock display.

[Cancel] Cancel the input time and returns the time of clock display to the time at which the keyboard was displayed and close the keyboard.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 83

84

GOT internal battery voltage status Displays battery voltage status.

When the battery voltage is low, replace the battery immediately. Refer to the following for battery replacement procedure. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

Display Status Normal Normal

Low/None Voltage drop or no battery installed

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Adjusting the clock Synchronize the clock data of the GOT with the clock data of the controller.

Clock adjustment setting

*1 If you set this item to [SNTP server], set [Time zone] to the time zone of the local time. Page 96 Local time

*2 If [Adjust the clock] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, only [Sampling] is selectable as the trigger type for the clock adjustment in the utility.

*3 If [Adjust the clock] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, [No setting] is displayed in [Device].

Settings of [Adjust] in the utility Configure the settings in the utility and in [GOT Setup] on GT Designer3 by the same method. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Item Description Setting range Adjust the clock Set whether to use the clock adjustment function. Yes (selected)/No (deselected)

Mode Set the clock adjustment mode.*1 External unit/SNTP server

Reference CH No. When selecting [External unit] for [Mode], set a reference channel of the controller.

1 to 4

SNTP IP address When selecting [SNTP server] for [Mode], set the IP address of the SNTP server. Touch the [Connection test] button to check the connection with the SNTP server.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Trigger type Set the trigger type for the clock adjustment.*2

When selecting [Sampling] for [Trigger type], set the sampling interval for the clock adjustment.

When selecting [Rise] or [Fall] for [Trigger type], information on the device set as a trigger is displayed.*3

Trigger type: Rise/Fall/Sampling Sampling interval: 1 to 1440

Specify the time zone of target unit Set whether to specify the time zone of the target controller. Selected/Not selected

Time zone When selecting [Specify the time zone of target unit], set the time zone.

GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00/Custom

Time difference from GMT When selecting [Custom] for [Time zone], set the time difference based on GMT.

Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 85

86

Display operation of the clock adjustment

Time (Time setting)

GOT basic setting

Touch [Time].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Setting procedure for the clock adjustment Adjust the clock 1. To synchronize the clock data of the GOT with the clock data of the controller, select [Adjust the clock].

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Mode 1. Touch the setting item and select a setting from the list.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 87

88

Reference CH No. 1. Touch the setting item and select a setting from the list.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

SNTP IP address 1. Touch the setting item to display a software keyboard. Input a value for each box with the keyboard.

2. Touch the [Connection test] button to check the connection with the SNTP server.

3. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Trigger type 1. Touch the setting item and select a setting from the list.

2. If you select [Sampling], set the sampling interval for the clock adjustment. Touch the entry box on the left side of [Min.] to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Specify the time zone of target unit 1. To specify the time zone of the target controller, select [Specify the time zone of target unit].

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 89

90

Time zone 1. Touch the up or down button on the right side of the time zone entry box to change the setting.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Time difference from GMT 1. To change the setting of [hour], touch the up or down button on the left side of [hour]. To change the setting of [Min.], touch the pull-down menu button on the left side of [Min.] and select an item from the list.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Broadcasting the clock data Notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller for synchronization with the GOT.

Time notification setting

*1 If [Broadcast the clock data] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, only [Sampling] is selectable as the trigger type for the time notification in the utility.

*2 If [Broadcast the clock data] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, [No setting] is displayed for the device.

Settings of [Broadcast] in the utility Configure the settings in the utility and in [GOT Setup] on GT Designer3 by the same method. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Item Description Setting range Broadcast the clock data Set whether to use the time notification function. Selected/Not selected

Broadcast CH No. Set a channel used for the time notification. CH 1, CH 2, CH 3, CH 4

Trigger type Set the trigger type for the time notification.*1

When selecting [Sampling] for [Trigger type], set the sampling interval for the time notification.

When selecting [Rise] or [Fall] for [Trigger type], information on the device set as a trigger is displayed.*2

Trigger type: Rise/Fall/Sampling Sampling interval: 1 to 1440

Specify the time zone of target unit Set whether to specify the time zone of the target controller. Selected/Not selected

Time zone When selecting [Specify the time zone of target unit], set the time zone.

GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00/Custom

Time difference from GMT When selecting [Custom] for [Time zone], set the time difference based on GMT.

Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 91

92

Display operation of the time notification

GOT basic setting

Touch [Time]. Time (Broadcast tab)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Setting procedure for the time notification Broadcast the clock data 1. To notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller for synchronization with the GOT, select [Broadcast the clock data].

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Broadcast CH No. 1. Touch a channel number to select it.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 93

94

Trigger type 1. Touch the setting item and select a setting from the list.

2. If you select [Sampling], set the sampling interval for the time notification. Touch the entry box on the left side of [Min.] to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Specify the time zone of target unit 1. To specify the time zone of the target controller, select [Specify the time zone of target unit].

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Time zone 1. Touch the up or down button on the right side of the time zone entry box to change the setting.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Time difference from GMT 1. To change the setting of [hour], touch the up or down button on the left side of [hour]. To change the setting of [Min.], touch the pull-down menu button on the left side of [Min.] and select an item from the list.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 95

96

Local time Set the time zone of the local time in the clock data of the GOT.

Local time setting

Display operation of the local time

Item Description Setting range Specify time zone Set whether to specify the time zone in the clock data of the GOT. Selected/Not selected

Time zone When selecting [Specify time zone], set the time zone. GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00/Custom

Time difference from GMT When selecting [Custom] for [Time zone], set the time difference based on GMT.

Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

GOT basic setting

Touch [Time]. Time (Local time)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

Setting procedure for the local time Specify time zone 1. To set the time zone, select [Specify time zone].

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

Time zone 1. Touch the up or down button on the right side of the time zone entry box to change the setting.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time 97

98

Time difference from GMT 1. To change the setting of [hour], touch the up or down button on the left side of [hour]. To change the setting of [Min.], touch the pull-down menu button on the left side of [Min.] and select an item from the list.

2. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.9 Time

2

2.10 Controller Controller setting Configure controller settings. The items which can be set are shown below. When each item part is touched, the respective setting becomes possible.

Communication detail setting display operation

Function Description Assign Ethernet I/F Change the assignment of channel No. and communication driver name of the device connected using the

Ethernet interface.

Channel-Driver assign Change the assignment of channel No. and communication driver name.

Channel no. (Ch No.) setting Set the channel numbers of the communication interface (Standard interface/Extend interface).

5 V power supply When connecting a controller to the RS-232 interface, whether to supply 5 V DC power or not to the controller through 9 pins can be selected.

Communication Detail Setting Set communication parameters of communication devices.

Controller(For GT27)

GOT basic setting

Touch [Controller].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 99

10

Controller contents This section describes setting items and display contents for a controller.

1)Channel-Driver assign Assignment of communication drivers to channels Even without setting [Controller Setting] on GT Designer3, communication with controller is available by assigning channel No. with this function. Page 104 Channel-Driver assign operation Changing the assignment of communication drivers to channels Without using GT Designer3, the assignment of communication drivers to channels can be changed. When change a communication driver, the alternative communication driver has to be installed in GOT in advance. 2)Standard interface display box The standard communication interfaces of the GOT are displayed. There are the following 4 types.

3)Extension interface display box The name of the unit installed in the extension interface is displayed. (Displays [None] when any unit is not mounted.) For details of each unit, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

RS-232 For communicating with a controller

RS-422/485 For communicating with a controller

USB (Device) For communicating with a personal computer (GT Designer3)

Ethernet For communicating with a personal computer (GT Designer3) or a controller

1)6)

4)

2)

5)

3)

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

4)Channel number specification menu box Set the channel number used for a standard interface or extension interface. For communication drivers that can be assigned to channels, refer to the following. 5)Communication driver display box

*1 The channels cannot be assigned with the Ethernet I/F assignment. *2 The same device cannot be used for Ch No.5 to Ch No.8 simultaneously.

For restrictions on external devices, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

5)Communication driver display box Displays the name of the communication driver assigned to a channel or the communication driver set in the controller setting of GT Designer3. For details on communication drivers to be displayed, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Display [None] in the driver display box in case of the followings. The communication driver is not installed. In the channel number specification menu box, [0] is set. The type of the communication unit mounted on the extension interface does not correspond to the set communication

driver. For how to set the communication driver, refer to the following. Page 104 Channel-Driver assign operation 6)Assign Ethernet I/F The communication settings for the Ethernet connection can be made. Ethernet I/F Assignment can assign up to four channels per interface. Page 103 Assign Ethernet I/F operation

0 Set when the communication interface is not used.

1 to 4 Set when connecting to a controller. (Except a barcode reader, an RFID controller, and a personal computer)

5 to 8*1*2 Set when connecting to a barcode reader, an RFID controller or a PC.

9*1 Set when connecting to a personal computer (GT Designer3). When the USB interface is used, the channel number is fixed to [9].

A Set this item when using the following functions. Gateway function MES interface function Ethernet download Report function Hard copy function (for output to a printer) Video display function RGB display function RGB output function External I/O function Operation panel function Sound output function Multimedia function Remote personal computer operation function VNC server function Wireless LAN connection function

- When the Ethernet communication unit is used, the channel number is fixed to [-].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 101

10

Precautions for communications between GOT and controller Installing a communication driver and downloading communication setting data To communicate with a controller, perform the following to the communication interface 1) 1) Install a communication driver (up to four drivers). 2) Assign a channel number and the communication driver to the communication interface. 3) Download the project data including the setting configured in step 2) above. Perform 1), 2), 3) by GT Designer3.

Refer to the following for details. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

When the communication setting data is not downloaded. The GOT automatically assigns the installed communication driver in the order of 1) to 3) as follows. (This automatic assignment is applied to the extension interface only.)

1): ChNo.1, Communication driver installed at 1st 2): ChNo.2, Communication driver installed at 2nd 3): ChNo.3, Communication driver installed at 3rd After communication driver is assigned automatically. When saving the settings to the GOT with [OK] button after the automatic assignment of communication driver, automatic assignment will not be performed at the next time and after. Priority against [Controller Setting] of GT Designer3 If download the communication settings to the GOT with GT Designer3 after the automatic assignment, the GOT will operate with the communication settings of GT Designer3. (The GOT operates with the latest communication settings.)

When the communication driver does not match with the unit that is installed in the GOT An error is displayed on the GOT when displaying [Communication setting]. If an error is displayed, confirm the combination of the communication driver and communication unit. Refer to the following manual for the combination. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used

1) 2) 3)

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

Controller setting operation

Assign Ethernet I/F operation The following describes how to operate the Ethernet I/F assign. The setting operation is same as that of the communication setting screen.

1. Touch the [Assign Ethernet I/F] button in [Communication setting].

2. After the screen shown below is displayed, touch the channel number specification menu BOX when changing the channel number.

Page 106 Channel number setting operation

3. For changing the parameter settings, touch the driver display BOX. Page 108 Communication detail setting

4. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Communication setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Communication setting] screen.

5. In the [Communication setting] screen, touching the [OK]/[Cancel]/[] button restarts and operates the GOT with the changed settings.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 103

10

Channel-Driver assign operation The following describes how to operate the Channel-Driver assign. The following description uses an example of changing the serial communication connection to the direct CPU connection (serial).

Before the operation The GOT automatically restarts after executing this setting. If project data has been downloaded, the GOT starts monitoring of the controller after restarting. Execute this setting after carefully confirming the safety.

1. IInstall the communication driver [Serial(MELSEC)] to the GOT. (Download of [Controller Setting] from GT Designer3 is not required.) After installing communication driver, touch the [Channel Driver assign] button in [Channel-Driver Assign].

2. Select a communication driver to be assigned for each channel on the screen displayed as below.

3. As the communication driver ([Serial(MELSEC)]) installed in the GOT is displayed, touch it.

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

4. The screen returns to the [Channel-Driver assign] screen. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Communication setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Communication setting] screen.

5. Confirm that the selected communication driver ([Serial(MELSEC)]) is assigned.

6. After the confirmation, if touch the [OK]/[Cancel]/[] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 105

10

Channel number setting operation 1. Touch channel number specification menu BOX to be set.

2. The cursor for the channel number specification menu BOX is displayed. Simultaneously the keyboard for a numerical input is displayed.

3. Input the channel number from the keyboard and touch [Enter] key, and the value is defined. Simultaneously, the name of the communication driver corresponding to the channel number assigned by GT Designer3 is displayed in the driver display BOX.

Communication detail setting switching operation 1. If the driver display BOX is touched on the communication setting screen or Ethernet I/F assign screen, the screen

switches to the detailed setting screen of the related controller device. Page 108 Communication detail setting

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

5V power supply setting operation When connecting a controller to the RS-232 interface, whether to supply 5 V DC power or not to the controller through 9 pins can be selected. Thus, it is not necessary to connect an external power supply.

1. Touch [5V supply].

2. Check that the 5V power supply is selected.

3. If touch the [OK]/[Cancel]/[] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings.

Host (PC) settings The communication driver of [USB] is fixed to [Host(PC)].

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 107

10

Communication detail setting

Communication detail setting

Before setting a keyword How to select a keyword protection level For equipments that are allowed to operate the FX PLC on line, 3 levels of protection level can be set. When performing monitoring or changing settings with any on-line equipment is required, set password with referring to the following. When setting keyword only Select a protection level by the initial letter of keyword. All operation protect: Set a keyword with initial letter of "A", "D" to "F", or "0" to "9". Read/Incorrect write protection: Set a keyword with initial letter of "B". Incorrect write protect: Set a keyword with initial letter of "C". When setting keyword and 2nd keyword Select a protection level by [Registration condition].

Monitoring availability at each keyword protection level Device monitoring availability at each keyword protection level is shown in the following.

Difference between all online operations prohibition and all operations prohibition When specifying All online operations prohibited, displaying devices and inputting data with a programming tool or GOT are all prohibited. When all operations are prohibited, displaying devices and inputting data with the GOT are enabled while all operations using a programming tool are prohibited.

Function Description Communication parameters setting Set various communication parameters of communication devices.

The settable parameters differ according to the communication device.

Keyword setting For the FX series PLCs, key word for protecting program in the PLC can be set.

Key word deleting For the FX series PLCs, key word for protecting program in the PLC can be deleted.

Key word protection cancel For the FX series PLCs, the program protection status in the PLC can be cancelled.

Keyword protection For the FX series PLCs, the cancelled program protection status in the PLC can be returned to the protection status again.

Item When setting keyword only When setting keyword and 2nd keyword Keyword not registered or protection canceled

All operation protect

Read/ Incorrect write protection

Incorrect write protect

All on-line operation protect

Read/write protect

Write protect

Monitoring devices

Changing devices

T, C set value and file register (D1000 and the following)

Other than the above

8 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

Display operation of the communication detail setting Communication setting 1. Touch the target communication driver display box to set the communication parameter.

Communication using the Ethernet communication unit If the Ethernet communication unit is assigned to an extension interface, the corresponding communication detail setting cannot be displayed.

2. The screen switches to the detail setting screen. Set communication parameters from this screen. Refer to the following for the setting change operation. Page 47 Basic operation to change the settings

Communication parameter setting by GT Designer3 Set the communication parameters for each communication driver at [Communication Settings] in [Controller Setting] of GT Designer3. When change the communication parameters after downloading project data, change the setting at communication detail setting of GOT. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual For the Ethernet multiple connection Touch the driver display BOX of the Ethernet connection, and then the communication detail setting screen of Channel No. 1 is displayed.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 109

11

Ethernet I/F assignment Several communication drivers are assigned to an Ethernet interface, whereas only one GOT IP address is assigned to an Ethernet interface. By changing the settings of one interface, the GOT IP address, GOT port No. download, default gateway and subnet mask settings of other drivers, which are assigned to the same interface, are also changed.

1. Touch the [Assign Ethernet I/F] button in [Communication setting].

2. Touch the driver display BOX of the communication parameter to be set in the [Ethernet I/F assignment] screen.

3. The screen switches to the detail setting screen. Set communication parameters from this screen. Refer to the following for the setting change operation. Page 47 Basic operation to change the settings

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

Communication parameter setting by GT Designer3 Set the communication parameters for each communication driver at [Communication Settings] in [Controller Setting] of GT Designer3. When change the communication parameters after downloading project data, change the setting at communication detail setting of GOT. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 111

11

Display contents of communication detail setting What to set in the communication detail setting varies depending on the communication driver type. This section explains the settings when MELSEC-FX or CC-Link IE TSN is selected as a communication driver. For setting items other than described in this section, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

MELSEC-FX When MELSEC-FX is selected as a communication driver, the following operations can be performed for a keyword. Registration Deletion Protection delete Protection

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

Registration Register key words.

1. Touching the [Regist] key pop-up displays the keyboard for inputting a keyword.

2. Input a keyword and touch the [Enter] key, and the registration completes. Up to 8 characters can be set for keyword with using A to F and 0 to 9.

*1 The access restriction can be selected from [Read/Write Protect], [Write Protect], and [All Protect]. For access restriction on each setting, refer to the following manual. The User's Manual of the FX series PLC you are using

Deletion Delete a registered keyword.

1. Touching the [Delete] key pop-up displays the keyboard for inputting a keyword.

2. Input a key word and touch the [Enter] key, and the keyword is deleted.

PLC connected Setting

When registering keyword and 2nd keyword When registering keyword only FX CPU compatible with 2nd keyword [Registration condition]*1 can be selected. [Registration condition]*1 cannot be selected.

FX CPU not compatible with 2nd keyword -

PLC connected Setting FX CPU compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to delete.

FX CPU not compatible with 2nd keyword Input the keyword to delete only into the keyword. The 2nd keyword will be ignored.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 113

11

Protection delete Delete the protection by key word in order to access to a FX PLC to which a key word is registered.

1. Touching the [Clear] key pop-up displays the keyboard for inputting a keyword.

2. Input a keyword and touch the [Enter] key to delete the protection.

Protection Reset the keyword in which protection has been deleted to the protection status.

1. Touch the [Protect] key, and the keyword goes to a protected status.

PLC connected Setting FX CPU compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to delete the protection.

FX CPU not compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to delete only into the keyword. The 2nd keyword will be ignored.

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller

2

CC-Link IE TSN When CC-Link IE TSN is selected as a communication driver, the following items are settable on the [Detail setting: IP Address] screen. IP Address Subnet Mask Default Gateway

1. Touch the [IP Address] button to display the [Detail setting: IP Address] screen.

2. Touch the entry box for the setting item to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. Touch the [OK] button to apply the new settings and return to the [Detail setting] screen. To cancel the new settings, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [Detail setting] screen.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.10 Controller 115

11

2.11 Ethernet Communication Ethernet setting The Ethernet setting, which has been configured with GT Designer3, can be checked. The host station setting, network number, station number, and IP address are changeable. For the Ethernet setting, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used

Display operation of the Ethernet setting

If the Ethernet setting is changed with applicable GOT special registers (GS), the GOT may not operate with the new Ethernet setting displayed in the utility. Therefore, restart the GOT to reflect the new setting.

Ethernet setting

GOT basic setting

Touch [Ethernet].

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication

2

Display contents of Ethernet setting The following describes the setting items and the display contents of the Ethernet setting.

1)Channel select tab Channels can be switched. Switching to the channel which does not have the Ethernet setting is not available. [*] is displayed on the right side of the channel whose setting is changed. 2)Ethernet setting items The contents of the Ethernet setting configured in GT Designer3 are displayed. Changing [Host], [Net No.], [Station No.] and [IP Address] are available. Page 118 Change of host Page 119 Change of Net No. Page 120 Change of station No. Page 121 Change of IP address

How to cancel the change of the setting in the [Ethernet setting] screen. Cancel the settings changed in the [Ethernet setting] screen with the [Restore default settings] button. The changed settings remain until they are canceled with the [Restore default settings] button. The changed settings are not canceled even if writing the project data or system application to the GOT. When the project data is written to the GOT without canceling the changed settings, those changed settings are reflected to the Ethernet setting of the written project data. (If the written project data does not have a channel with same Ethernet settings as that of the channel changed in [Ethernet setting] screen, the changed settings are not reflected.)

(1)

(2)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication 117

11

Change of host 1. Touch the device to be set as the host.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. TTouch the [Cancel] button to cancel the changed settings and return to the [Controller] screen.

8 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication

2

Change of Net No. 1. Touch the Net No. to be changed, and input the network No. to be changed by the numeric keypad displayed.

2. Touch the [Enter] button and [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the changed settings and return to the [Basic Setting] screen.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication 119

12

Change of station No. 1. Touch the station No. to be changed, and input the station No. of the destination Ethernet module to be changed by the

numeric keypad displayed.

2. Touch the [Enter] button and [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the changed settings and return to the [Basic Setting] screen.

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication

2

Change of IP address 1. Touch the IP address to be changed, input the destination IP address to be changed by the numeric keypad displayed.

2. Touch the [Enter] button and [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the changed settings and return to the [Basic Setting] screen.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.11 Ethernet Communication 121

12

2.12 Transparent Mode Transparent mode setting When using the multi-channel function, the channel No. of a controller to which the FA transparent function is executed can be set. For the multi-channel settings, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Electric Products) For GT Works3 Version1 GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Also, refer to the following for the FA transparent function. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Electric Products) For GT Works3 Version1

Display operation of the transparent mode setting

Function Description Setting range ChNo. The channel No. of a controller to which the FA transparent function is executed can be set. 1/2/3/4

Transparent mode

GOT basic setting

Touch [Transparent mode].

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.12 Transparent Mode

2

Operation the transparent mode 1. Touching the transparent ChNo. (numerical part) shown below, the keyboard is displayed. Input numerical value by the keyboard.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the Main Menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.12 Transparent Mode 123

12

2.13 GOT Internal Device Monitor GOT internal device monitor setting Set whether to use the GOT internal device monitor of the GOT diagnostics function.

Display operation of the GOT internal device monitor

Item Description Setting range Use GOT internal device monitor of GOT diagnostics

Set whether to use the GOT internal device monitor of the GOT diagnostics function. Selected/Not selected

Allow GOT internal device change Set whether to allow the GOT internal device change. YES/NO

GOT internal device monitor

GOT basic setting

Touch [GOT Internal device monitor].

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.13 GOT Internal Device Monitor

2

Setting procedure for the GOT internal device monitor 1. To use the GOT internal device monitor of the GOT diagnostics function, select the item shown below.

2. To allow the values of the GOT internal devices to be changed, touch the current selection of [Allow GOT internal device change].

Switch between the selections with each touch.

3. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. To cancel the new setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.13 GOT Internal Device Monitor 125

12

2.14 Security Security level authentication

Security level change functions Authenticates the security level set by each object or screen switch. Refer to the following for the security level. Security level setting GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Password setting GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Restrictions on screen display The security level change screen cannot be displayed when project data do not exist in GOT. Change the security level after downloading the project data to GOT.

Display operation of security level

Security level authentication

GOT basic setting

Touch [Security].

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.14 Security

2

Setting operation of security level Password input operation 1. By touching [0] to [9], [A] to [F] key, the password of the changed security level is input. When correcting the input character, touch [Del] key to delete the correcting character and input the password again.

2. After inputting password, touch the [Enter] key. When the password matches, the normal completion message is displayed.

If the password does not match, the error message is displayed. Touch the [OK] button to return to the password entry screen.

About forgetting to return to the original level after changing security level temporarily When use GOT after temporarily changing the security level, do not forget to return the security level to the original level.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.14 Security 127

12

2.15 Operator Authentication Operator management

Operator management Operator management function The function enables displaying a list of the operator information and adding, changing, or deleting the operator information to be used. A password for operator authentication can be changed when the password is out of date. Functions for the operator authentication (automatic logout time, authentication method, password expiration date, etc.) can be set. For the details of the operator authentication functions, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Reference Operator management

Enables adding, editing, deleting, importing, and exporting the operator information. Page 130 Display operation of operator management Page 133 Operator management operation

Add operation Add operator information to the GOT. Page 135 Add operation

Edit operation Edit the operator information stored in the GOT. Unlock an operator ID.

Page 139 Edit operation

Deletion Delete the operator information stored in the GOT. Page 141 Deletion operation

Undo Restore the current operator information to the previous saved one. Page 142 Undo operation

Import operation Import the operator information that is already exported to a CF card to the GOT. Page 144 Import operation

Export operation Export the operator information stored in the data storage. Page 146 Export operation

Password change Enables changing passwords to be used for login and logout in/out of the GOT. Page 148 Export operation

Function setting Set the following items. Operator authentication method Automatic logout time Password expiration date Password expiration prenotification Start position of the external authentication ID Number of bytes of the external authentication ID Sub administrator setting Displaying uneditable operator information Security level required to change the function setting Continuous failure count to block login Login prohibition time Continuous failure count to lock an operator ID Password requirements Password history

Page 151 Password change operation

8 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Administrator and sub administrator Administrator refers to the account preset in the GOT for management use only. (Operator name: Administrator, operator ID number: -) The administrator can register, edit, or delete the operator management information on each operator. The administrator can also change the function setting for the operator authentication in the utility. However, the administrator cannot log in as an operator to perform operations on the GOT. Sub administrator refers to an operator with administrator privileges. The sub administrator can register, edit, or delete the operator management information on an operator having a lower security level. The sub administrator can also change the function setting for the operator authentication in the utility. To enable the use of sub administrators, configure the relevant setting in [Function setting] in the utility. For the setting, refer to the following. Page 153 Function setting operation To grant administrator privileges to an operator, set the operator management information on the operator. For the details of the operator management information, refer to the following. Operator information edit screen (: Available, : Not available)

*1 A sub administrator can manipulate the operator management information on an operator having a lower security level. *2 To set this item, a sub administrator must have security level 15. *3 A sub administrator having a security level lower than the level specified in [Allow function setting] cannot configure the settings.

Settings in the utility Administrator Sub administrator

When [Allow functionsetting] is selected

When [Allow functionsetting] is deselected

Operator management Registering, editing, or deleting the operator management information

*1 *1

Editing the operator management information on the administrator

*2

Function setting Settings other than the administrator setting

*3

Administrator setting

Enabling the use of sub administrators

Displaying uneditable operator information

*2

Allowing the function setting to be changed

Security level required to change the function setting

*2

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 129

13

Display operation of operator management

Operator management

GOT basic setting

Operator authentication

Touch [Operator authentication].

Touch [Operator management].

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Display example of operator management Operator information management screen

No. Item Description (a) Status Displays the operator status.

: Operator with administrator privileges : Operator in the disabled state

(b) [Operator Name] Displays operator names.

(c) [ID] Displays operator IDs.

(d) [Level] Displays security levels for operators.

(e) [PW Update] Displays the updated dates of the operators' passwords.

(f) [Lock status] Displays a checkmark in the row of the operator whose account is locked after consecutive failed login attempts.

(g) Operation keys Execution keys for each function

(h) Drive in use Displays and sets the storage location for imported and exported operator information. To switch the drive, touch the key. (A: Built-in SD card/B: USB drive/E: USB drive/F: USB drive/G: USB drive) Only when the drive B, drive E, drive F, or drive G is installed on the GOT, the user can switch the drive.

(a)

(b) (c) (d)

(g)

(h)

(e) (f)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 131

13

Operator information edit screen Touch the [Add] button or touch the [Edit] button with the operator information selected on the Operator information management screen, and then the Operator information edit screen is displayed. The operator information can be edited.

No. Item Description (a) [Operator Name] Displays the operator name, or input an operator name.

Up to 16 alphanumeric characters, symbols, and one-byte spaces can be entered per operatorname.

(b) [Operator ID] Displays the operator ID, or input an operator ID. (Setting range: 1 to 32766) The maximum number of registrations depends on the GOT model. GT27, GT25: 1000 GT23: 255

(c) [Level] Displays the security level of the operator, or input a security level for the operator. (0 to 15)

(d) [Password] Input a password. Up to 32 alphanumeric characters, symbols, and one-byte spaces can be entered per password. You are recommended to set an unpredictable password consisting of uppercase and lowercase alphabetic characters, numbers, and symbols.

(e) [Grant admin authority] Grants administrator privileges to the operator, which changes the operator to a sub administrator. For the sub administrator privileges, refer to the following. Page 129 Administrator and sub administrator

(f) [Make a permanent password] Sets or does not set a permanent password. When this item is selected, the password does not expire regardless of the set password expiration date.

(g) [Disable the operator] Disables the operator account. The disabled operator account is not usable for login. To enable the operator account, deselect this item.

(h) [Change password at next login] Prompts for a password change at the next login. This item becomes deselected after the password change. An operator cannot log in with the unchanged password.

(i) [Use ext. auth. ID] Uses or does not use the external authentication ID.

(j) [Ext.auth. ID] Displays the external authentication ID in hexadecimal or input an external authentication ID in hexadecimal. The setting range is 4 to 32 alphanumeric characters from A to F and 0 to 9. Page 151 Function setting

(k) [Unlock] Unlocks the operator account.

(h)

(a)

(k)

(e) (f) (g)

(i)

(d)

(b)

(c)

(j)

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Operator management operation 1. Touch [Operator management] in the operator setting menu.

2. The Admin password authentication screen is displayed, and then input the administrator password. If [Use sub administrator] is selected on the function setting screen, enter the operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

If the administrator password authentication is succeeded in the invalid login state, the invalid login state is cleared.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 133

13

3. When the administrator password is correctly input, the Operator information management screen in displayed. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following.

[Add] Page 135 Add operation [Edit] Page 139 Edit operation [Delete] Page 141 Deletion operation [Undo] Page 142 Undo operation [Import] Page 144 Import operation [Export] Page 146 Export operation

4. After all settings are completed, touch the [Save] button, and then the settings are saved.

5. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Save] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Add operation Add operator information to the GOT.

1. Touch the [Add] button.

2. The Operator information edit screen is displayed, and then touch an item to be edited.

1) 2) 3)

4) 5)

6) 7) 8)

9) 10)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 135

13

1)[OperatorName] Touch the OperatorName, and then the Operator name input dialog is displayed. Input an operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

2)[OperatorID] Touch the Operator ID, and then the Operator ID input dialog is displayed. Input an operator ID. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

3)[Level] Touch the level, and then the Operator level input dialog is displayed. Input an operator level. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. When the level of the operator being login is changed during editing the operator information, a new level is not reflected until you log out of the GOT once and log in the GOT again.

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

4)[Password] For changing passwords during editing, touch the password. The New password input dialog is displayed, and then input a password. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. When the password input is completed, the New password input confirmation dialog is displayed. Input the same password.

5)[Grant admin authority] To grant administrator privileges to the operator, touch the check box to select this item.

: Do not grant : Grant

For the sub administrator privileges, refer to the following. Page 129 Administrator and sub administrator 6)[Make a permanent password] To set a permanent password, touch the check box to select this item.

: Do not set : Set

7)[Disable the operator] To disable an operator account, touch the check box to select this item.

: Enable : Disable

8)[Change password at next login] To prompt for a password change at the next login, touch the check box to select this item.

: Do not prompt : Prompt

9)[Use ext. auth. ID] To use an external authentication ID, touch the check box to select this item.

: Do not use : Use

10)[Ext.auth. ID] Touch this item to display an input dialog, and input an external authentication ID in the dialog. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. When the authentication method is set to [External auth (serial)] or [External auth (USB)], you can input the external authentication ID with an external authentication device.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 137

13

3. Touch the [OK] button after all items are input, and then the dialog shown below is displayed and the input operator information is added.

4. Touch the [Cancel] button or the [] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

8 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Edit operation Edit the operator information stored in the GOT.

1. Select the operator information to be edited with touching the operator information.

2. Touch the [Edit] button.

3. The Operator information edit screen is displayed, and then touch an item to be edited. For information on how to edit the items, refer to the following. Page 135 Add operation

1)Unlock To unlock an operator ID, touch the [Unlocked] button.

1)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 139

14

4. Touch the [OK] button after all items are input, and then the dialog shown below is displayed and the input operator information is changed.

5. Touch the [Cancel] button or the [] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

When GS621.b1 is ON, editing of the disabled operator account is prohibited. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Even if GS621.b1 is ON, you can restore the disabled operator account by touching the [Undo] button on the [Operator information management] screen. For details on the undo operation, refer to the following. Page 142 Undo operation

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Deletion operation Delete the operator information stored in the GOT.

1. Select the operator information to be deleted with touching the operator information.

2. Touch the [Delete] button to display the dialog shown below. To delete the selected operator information, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the deletion, touch the [Cancel] button.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog is displayed. Touching the [OK] button closes the dialog box.

When GS621.b0 is ON, deletion of operator accounts is prohibited. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Even if GS621.b0 is ON, you can cancel the addition of an operator account by touching the [Undo] button on the [Operator information management] screen. For details on the undo operation, refer to the following. Page 142 Undo operation

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 141

14

Undo operation Restore the current operator information to the previous saved one.

1. Touch the [Undo] button.

2. The dialog shown below is displayed, and then touch the [OK] button.

3. The Admin password authentication screen is displayed, and then input the administrator password. If [Use sub administrator] is selected on the function setting screen, enter the operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

4. When the administrator password is correctly input, the current operator information is restored to the previous saved one.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 143

14

Import operation Import the operator information that is already exported to an SD card to the GOT.

1. Touch the [Import] button.

2. The dialog shown below is displayed, and then touch the [OK] button.

3. When [Delete password history on import] is selected on the function setting screen, the dialog that confirms deleting the password history appears. Click the [OK] button.

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

4. The Admin password authentication screen is displayed, and then input the administrator password. If [Use sub administrator] is selected on the function setting screen, enter the operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. When the administrator password is correctly input, the operator information stored in an SD card is imported to the GOT.

5. The dialog shown below is displayed, and then touch the [OK] button.

When GS621.b2 is ON, the [Import] button is inactivated. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 145

14

Export operation Export the operator information stored in the GOT to an SD card.

1. Touch the [Export] button.

2. The dialog shown below is displayed. Touch the following buttons according to the output format for the file. Binary file: [Binary] button CSV file: [CSV] button

3. The dialog shown below is displayed. Touch [OK] button, and then the Admin password authentication screen is displayed. Input the administrator password. If [Use sub administrator] is selected on the function setting screen, enter the operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

4. When the administrator password is correctly input, the dialog shown below is displayed and the operator information stored in the GOT is exported to an SD card.

(file name: AUTHINF.G2U)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 147

14

Password change

Password change Password change function The passwords to be used for the operator authentication can be changed. For the password change, log into the GOT in advance with the operator name corresponding to the password to be changed.

Display operation of password change

Password change

GOT basic setting

Operator authentication

Touch [Password change].

Touch [Operator authentication].

8 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Password change operation 1. Log into the GOT with the operator name corresponding to the password to be changed on the Main Menu screen for the

utility.

2. Touch [Password change] in the operator setting menu, and then the Password change dialog is displayed.

3. Input the current password on the Password change dialog. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 149

15

4. Input a new password.

5. After inputting a new password, input the new password again.

6. When the new password is correctly input, the dialog shown below is displayed and the password is changed.

0 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Function setting

Function setting Function setting The functions for the operator information can be set. The following items can be set.

*1 If the number of login attempts has reached the invalid login count, another login attempt fails for a certain period of time. To immediately clear the invalid login state without waiting for the prohibition time, perform the administrator password authentication on the operator management screen. Page 133 Operator management operation

Setting item Description Reference Auth method Switch between the authentication methods. ([Operator name + password],

[External auth (serial)], [External auth (USB)]) When [External auth (serial)] or [External auth (USB)] is selected, the [Enable operator name/pswd authentication] check box appears.

1)[Auth method]

Automatic logout time Set the time period from when the last operation is performed on the GOT until when the automatic logout is performed. (1 to 60 minutes, 0: invalid)

2)[Automatic logout time]

Password expiration date Set the item for regularly changing the password to be used for the operator authentication. (1 to 1000 days, 0 is invalid.) When the password is out of date after setting the password, the GOT requests the password change.

3)[Password expiration date]

Adv. notification Set the number of days before password expiration to start notifying the password expiration date. (1 to 30 days, 0: invalid)

4)[Adv. notification]

Initial position input Set the initial position input (byte count) of external authentication ID from among the data read from the external authentication device. (0 to 1998 bytes)

5)[Initial position input]

Valid byte count input Set the valid byte count for external authentication ID. (2 to 16 bytes) 6)[Valid byte count input]

Admin setting Set whether to enable the use of sub administrators. Set whether to display editable operators only or display all the operators. Set whether to allow sub administrators to change the function setting. Set the security level of the sub administrator who can edit the function setting.

7)[Admin setting]

Upon login failure, prohibit login for a set period of time*1

Set the continuous failure count to block login. (3 to 10 times, 0: invalid) Set the prohibition time. (1 to 3600 seconds)

8)[Continuous failure count] 9)[Prohibition time]

Upon login failure, lock the operator (individually)

Set the continuous failure count to lock an operator ID. (3 to 10 times, 0: invalid) 10)[Continuous failure count]

Check password requirements Set whether to check the number of characters and the character types of a password.

11)[Set password requirements]

Set minimum length Set the minimum number of characters of a password. (1 to 32 characters)

Set character type Set the character types of a password. [No check]: Does not check the character types of a password. [[A-Z, a-z]/[1-9, Other]]: Checks if a password contains letters and another type

of characters. [[A-Z, a-z]/1-9/Other]: Checks if a password contains letters, numbers, and

another type of characters. [A-Z/a-z/1-9/Other]: Checks if a password contains uppercase and lowercase

letters, numbers, and another type of characters.

Set number of histories Set the number of passwords used. (1 to 5, 0 is invalid.) 12)[Set password history]

Delete password history on import Set whether to delete the password history when the operator management information file is imported.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 151

15

Display operation of function setting

Function setting

GOT basic setting

Operator authentication

Touch [Function setting].

Touch [Operator authentication].

2 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

Function setting operation 1. Touch [Function setting] in the operator setting menu, and then the Admin password authentication dialog is displayed.

2. Input the administrator password. If [Use sub administrator] is selected on the function setting screen, enter the operator name. Character types to be input can be changed with touching the following buttons. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [a-z]: Alphabet small letter [0-9]: Numeric When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

3. When the administrator password is correctly input, the Function setting screen in displayed. Touch an item to be set.

6)

8) 9)

10) 11)

1)

2) 3) 4) 5)

7) 12)

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 153

15

1)[Auth method] Switch the authentication method. Touch the current selection to switch the authentication method between [Operator name + password], [External auth (serial)], and [External auth (USB)]. When [External auth (serial)] or [External auth (USB)] is selected, the [Enable operator name/pswd authentication] check box appears. Select the checkbox to also perform authentication through an operator name and password at login. 2)[Automatic logout time] Touch the entry box of [Automatic logout time] to display the [Automatic logout time edit] dialog. Input the time. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key.

3)[Password expiration date] Touch the entry box of [Password expiration date] to display the [Password expiration date edit] dialog. Input the expiration date. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key.

4)[Adv. notification] Touch the entry box of [Adv. notification] to display the [Enter advance notification days] dialog. Input the number of days. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. 5)[Initial position input] Touch the entry box of [Initial position input] to display the [Ext. auth. ID initial position input] dialog. Input the start position. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. 6)[Valid byte count input] Touch the entry box of [Valid byte count input] to display the [Ext. auth. ID valid byte count input] dialog. Input the number of bytes. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. (Only available when the [External auth (serial)] or [External auth (USB)] is set as the authentication method.)

4 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

2

7)[Admin setting] To use sub administrators, select [Use sub administrator].

: Do not use : Use

To display uneditable operator information, select [Display operators without edit permission]. : Do not display : Display

To allow sub administrators to change the function setting, select [Allow function setting]. : Do not allow : Allow

Selecting this item displays the [Operator level input] dialog. Specify the security level required to change the function setting. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. When a sub administrator having security level 14 or less logs into the GOT, this setting item is not displayed. For the authority of the sub administrator, refer to the following. Page 129 Administrator and sub administrator 8)[Continuous failure count] Touch the entry box of [Continuous failure count] to display the [Continuous failure count input] dialog. Input the maximum number of consecutive failed login attempts. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. 9)[Prohibition time] Touch the entry box of [Prohibition time] to display the [Prohibition time input] dialog. Input the prohibition time. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. 10)[Continuous failure count] Touch the entry box of [Continuous failure count] to display the [Continuous failure count input] dialog. Input the maximum number of consecutive failed login attempts. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. For information on how to unlock an operator ID, refer to the following. Page 139 Edit operation 11)[Set password requirements] To check for password requirements, select [Check password requirements].

: Do not check : Check

Touch the entry box of [Set minimum length] to display the [Enter minimum password length] dialog. Input the number of characters. Touch the entry box of [Set character type] to make a selection. After completing the entry, touch the [Enter] key. 12)[Set password history] Touch the entry field of [Set number of histories] to display the [Number of password histories input] dialog. Enter the number of passwords used. When the authentication method is set to [External auth (serial)] or [External auth (USB)], and [Enable operator name/pswd authentication] is deselected, this item is disabled. Set whether to delete the password history by selecting or deselecting [Delete password history on import].

: Do not delete : Delete

When [Set number of histories] is set to 0, this item is disabled. Although [Set password history] is disabled, the settings of [Set password history] are retained when the [OK] button is touched. The settings are enabled when [Set password history] is enabled.

2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication 155

15

4. After all settings are completed, touch the [OK] button, and then the settings are saved. If you touch the [] button without touching the [OK] button, the dialog shown below is displayed

5. The dialog shown below is displayed, and then touch the [OK] button.

6 2 GOT BASIC SETTING 2.15 Operator Authentication

3

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING Page 158 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function Page 163 VNC Server Function Page 165 Sequence Program Monitor Page 167 Backup/Restoration Page 171 Trigger Backup Page 174 License Management Page 176 Video/RGB Page 184 Multimedia Page 199 Wireless LAN Function Page 204 System Launcher Page 206 iQSS Utility Page 208 ANDON Connection Page 211 Ethernet Printer Page 213 Network drive setting You can display the setting screens for the extended functions from the GOT utility. The following table lists the extended functions and their setting contents in the corresponding screens.

Item Description Reference SoftGOT-GOT link function Setting the authorization of the SoftGOT-GOT link function, obtaining or releasing the

exclusive authorization Page 158 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function

VNC server function Setting the authorization guarantee time for the VNC server function Page 163 VNC Server Function

Sequence program monitor Specifying the destination location to store sequence programs, setting the ladder editor (iQ-R ladder)

Page 165 Sequence Program Monitor

Backup/restoration Specifying the destination location to store backup data Page 167 Backup/Restoration

Trigger backup Setting the trigger backup Page 171 Trigger Backup

License management Registering or deleting a license Page 174 License Management

Video/RGB Configuring the video unit settings, video display settings, and RGB display settings Page 176 Video/RGB

Multimedia Configuring the video unit settings, video setting, and long time recording settings Page 184 Multimedia

Wireless LAN Setting the wireless LAN communication unit, listing the connected stations, and setting the destination access point

Page 199 Wireless LAN Function

System launcher Configuring a setting to enable the online module change from the system launcher Page 204 System Launcher

iQSS utility Setting a drive of the data storage in which profile data of iQSS-compatible devices is stored

Page 206 iQSS Utility

ANDON connection Setting the IP address of a client targeted for the ANDON connection Page 208 ANDON Connection

Ethernet printer Setting the IP address of the Ethernet printer Page 211 Ethernet Printer

Network drive setting Setting the network drive Page 213 Network drive setting

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 157

15

3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function SoftGOT-GOT link function setting The authorization of the SoftGOT-GOT link function can be set, and the exclusive authorization can be obtained or released. Only the GOT can obtain the exclusive authorization. While the GOT has the exclusive authorization, GT SoftGOT2000 cannot obtain the authorization. For the details of the SoftGOT-GOT link function, refer to the following. GT SoftGOT2000 Version1 Operating Manual

Relationship with the GOT network interaction function setting The SoftGOT-GOT link function setting is independent of the GOT network interaction function setting. Both of the settings are enabled.

Function Description Setting range Exclusive authorization obtained state

The status whether or not the GOT obtains the exclusive authorization is displayed. Obtaining or releasing the exclusive authorization can be executed by the GOT.

Obtain/Release

Authorization obtained time The time length from the last operation of GT SoftGOT2000 after obtaining the authorization until the GOT automatically obtains the authorization can be set.

0 to 3600 seconds

Operating priority guaranteed time

The time period that the authorized equipment (GOT or GT SoftGOT2000) keeps the authorization after the last operation of the authorized equipment can be set. (The unauthorized equipment cannot obtain the authorization until the set time elapses.)

0 to 3600 seconds

Operation status popup notification

When the authorization is not obtained in GT SoftGOT2000/GOT, whether to display or not the information of the authorized side in pop-up can be set.

YES/NO

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function

3

Display operation of the SoftGOT-GOT link function setting

SoftGOT-GOT link function

Special function setting

Touch [SoftGOT-GOT link function].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function 159

16

SoftGOT-GOT link function setting operation

Exclusive authorization obtained state Obtaining the exclusive authorization 1. Touch the [Obtain] button to display the dialog.

2. Touch the [OK] button to obtain the exclusive authorization. Touch the [Cancel] button to stop obtaining the exclusive authorization.

Releasing the exclusive authorization 1. Touch the [Release] button to display the dialog.

2. Touch the [OK] button to release the exclusive authorization. Touch the [Cancel] button to stop releasing the exclusive authorization.

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function

3

Authorization obtained time 1. If touch the select button of the authorization obtained time, a keyboard is displayed. Enter the authorization obtained time with the keyboard. When setting to 0 second, the authorization is not automatically obtained by the GOT.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

Operating priority guaranteed time 1. If touch the select button of the operating priority guaranteed time, a keyboard is displayed. Enter the operating priority guaranteed time with the keyboard.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

Relation between the authorization obtained time and the operating priority guaranteed time When the followings are set, the authorization obtained time is prioritized. (After the authorization obtained time is elapsed, the GOT automatically obtains the authorization.) 1sec or more is set for the authorization obtained time. The authorization guarantee time is set longer than the authorization obtained time.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function 161

16

Operation status popup notification 1. Touch the field of the setting to be changed.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.1 SoftGOT-GOT Link Function

3

3.2 VNC Server Function VNC server function setting In the VNC server function setting, the authorization guarantee time for the VNC server function can be set. For details on the VNC server function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Authorization guarantee time cancel signal (GS1792.b8) When the Authorization guarantee time cancel signal (GS1792.b8) turns on, the authorization guarantee time setting is disabled. Relationship with the GOT network interaction function setting The VNC server function setting is independent of the GOT network interaction function setting. Both of the settings are enabled.

Display operation of the VNC server function setting

Function Description Setting range Operating priority guaranteed time

The time that the authorized equipment holds the authorization after you operate the authorized equipment can be set. (The unauthorized equipment cannot obtain the authorization until the set time elapses.)

0 to 3600 seconds

VNC server function

Special function setting

Touch [VNC server function].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.2 VNC Server Function 163

16

VNC server function setting operation

Operating priority guaranteed time 1. Touch the input field for [Operating priority guaranteed time] to display a keyboard. Input the authorization guarantee time with the keyboard.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.2 VNC Server Function

3

3.3 Sequence Program Monitor Sequence program monitor setting Storage locations and others for data to be used for the sequence program monitor function can be set. Storing a sequence program eliminates the need for reading the program from the PLC CPU at the next GOT startup. This shortens the time required for the execution of the sequence program monitor. For the details of the sequence program monitor, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Sequence program to be saved The sequence program to be saved is used by the GOT to execute the sequence program monitor. The sequence program can be saved in the SD card with this function, however it cannot be copied in the personal computer to be referred/edited with GX Developer, etc.

Function Description Setting range Data save location Select the storage location for the sequence program monitor. A: Built-in SD card

B: USB Drive E: USB Drive F: USB Drive G: USB Drive

Automatic program read Select whether to automatically read sequence programs when the sequence program monitor starts from a touch switch or alarm display.

YES/NO

Priority comment If both Common comment and Each program comment are set for the same device in a sequence program, select either of the comments to be displayed in the sequence program monitor.

Common comment/Each program comment

Ladder editor (iQ-R ladder) Select whether to enable or disable the ladder editor of sequence programs (MELSEC iQ-R series).

Invalid/Effective

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.3 Sequence Program Monitor 165

16

Display operation of the sequence program monitor

Sequence program monitor setting operation 1. Touch the selection for the setting item to switch the selection.

2. Touch the [OK] button to reflect the new setting and return to the [Ext. func. set] screen. To cancel the setting change, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

Sequence program monitor setting

Extended function setting

Select the storage location for the sequence program monitor.

Touch [Seq. program monitor].

6 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.3 Sequence Program Monitor

3

3.4 Backup/Restoration Backup/restoration setting The storage location for backup data can be set. For how to use the backup/restoration, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor) Set the following items with touching the items on the GOT.

Item Description Setting range Drive for backup setting The drive for storing backup settings, including parameters and passwords for

controllers, can be selected. A: Built-in SD card B: USB Drive E: USB Drive F: USB Drive G: USB Drive X: Drive

Drive for backup data The drive for storing backup data can be selected. A: Built-in SD card B: USB Drive E: USB Drive F: USB Drive G: USB Drive X: Drive

Trigger backup setting The GOT automatically backs up data when triggers (Rise, Time) specified for each backup setting are met.

None/Rise/Time Page 171 Trigger Backup

Max. of backup data Set the maximum number of backup data to be stored. (When 0 is specified, the GOT does not check the number of backup data to be stored.)

Setting range: 0 to 50

Enable CPU No. setting Set whether to specify the CPU No. at a backup. (When [YES] is selected, the GOT starts to communicate with only the specified PLC. Therefore the network batch backup/restoration on the multiple PLCs cannot be executed.)

YES/NO

Retain file register inf. during restor

Set whether to retain the file register information at a restoration. YES/NO

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.4 Backup/Restoration 167

16

Display operation of backup/restoration setting

Backup/restoration setting

Touch an item to be changed.

Touch [Backup/ restoration].

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.4 Backup/Restoration

3

Backup/restoration setting operation

Drive for backup setting, drive for backup data 1. If touch the setup item, the setup contents are changed.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

Trigger backup setting For operations of the trigger backup setting, refer to the following. Page 169 Backup/restoration setting operation

Max. of backup data 1. If touching the setting items, keyboard is displayed. Input numeric with the keyboard. Setting range: 0 to 50, Default: 0 (When 0 is specified, the GOT does not check the number of backup data to be stored.)

2. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.4 Backup/Restoration 169

17

Enable CPU No. setting 1. If touch the setup item, the setup contents are changed.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

Retain file register inf. during restor 1. If touch the setup item, the setup contents are changed.

2. If touch the [OK] button, the changed settings are reflected and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Special function setting] screen.

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.4 Backup/Restoration

3

3.5 Trigger Backup Trigger backup setting When the conditions of the trigger specified for each backup setting (Rise, Time) are met, the GOT automatically backs up data. For how to use the trigger backup, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Display operation of the trigger backup setting

Trigger backup setting

Special function setting

Backup/restoration

Touch an item to be changed.Touch

[Trig bkup setting].

Touch [Backup/ restoration].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.5 Trigger Backup 171

17

Trigger backup setting operation 1. Touch a setting item for the trigger type, and then the setting is changed.

None: The GOT does not execute the trigger backup. Rise: The GOT backs up data when the trigger device turns on. Time: The GOT backs up data at the specified time.

2. Touch a setting item for check changes, and then the setting is changed.

3. When the trigger type is changed, a password input window appears by touching the [OK] button. Input the password for the backup/restore. When the password is verified, the settings are reflected, and then the screen returns to the [trigger backup setting] screen. When the trigger type is not changed, touching the [OK] button reflects the settings. If touch the [Cancel] button, the changed settings are canceled and the screen returns to the [Backup/restoration] screen.

Precautions for setting When the trigger type is set to [Rise], set the trigger device with GT Designer3 in advance. Failure to do so disables the backup setting with [Rise] set.

: Backup is executed regardless of whether the backup data has been changed.

: When the backup is executed, the GOT checks if the backup data and the data stored in the file register have been changed after the previous backup. When the data has been changed, the GOT backs up the changed data.

: When the backup is executed, the GOT checks if the backup data has been changed after the previous backup. When the data has been changed, the GOT backs up the changed data. However, the GOT does not check if the data stored in the file register has been changed.

(None Rise Time)

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.5 Trigger Backup

3

Trigger time setting operation 1. When the trigger type is set to [Time], touch a setting item for [Detail] and the screen is switched to the trigger time

setting screen.

2. In the screen, specify the days and time that the GOT executes the backup. Day: Select days that the GOT executes the backup by touching displayed items.Multiple days can be selected. Time: Set the time that the GOT executes the backup by touching the displayed item.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.5 Trigger Backup 173

17

3.6 License Management License management setting To use functions which require a license, register the license to the GOT. To delete the license registered to the GOT, perform the operation also on the license management screen.

You can register or delete licenses for the remote personal computer operation function (Ethernet), the VNC server function, the MES interface function, and the GOT Mobile function independently. For the details of each function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual GOT2000 Series MES Interface Function Manual for GT Works3 Version1

Display operation of the license management setting

Item Description Setting range Remote personal computer operation function (Ethernet)

Register or delete the license for the remote personal computer operation function (Ethernet). -

VNC server function Register or delete the license for the VNC server function. -

MES interface function Register or delete the license for the MES interface function. -

GOT Mobile function Register or delete the license for the GOT Mobile function. -

License management

Special function setting

Touch [License management].

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.6 License Management

3

Setting operation of license management

When registering a license number for the GOT 1. Touch the license number input area on the license management screen, and then the keyboard appears on the bottom

of the screen.

2. Touch the [Regist] button to register the input license number. If the [] button is touched without touching the [Regist] button, the license number is not registered.

3. After a license number is registered, touch the [] button to close the license management screen.

When releasing a license number for the GOT 1. Touch the [Cancel reg.] button to release the registered license number.

2. Touch the [] button to close the license management screen.

How to obtain a license number For how to obtain a license number, consult your local sales office.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.6 License Management 175

17

3.7 Video/RGB Video unit setting

Video unit setting The video input signal and resolution can be selected.

*1 Can be selected only in PAL format

Input signal settings Set the input signal as follows according to the output format for the video camera or the like connected. If the settings made differ from these, video images may not be displayed correctly.

Display operation of the video unit setting

Item Description Setting range Video unit setting The input signal and resolution can be selected. Input signal: NTSC format, PAL format

Resolution: 640 480, 720 480*1, 768 576

Output format for video camera or the like Input signal setting NTSC format NTSC

PAL format PAL

EIA format NTSC

CCIR format PAL

Video unit setting

Special function setting Video/RGB setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch an item to be set.

6 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB

3

Operating the video unit setting 1. When you touch the setting item, the setting contents change.

2. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

3. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

4. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change in [Video Unit Settings], when closing [Video Unit Settings] and [Video/RGB Setting]/[Communication Setting] with the [] button, the GOT is restarted, and the new setting contents are reflected.

Input signal PAL, NTSC

Resolution 720480, 768576, 640480

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB 177

17

Video display setting

Video display setting The target for the video settings and the preview channel can be selected and the captive area and image quality can be set.

Display operation of the video display setting

Item Description Setting range Video Display Setting The target for the video settings and the preview channel can be selected and

the captive area (in the horizontal direction and vertical direction) and image quality (color tone, contrast, brightness, color intensity) can be set. The captive area and image quality can be set for each channel.

Channel 1/2/3/4 Captive area Horizontal: -100 to 100 Vertical: -100 to 100 Image Quality and Color Tone: -100 to 100 Contrast: -100 to 100 Brightness: -100 to 100 Intensity: -100 to 100

Video display setting

Extended function setting Video/RGB setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch an item to be set.

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch [Video Display Settings]

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB

3

Video display setting operation 1. Select a video channel No. to be displayed. The video image for the selected channel No. is previewed.

2. To change the captive area or image quality, touch the display section of each item. Captive Area: Refer to step 3 to step 6. Image Quality: Refer to step 7 to step 10.

3. The captive area (horizontal direction/vertical direction) for the selected channel No. can be changed.

Touching the [Default] button returns to the default status.

4. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

Moves the captive area a certain distance in the "-" direction.

Moves the captive area to the touched position.

Moves the captive area a certain distance in the "+" direction.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB 179

18

5. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

6. After completing all the items to set, if you touch the [] button, the display returns to the preview screen step1.

7. The image quality (color tone, contrast, brightness, color intensity) for the selected channel No. can be changed.

Touching the [Default] button returns to the default status. When touching the [Copy CH1] button, the image quality (color tone, contrast, brightness, color intensity) for the selected channel No. is matched with the image quality settings for Channel No. 1 ([CH1]).

8. When touching the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

9. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

10.After completing all the items to set, if you touch the [] button, the display returns to the preview screen step1.

11. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change in the video display settings, when closing [Video Display (Preview)] with the [] button, the display returns to [Video/RGB Setting].

Changes the number a certain amount in the "-" direction.

Changes the number to the touched position.

Changes the number a certain amount in the "+" direction.

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB

3

Precautions for setting Incorrect settings may disrupt or stop the video image. (If this happens, returning the settings to their default values restores normal display.) This phenomenon depends on the video camera or other device connected. Use setting values that provide proper display.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB 181

18

RGB display setting

RGB display setting The RGB clock phase and screen position can be set.

*1 Adjust this setting when horizontal noise lines appear on the screen. *2 Adjust this setting when characters are blotted or contours are unclear. *3 Only available to GT27-R2.

Display operation of the RGB display setting

Item Description Setting range RGB Display Setting The following items can be set.

Channel to be previewed Clock phase *1

Clock phase (extend) *2*3

Screen position (horizontal) Screen position (vertical)

Channel: 1/2 ClockPhase: -100 to 100 Clock phase (extend): -100 to 100 Display position Horizontal: -100 to 100 Display position Vertical: -100 to 100

RGB display setting

Extended function setting Video/RGB setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch [Video/RGB].

Touch an item to be set.

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB

3

RGB display setting operation 1. Select an RGB channel No. to be displayed. The RGB image for the selected channel No. is previewed.

2. The clock phase and screen display position (horizontal direction or vertical direction) can be changed.

3. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

4. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

5. After completing all the items to set, if you touch the [] button, the display returns to [Video/RGB Setting].

Precautions for setting If the value for [Horizontal] or [Vertical] is too large, RGB display may not be performed or the display may be disrupted or stopped. If this happens, return the settings to their default values and make settings in the range where RGB display is possible.

Changes the number a certain amount in the "-" direction.

Changes the number to the touched position.

Changes the number a certain amount in the "+" direction.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.7 Video/RGB 183

18

3.8 Multimedia Video unit setting

Video unit setting The video input signal and resolution can be selected.

*1 When NTSC format is selected, the resolution is fixed to 640 480. *2 When PAL format is selected, the resolution is fixed to 768 576.

Input signal settings Set the input signal as follows according to the output format for the video camera or the like connected. If the settings made differ from these, video images may not be displayed correctly.

Display operation of the video unit setting

Item Description Setting range Video unit setting The input signal and resolution can be selected. Input signal: NTSC format, PAL format

Resolution: 640 480*1, 768 576*2

Output format for video camera or the like Input signal setting NTSC format NTSC

PAL format PAL

EIA format NTSC

CCIR format PAL

Video unit setting

Extended function setting Multimedia setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Touch [Video Unit Settings].

Touch [Multimedia].

Touch an item to be set.

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Operating the video unit setting 1. When you touch the setting item, the setting contents change.

Resolution automatically switches to 640 480 when NTSC is selected and to 768 576 when PAL is selected.

2. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

3. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

4. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change, close [Video Unit Settings] with the [] button.

5. When closing [Multimedia Setting] or [Communication Setting] with the [] button, the new setting contents are reflected.

Input signal PAL, NTSC

Resolution 768 576, 640 480

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 185

18

Video setting

Video setting The captive area and image quality can be set.

Display operation of the video setting

Item Description Setting range Video setting The captive area (in the horizontal direction and vertical direction) for the video and the

image quality (color tone, contrast, brightness, color intensity) can be set. Captive area Horizontal: -100 to 100 Vertical: -100 to 100 Image Quality and Color Tone: -100 to 100 Contrast: -100 to 100 Brightness: -100 to 100 Intensity: -100 to 100

Video setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Extended function setting Multimedia setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Video setting].

Touch an item to be set.

Touch [Multimedia].

6 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Operation of Video setting 1. To change the captive area or image quality, touch the display section of each item. Captive Area: Refer to step 2 to step 5. Image Quality: Refer to step 6 to step 9.

2. The captive area (horizontal direction or vertical direction) can be changed.

Touching the [Default] button returns to the default status.

3. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

4. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

5. After completing all the items to set, if you touch the [] button, the display returns to the preview screen step1.

Moves the captive area a certain distance in the "-" direction.

Moves the captive area to the touched position.

Moves the captive area a certain distance in the "+" direction.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 187

18

6. The image quality (color tone, contrast, brightness, color intensity) for the selected channel No. can be changed.

Touching the [Default] button returns to the default status. When touching the [] button, the setting contents are determined.

7. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

8. After completing all the items to set, if you touch the [] button, the display returns to the preview screen step1.

9. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change in [Video setting], when closing [Video setting (preview)] with the [] button, the display returns to [Multimedia Setting].

Precautions for setting Incorrect settings may disrupt or stop the video image. (If this happens, returning the settings to their default values restores normal display.) This phenomenon depends on the video camera or other device connected. Use setting values that provide proper display.

Changes the number a certain amount in the "-" direction.

Changes the number to the touched position.

Changes the number a certain amount in the "+" direction.

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Long time recording setting

Long time recording setting In the long time recording settings, the saving method of video files for long time recording can be set.

Display operation of the long time recording setting

Item Description Setting range Continuous save At the long time recording, whether to start recording after deleting all the video files which

are previously recorded or to start recording without the deletion can be set. Valid/Invalid

Long time recording setting

Extended function setting Multimedia setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Touch [Long time recording settings].Touch

[Multimedia].

Set the saving method of video files for long time recording.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 189

19

Operating the long time recording settings 1. When you touch the setting item, the setting contents change.

Continuous recording: Valid/Invalid

2. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined.

3. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

4. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change, close [Long time recording settings] with the [] button.

5. When closing [Multimedia Setting] or [Communication Setting] with the [] button, the new setting contents are reflected.

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Version control Perform the version control when updating the software version of the multimedia unit.

Display operation of the version control To update the software version of the multimedia unit, insert a CF card that contains the update program into the multimedia unit. Obtain the update program by one of the following methods. Disk5 folder in GT Works3 DVD-ROM Contact your local distributor.

Version control

Special function setting Multimedia setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Touch the unit software update menu to switch to the software update screen.

Touch [Version control].

Touch [Multimedia].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 191

19

Setting procedure for the version control 1. Check the current software version of the multimedia unit that is displayed in [Unit software version]. Touch the [Unit software Update menu] button to display the update program transfer screen.

2. Insert a CF card that contains the update program into the multimedia unit. The update program version appears in [Update software ver] only when this version is newer than the one displayed in [Unit software version].

3. To update to the new version, touch the [Update] button.

4. The dialog below appears.

To perform the update, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the update, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

5. The dialog below appears during the update. Do not remove the CF card or power off the GOT while this dialog is being displayed. Do not turn off the SD card access switch of the multimedia unit. Doing so causes an improper update of the software.

6. After the update is complete, the dialog below appears.

7. If the update terminates abnormally or fails, the dialog below appears. In such a case, restart the GOT and then perform the update from step 1 again.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 193

19

Network setting

Network setting The network setting is executed when the network connection is made using the Ethernet I/F of the multimedia unit. The following settings can be made in the network setting.

Display operation of the network setting

Item Description Setting range MAC address Displays the MAC address. -

IP address Displays and sets the IP address. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Default gateway Displays and sets the router address of the default gateway. For the connection via a router, the setting is required.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Subnet mask Displays and sets the subnet mask. For the connection via a router, the setting is required.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Network setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Extended function setting Multimedia setting menu

Communication setting

Touch [Multimedia].

Touch [Network settings].

Touch an item to be changed.

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Operating the network setting The following shows the setting operation of the IP address. The same setting operation is applied to the default gateway and the subnet mask.

1. Touch the IP address display box.

2. The keyboard appears. Enter numerical values.

3. When you touch the [Confirm] button, the setting contents are determined. If you touch the [Default] button, the setting contents can be returned to the initial values.

4. If you touch the [] button without touching the [Confirm] button, the dialog shown below is displayed.

5. After completing the settings for all the items you want to change in [Network settings], when touching the [] button, the display returns to [Multimedia setting menu].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 195

19

Multimedia screen

Display operation of multimedia screen Create the multimedia screen switch used to display the multimedia screen on the project screen. Touch the multimedia screen switch so that the screen is switched to the multimedia screen. The video image, play video and file selection menu can be switched on the multimedia screen. For details of the procedures for creating the special function switch used to display the multimedia screen, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Operation of multimedia screen Video image screen Images taken with a video camera connected to the multimedia unit can be displayed on the GOT screen. Images taken with a video camera can be recorded.

*1 The file is saved to the output destination specified in the hard copy function setting.

Item Item Description (1) Image display screen Screen to display images taken with a video camera

(2) button

Button to pause images taken with a video camera

(3) button

Button to start recording images taken with a video camera

(4) button

Button to stop recording

(5) [Print Screen] button Button to start printing the screen*1

(6) [Cancel Print] button Button to cancel printing the screen

(7) [Switch video] button Button to switch the display to the play video screen

(8) [Menu] button Button to switch the screen to the file menu screen

(9) [Exit] button Button to exit the multimedia screen and return to the utility screen

(10) [OK] button Button to accept messages

(11) [Cancel] button Button to stop messages

(12) Message display screen Screen to display error messages, etc.

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

(5)

(6)

(7)

(8)

(9)

(12)

(10) (11)

6 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

Play video screen Video files saved in the CF card installed on the multimedia unit can be played and displayed.

*1 The file is saved to the output destination specified in the hard copy function setting.

Item Item Description (1) Image display screen Screen to display images taken with a video camera or to play video taken with a video camera

(2) button

Play button for playing video

(3) button

Button to pause images or video taken with a video camera

(4) button

Button to stop playing

(5) button

Button to return to the beginning of video files and to play the video

(6) button

Button to return to the beginning of video files and to play the video

(7) button

Button to play the video in slow motion

(8) [Print Screen] button Button to start printing the screen*1

(9) [Cancel Print] button Button to cancel printing the screen

(10) [Switch video] button Button to switch the screen to the video image screen

(11) [Menu] button Button to switch the screen to the file menu screen

(12) [Exit] button Button to exit the multimedia screen switch and to return to the utility screen

(13) [OK] button Button to accept messages

(14) [Cancel] button Button to stop messages

(15) Message display screen Screen to display the file name and shooting time of the video being played and messages

(16) Play position display bar Bar to display the play position of the video

(1)

(4)

(5)

(6)

(8)

(9)

(10)

(11)

(14)

(12) (16)

(13)

(15)

(7)

(2) (3)

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia 197

19

File menu screen Video files of the CF card installed on the multimedia unit can be searched. Searched video files can be displayed on the play video screen.

Item Name Description (1) File menu display screen Screen to list the video files, display the number of files, and delete a target file in the CF card selected in

[Select drive]

(2) [Play video] button Button to switch the display to the play video screen

(3) [Video image] button Button to switch the screen to the video image screen

(4) [Exit] button Button to exit the multimedia screen switch and to return to the utility screen

(5) [OK] button Button to accept messages

(6) [Cancel] button Button to stop messages

(7) Message display screen Screen to display error messages, etc.

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4) (5) (6)

(7)

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.8 Multimedia

3

3.9 Wireless LAN Function Wireless LAN function setting On the GOT, you can enable or disable the wireless LAN function, and check the wireless LAN function setting that is configured with GT Designer3. For the setting of the wireless LAN function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of the wireless LAN function setting

Wireless LAN setting (Access point)

Special function setting

Touch [Wireless LAN setting].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.9 Wireless LAN Function 199

20

Display contents when [Action Mode] is set to [Access point] The following describes the setting of the wireless LAN function when [Action Mode] is set to [Access point].

Wireless LAN unit setting The following describes the setting items and the display contents of the wireless LAN setting.

Wireless LAN function Select whether to enable the wireless LAN function.

Action mode, SSID, authentication method, wireless channel No., and MAC address Displays the action mode, SSID, authentication method, and wireless channel number that are set with GT Designer3. Displays the MAC address of the wireless LAN communication unit that is mounted on the GOT.

Setting change Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. To cancel the setting change and return to the utility main menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

(3)

(1)

(2)

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.9 Wireless LAN Function

3

Connected stations The following describes the display contents of [Connected stations].

Connected stations The number of connected stations and MAC address are displayed. Touch the [Update list] button to update the number of connected stations and their MAC addresses.

Changing the settings Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. To cancel the setting change and return to the utility main menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

(1)

(2)

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.9 Wireless LAN Function 201

20

Display contents when [Action Mode] is set to [Station] The following describes the setting of the wireless LAN function when [Action Mode] is set to [Station].

Wireless LAN communication unit setting The following describes the setting of the wireless LAN function when [Action Mode] is set to [Station].

Wireless LAN function Select whether to enable the wireless LAN function.

Action mode, connection destination ID, reception field intensity, and MAC address Displays the action mode and the connection destination ID that are set with GT Designer3. Displays the reception field intensity that indicates the connection status between the GOT and the current destination access point. Displays the MAC address of the wireless LAN communication unit that is mounted on the GOT.

Setting change Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. To cancel the setting change and return to the utility main menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

(1)

(2)

(3)

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.9 Wireless LAN Function

3

Destination access point setting The following describes the display contents of [Conn. dest. AP setting].

Connection destination access point setting Lists the ID numbers, names, and SSIDs of the destination access points that are set with GT Designer3.

Setting change Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT to operate with the changed settings. To cancel the setting change and return to the utility main menu, touch the [Cancel] button.

(1)

(2)

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.9 Wireless LAN Function 203

20

3.10 System Launcher System launcher setting You can enable or disable the online module change in the system launcher function. For the details of the system launcher function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Display operation of the system launcher setting

Item Description Setting range Online module change Enable or disable the online module change in the system launcher function. Effective/Invalid

Extended function setting

System launcher

Touch [System launcher].

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.10 System Launcher

3

Setting procedure for the system launcher

Online module change 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.10 System Launcher 205

20

3.11 iQSS Utility iQSS utility setting You can set the drive for a data storage containing the profile data of iQSS-compatible equipment. For the details of the iQSS utility function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Display operation of the iQSS utility setting

Item Description Setting range Data save location Select the drive for a data storage containing profile data. A:Built-in SD card

B:USB drive E:USB drive F:USB drive G:USB drive X:drive

iQSS utility

Extended function setting

Touch [iQSS utility].

6 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.11 iQSS Utility

3

Setting procedure for the iQSS utility

Data save location 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting change. To cancel the setting change, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.11 iQSS Utility 207

20

3.12 ANDON Connection ANDON connection setting You can set the IP address of a client that connects to the GOT without the operator name and password-based authentication. (The authentication screen does not appear.) For the details of the ANDON function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

*1 Leave the boxes blank if you do not set any IP addresses.

Display operation of the ANDON connection setting

Item Description Setting range ANDON IP filter usage Set whether to limit the IP addresses targeted for the ANDON connection. Yes/No

Range Set whether to set IP addresses by specifying a range. To specify a range, set the start IP address and the end IP address in [Target IP address].

Selected/Not selected

Target IP address Set the IP addresses or IP address ranges targeted for the ANDON connection. Up to five settings can be made.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255*1

ANDON connection

Extended function setting

Touch [ANDON connection].

8 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.12 ANDON Connection

3

Setting procedure for the ANDON connection

Setting an IP address 1. Touch the down arrow of the [ANDON IP filter usage] list box, and select [Yes].

2. Touch a start IP address entry box in the [Target IP address] column to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. To specify an IP address range, refer to the following. Page 209 Specifying an IP address range

4. Touch the [OK] button to display a restart confirmation dialog. Restart the GOT to operate with the new setting. To cancel the setting, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the main menu. To reset each item to its default, touch the [Default] button.

Specifying an IP address range 1. Touch a checkbox in the [Range] column to display the end IP address entry boxes in the [Target IP address] column.

2. Touch any IP address entry box in the [Target IP address] column to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

1.

2.

4.

1. 2. 2.

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.12 ANDON Connection 209

21

Precautions

Setting of [ANDON IP filter usage] If you select [No] for [ANDON IP filter usage], any IP address can access the GOT without the operator name and password- based authentication. When you use the ANDON connection, make sure to select [Yes] to limit the IP addresses that can access the GOT without the operator name and password-based authentication.

Configuring the IP filter setting In the IP filter setting, allow the IP addresses targeted for the ANDON connection to access the GOT. Otherwise, the IP addresses cannot access the GOT using the ANDON connection.

0 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.12 ANDON Connection

3

3.13 Ethernet Printer Ethernet printer setting Set the IP address of an Ethernet printer.

Display operation of the Ethernet printer

Item Description Setting range IP address Set the IP address of the Ethernet printer to be connected. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Ethernet printer

Extended function setting

Touch [Ethernet printer].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.13 Ethernet Printer 211

21

Procedure for setting an Ethernet printer

1. Touch the input area of [IP Address] to display a keyboard. Input values with the keyboard.

2. Touch the [OK] button to reflect the new setting and return to the [Ext. func. set] screen. To cancel the setting change, touch the [Cancel] button to return to the [Ext. func. set] screen.

1.

2.

2 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.13 Ethernet Printer

3

3.14 Network drive setting Setting the network drive Configure the network drive settings.

Displaying the network drive setting screen

Function Description Setting range File server address Display or change the IP address of the file server. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Share name Display or change the name of the shared folder on the file server. Make sure that the number of characters (including delimiters) in the drive path is 60 or less.

Folder path Display or change the path to a folder in the shared folder.

User name Display or change the name of a user that is permitted to access the network drive. 1 to 32 one-byte or two-byte characters

Password Display or change the password for a user to access the network drive. 1 to 32 one-byte alphanumeric characters and symbols

Drive name Display the network drive name. Drive N (fixed)

Communication timeout Display or change the communication timeout period. 3 to 255 seconds

Network drive setting

Extended function setting

Touch [Network drive setting].

3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.14 Network drive setting 213

21

Procedure for setting the network drive 1. Touch a setting item.

2. Enter values or characters using the software keyboard displayed.

3. Touch the [OK] button to confirm the entry.

1.

2.

4 3 EXTENDED FUNCTION SETTING 3.14 Network drive setting

4

4 MAINTENANCE Page 216 Batch Self Check Page 219 USB Device Management Page 221 Screen Cleaning Page 223 Touch Panel Calibration Page 226 System Alarm Page 228 Drawing Check Page 232 Font Check Page 234 Touch Panel Check Page 236 I/O Check Page 241 Ethernet Status Check Page 243 GOT Information Page 245 GOT Mobile Information The GOT can display the screen for maintenance. The following describes the functions available as the maintenance.

Item Description Reference Batch self check This function collects data about energization time, installed system application and

others, and can display it in View self check results menu. Page 216 Batch Self Check

USB device management This function controls the USB peripheral device connection status in the GOT. Page 219 USB Device Management

Clean The screen can be set as not to be effected by touching the screen when clean with clothes.

Page 221 Screen Cleaning

Touch panel calibration Touch panel reading error can be corrected. Page 223 Touch Panel Calibration

System alarm Displays error code and error message when error occurs. Page 226 System Alarm

Drawing check Carries out missing bit check, color check and drawing check. Page 228 Drawing Check

Font check Displays the character data on the screen to check visually. Page 232

Touch panel check Checks whether there are no dead zone area in the Touch key minimum unit (16 dots x 16 dots).

Page 234 Touch Panel Check

I/O check Carries out RS-232 connecting target confirmation and self-loopback check. Page 236 I/O Check

Ethernet status check Sends a ping to check the Ethernet connection status. Page 241 Ethernet Status Check

GOT information Displays information of the GOT. Page 243 GOT Information

GOT Mobile information Displays the GOT Mobile function settings and the list of clients being connected to the GOT.

Page 245 GOT Mobile Information

4 MAINTENANCE 215

21

4.1 Batch Self Check The Batch self check collects data about energization time, installed system application and others, and can display it in View self check results menu.

Batch self check When an export destination of the system status log is specified in the batch self check screen, the data can be logged.

Also, the following information are displayed in View self check results menu.

Display operation of batch self check

Item Description System status log, Diagnostic data that the GOT system status has been logged

Item Description Start up information Information at power-on, Information at system start up

System status 1 Installed system application, installation history

System status 2 Communication driver, GOT system configuration information

Communication setting contents Displays the controller status.

Operation history Displays the operation history and execution time.

Screen switching history Displays the screen switching history and execution time.

Clock change history Displays the time before and after clock change.

System alarm history Displays the alarm and alarm occurrence time.

CPU error history Displays the ChNo., error messages and error occurrence time.

GOT start time history Displays the time GOT was powered on.

Batch self check

Maintenance

Touch [Batch self check].

6 4 MAINTENANCE 4.1 Batch Self Check

4

Operation of batch self check

Batch self check 1. Touch the selection of [Export system status log] to switch the set drive. Each touch changes the selection in the

following order: [A drive] [B drive] [E drive] [F drive] [G drive] [Not exported] [A drive]. If you select drive A, insert an SD card into the drive. If you select drive B, drive E, drive F, or drive G, install a data storage on the drive. If the batch self check is started with no SD card or data storage installed, the system status log is not saved. (The system status log is for manufacturer investigation only. Customers cannot view it.)

2. Touch the [Start] button to start Batch self check. Touch the [] button to return to the main menu.

4 MAINTENANCE 4.1 Batch Self Check 217

21

View self check results menu After completion of Batch self check, the following screen is displayed. Touch each item to display the details screen. Touch the [Stop] button to return to the Batch self check screen.

Display example of details screen Touch the items to display the following screens. Touch the [] button to return to the View self check results menu.

Touch the button in the left bottom of the screen to display the previous screen. Touch the button in the right bottom of the screen to display the next screen.

8 4 MAINTENANCE 4.1 Batch Self Check

4

4.2 USB Device Management Function of the USB device management This function displays a list of the USB peripheral device connection status in the GOT. Also, this screen is used to remove the USB peripheral device from GOT.

Display operation of the USB device management

USB device management

Maintenance

Touch [USB device management].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.2 USB Device Management 219

22

USB device status display operation 1. When a USB memory is installed, the [Stop] button is displayed in the [Attach] column. Touch the [Stop] button when removing the USB memory.

2. Touch the [Stop] button in the [Attach] column to display the following dialog. Touch the [OK] button to remove the USB peripheral device. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel removing the USB peripheral device.

3. When the USB peripheral device is ready to be removed, the following dialog appears. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

0 4 MAINTENANCE 4.2 USB Device Management

4

4.3 Screen Cleaning Screen cleaning function You can display the dedicated screen for cleaning the GOT. The touch operation is disabled on the dedicated screen, and therefore wiping the GOT display section with a cloth or others does not operate the GOT. For information on how to clean the GOT, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

Display operation of the screen for cleaning

To switch to the utility screen, touch the upper-left corner and then the upper-right corner of the screen.

Screen cleaning

Maintenance

Touch [Screen cleaning].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.3 Screen Cleaning 221

22

Operation of clean After cleaning the screen, touch the screen following the instruction displayed. After touching the screen, the screen returns to the Main Menu. The following screen is displayed.

2 4 MAINTENANCE 4.3 Screen Cleaning

4

4.4 Touch Panel Calibration Touch panel calibration setting Touch panel reading error can be corrected. Normally the adjustment is not required, however, the difference between a touched position and the object position may occur as the period of use elapses. When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, correct the position with this function.

Display operation of the touch panel calibration setting

Run Stop Run Stop

Before adjustment After adjustment

The [Run] will operate though you

intended to touch the [Stop] button. The [Stop] button can be touched

without fail.

Touch panel calibration Example) For GT25

Maintenance

Touch [Touch panel calibration].

Perform touch panel calibration.

4 MAINTENANCE 4.4 Touch Panel Calibration 223

22

Touch panel calibration operation Touch the point displayed on the screen with the finger one by one to make the setting. Example) For GT25

1. Touch the center of the displayed on the upper left precisely.

2. Touch the point displayed on the upper right.

3. Touch the point displayed on the lower right.

4 4 MAINTENANCE 4.4 Touch Panel Calibration

4

4. Touch the point displayed on the lower right.

5. Touching the button displayed on the upper right returns to the previous screen. When the precise touch could not be made, touch the [Readjustment] button to make the setting from step1 again.

4 MAINTENANCE 4.4 Touch Panel Calibration 225

22

4.5 System Alarm System alarm The system alarm function displays the error code and error message when an error occurs in the GOT, GOT Mobile function client, network, or controller. System alarms can be reset on the System alarm display screen. For the details of the system alarm, refer to the following. Page 401 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST

Display operation of system alarm

System alarm

Maintenance

Touch [System alarm].

When [Reset] is touched, the system alarm display of the GOT error is reset.

6 4 MAINTENANCE 4.5 System Alarm

4

Operation of system alarm display

System alarm display resetting 1. Eliminate each cause of the system alarm being occurred. Error causes can be identified by the error code, error message and channel No. displayed on the System alarm screen. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

2. A method for resetting system alarm depends on an error. GOT error Touch the [Reset] button to reset system alarms. CPU error and Network error The system alarm is automatically reset after its cause is eliminated.

Before resetting the system alarm display in the GOT error Eliminate the system alarm cause before resetting the system alarm display in the GOT error. If not eliminated, the system alarm display in the GOT error will not be reset even after the reset operation. Displaying a GOT Mobile error A GOT Mobile error is displayed as a GOT error. Processings with reset operation The following data in the system information are also reset. GOT error code (Write device) GOT error detection signal (System Signal 2-1.b13)

Touch

4 MAINTENANCE 4.5 System Alarm 227

22

4.6 Drawing Check Drawing check function The drawing check function carries out display checks as missing bit check, color check, basic figure display check, move check among screens.

Display operation of drawing check

Notes on drawing check Missing bits is occurred in the following cases. There are parts drawn in different color with the filled color. There are basic figures or patterns which are not drawn according to the layout and procedure described in

the following section. Page 228 Display operation of drawing check When missing bits occurs, contact your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service.

Drawing check

Maintenance

Touch [Drawing check].

8 4 MAINTENANCE 4.6 Drawing Check

4

Drawing check operation Touch [Drawing check] to display the drawing check screen.

Before execute drawing check Touching the upper right part of the screen proceeds to the next check in each step during drawing check. Touching the upper left part of the screen returns to the [Display check] screen.

Missing bit, Color Check Each touch of the upper-right part of the screen, the entire screen color changes in the following order: blue, black, red, purple, green, light blue, yellow, white, and gray. Check missing bit and color visually.

If touch the upper right part of the screen at the final color (white screen), the following 2) Basic figure check screen is displayed.

Basic figure check Check whether there is no shape transformation of basic figure or display losses. The basic figure drawn has 4 types: 1. Filled circle, 2. Line, 3. Rectangle, 4. Ellipse.

Upper-left touch

position

Upper-right touch

position

Black Red Purple Green Light blue Yellow White GrayBlue

To (b) Basic figurecheck screen

To Pattern 1 of (c) Move check

among screen

4 MAINTENANCE 4.6 Drawing Check 229

23

Move check among screens Pattern 1: Shape transformation, color check The drawn figures are displayed in order and at regular intervals. If the shape and color are displayed visually in order, it is normal.

Pattern 2: Shape transformation, color check The drawn figures are displayed in order and at regular intervals. If the shape and color are displayed visually in order, it is normal.

To Pattern 2

Pattern 1

To Pattern 3

Pattern 2

0 4 MAINTENANCE 4.6 Drawing Check

4

Pattern 3: Shape transformation, color check The overlapped shapes of pattern 1 and pattern 2 are displayed. If the shape and color are displayed visually in order, it is normal.

Pattern 4: Shape check The drawn figures are displayed in order and at regular intervals. If the shape and color are displayed visually in order, it is normal. If touch the upper right part of the screen, returns to [Display check] screen.

To Pattern 4

To [Display check]

The main screen image after the screen information read and write is executed

4 MAINTENANCE 4.6 Drawing Check 231

23

4.7 Font Check Font check function The font check is a function which confirms fonts installed in GOT. The character data of the font is displayed on the upper left part of the screen one by one.

Display operation of Font check

Display operation of Font check Judged as normal if the following characters are correctly displayed. (UNICODE) Alphabetic characters etc.: 0x0000 to 0x04F9 (From basic Latin to Kirill) Hangul characters: 0xAC00 to 0xD7A3 (Hangul/Hangul auxiliary) Kanji: 0x4E00 to 0x9FA5 (CJK integrated Kanjis) If the characters above are not displayed correctly, the fonts may not be installed. Install the system application again.

Font check

Maintenance

Touch [Font check].

2 4 MAINTENANCE 4.7 Font Check

4

Font check operation Touch [Font check] to start the font check. The character data of the built-in font (in the built-in flash memory) can be checked visually to confirm the font drawings by displaying the character data serially on the screen.

Before executing the font check To proceed to the next check in each step during the font check, touch the [Next] button at the bottom right of the screen. To return to the [Display check] screen, touch the [Prev] button at the bottom right of the screen.

Lower-right touch position

NextPrev

4 MAINTENANCE 4.7 Font Check 233

23

4.8 Touch Panel Check Touch panel check function Touch panel check is a function which checks whether there is no dead zone area in touch key minimum unit (16 dots 16 dots).

Display operation of Touch panel check

Notes on Touch panel check If the touched part is not filled with yellow color, there are the following two possible causes. 1. Display part failure 2. Touch panel failure In that case, contact your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service.

Touch panel check

Maintenance

Touch [Touch panel check].

4 4 MAINTENANCE 4.8 Touch Panel Check

4

Touch panel check operations Touch [Touch panel check] to display the screen filled with black.

1. Touch a part of the screen. The touched part becomes a yellow-filled display.

2. To return to the previous screen, touch the upper right part of the screen.

Checking the upper right part of the screen Only the upper right part of the screen cannot be filled with yellow. If you can return to the previous screen by touching the upper right part of the screen, the part is judged to be normal.

Screen filled with black

Yellow

Upper-right touch position

4 MAINTENANCE 4.8 Touch Panel Check 235

23

4.9 I/O Check I/O check function The I/O check is a function which checks whether GOT and PLC can communicate with each other. If I/O check ends normally, the communication interface and the connection cable hardwares are normal. Before executing the I/O check, write the applicable communication driver from GT Designer3 to the GOT. Note that the GOT restarts when this function is performed. Refer to the following for the details related to the installation of the communication driver. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Communication drivers inapplicable to I/O check When the following communication drivers are used, the I/O check cannot be executed.

Connection type Communication driver Connection to MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC PLC

MELSECNET/H connection MELSECNET/H

MELSECNET/10 connection MELSECNET/H

CC-Link IE TSN connection CC-Link IE TSN

CC-Link IE Controller Network connection CC-Link IE Controller Network

CC-Link IE Field Network connection CC-Link IE Field Network

CC-Link connection (Intelligent device station) CC-Link Ver.2(ID)

Ethernet connection Ethernet (MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC), Gateway

Ethernet (FREQROL (Batch monitor)), Gateway

Connection to FUJI PLC FUJI PXR/PXG/PXH

Connection to YASKAWA PLC YASKAWA GL YASKAWA CP9200(H) YASKAWA CP9300MS (MC compatible) YASKAWA MP2000/MP900/CP9200SH Ethernet (YASKAWA), gateway

Connection to YOKOGAWA PLC YOKOGAWA FA500/FA-M3/STARDOM Ethernet (YOKOGAWA), gateway YOKOGAWA GREEN/UT100/UT2000/UTAdvanced

Connection to ALLEN-BRADLEY PLC Ethernet(AB), Gateway

Connection to SIEMENS PLC SIEMENS S7-200 SIEMENS S7-300/400 Ethernet(SIEMENS S7), gateway

Microcomputer connection Microcomputer connection

Inverter connection FREQROL 500/700/800,SENSORLESS SERVO

MODBUS/TCP connection MODBUS/TCP Master, Gateway

AZBIL control equipment connection Azbil SDC/DMC

Connection to RKC temperature controller RKC SR Mini HG (MODBUS)

6 4 MAINTENANCE 4.9 I/O Check

4

Display operation of I/O Check

I/O check(For GT27)

Maintenance

Touch [I/O check].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.9 I/O Check 237

23

I/O check operation

Connecting target confirmation If touch [CPU] button, the connecting target confirmation communication check is carried out.

1. After the CPU communication starts normally, the dialog mentioned right notifying that it is on checking, until the connecting target confirmation communication ends normally.

2. When the connecting target confirmation communication ends, its result is notified by dialog. If the connecting target confirmation communication ends normally, the dialog notifying of the normal termination mentioned right is displayed. If touch [OK] button in the dialog after confirming the result, returns to [I/O check].

If the dialog mentioned right is displayed after selecting connecting target confirmation or during CPU communication check, confirm the following.

No misconnection with CPU GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used No missettings of parameter Page 100 Controller contents Check if the hardware has no problems. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) If touch [OK] button in the dialog after confirming the result, returns to [I/O check].

8 4 MAINTENANCE 4.9 I/O Check

4

Self-loopback If touch [Self], the hardware check of RS-232 interface is carried out.

1. For preparation for the self-loopback communication check, insert the connector for self-loopback check (Customer purchased) shown in the diagram right in the RS-232 interface.

For this connector, short 2 and 3 pins, 7 and 8 pins and 4 and 6 pins, respectively. In the communication setting of the GOT utility, set the channel number for the RS-232 interface to 0 ([None]).

2. After selecting [Self], the transferred data and received data are verified through the self-loopback connector. When the GOT cannot receive data during data transmission, the following dialog appears.

When this dialog appears, check the following. Check if the pins of the connector for self-loopback check are incorrectly shorted. Check if the channel number for the RS-232 interface is set to 0 ([None]) in the communication setting of the GOT utility. Page 100 Controller contents Check if the hardware has no problems. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

3. The following dialog is displayed during a check.

When using GT2505HS-V without a connector conversion box connected

When connecting to GT11H-C

When connecting to GT11H-C-37P

2)W/R(A)

3)W/B(A)

4)G/R(A)

5)G/B(A)

6)O/R(A)

7)O/B(A)

GOT rear face

4 3 2

68 7

RS-232 interface

4 MAINTENANCE 4.9 I/O Check 239

24

4. If the check is complete, the following dialog appears.

5. If an error occurs, a dialog appears notifying you of an abnormal termination and the byte in error.

When this dialog appears, check the following. Check if the hardware has no problems. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

0 4 MAINTENANCE 4.9 I/O Check

4

4.10 Ethernet Status Check Ethernet status check function Ethernet status check is a function that sends a ping to check the connection status with the equipment on the Ethernet.

Display operation of Ethernet status check

Ethernet status check

Maintenance

Touch [Ethernet status check].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.10 Ethernet Status Check 241

24

Operation of Ethernet status check 1. If touch the select button of [IP address of the other terminal], a keyboard is displayed. Enter the IP address of the other terminal with the keyboard.

2. If touch the [Ping transmission] button, a ping is sent to the IP address entered in [IP address of the other station]. The result is displayed in the dialog. The timeout time is about 5sec.

2 4 MAINTENANCE 4.10 Ethernet Status Check

4

4.11 GOT Information GOT information This function displays the following contents of the GOT information. Serial number MAC address of the Ethernet interface built in the GOT MAC address of the Ethernet communication unit Hardware version Software version at factory default CoreOS version BootOS version

Display operation of GOT information

GOT information(For GT27)

Maintenance

Touch [GOT information].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.11 GOT Information 243

24

Display of GOT information

Item Description S/N Displays the serial number.

User memory (RAM) size Displays the size of the user area in the built-in RAM of the GOT.

MAC address (standard port) Displays the MAC address of the Ethernet interface built in the GOT.

MAC address (standard port 1)

MAC address (standard port 2)

MAC address (extension port) Displays the MAC address of the Ethernet communication unit. Displays [-] when the Ethernet communication unit is not mounted.

MAC address (wireless LAN) Displays the MAC address of the wireless LAN communication unit. Displays [-] when the wireless LAN communication unit is not mounted.

H/W version Displays the H/W version.

S/W version Displays the S/W version at factory shipment.

CoreOS version Displays the CoreOS version.

BootOS version Displays the BootOS version.

For the models other than GT25-W For GT25-W

BootOS 01.17.000.R001.-Z

4 4 MAINTENANCE 4.11 GOT Information

4

4.12 GOT Mobile Information GOT Mobile information This function displays the GOT Mobile function settings and the list of clients being connected to the GOT. For the GOT Mobile function settings, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Precautions for remote control To disconnect a client when operating the server of the GOT Mobile function, be sure to notify the operator of the client before the disconnection. Not doing so may cause an accident.

Display operation of the GOT Mobile information

GOT Mobile information

Maintenance

Touch [GOT Mobile information].

4 MAINTENANCE 4.12 GOT Mobile Information 245

24

Displaying the GOT Mobile information

GOT Mobile information You can check the GOT Mobile function settings. To change the settings, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

List of connected clients You can check the clients being connected to the GOT.

Item Item Description (1) [Simultaneous client connection] Maximum number of clients connectable to the GOT simultaneously

(2) [Port No.] Port number of the GOT to which clients are connected

(3) [Auto disconnection time] Time period until a client is automatically disconnected from the GOT if no operation is performed on the client

Item Item Description 1) [Connected clients] Number of clients being connected to the GOT

2) IP address list Displays the IP addresses of the clients being connected to the GOT. The IP address is displayed for each client number. A client using the ANDON connection is marked with an asterisk [*] in the [ANDON] column. To disconnect a client, touch the [Disconnect] button in the [Connect] column.

(1)

(3)

(2)

1)

2)

6 4 MAINTENANCE 4.12 GOT Mobile Information

5

5 MONITOR Page 247 Monitor Screens

5.1 Monitor Screens The monitor screens are designed to confirm the device status of PLC CPU and to make the response for PLC system trouble more efficient. In this manual, the overview of the monitor screens and the operation procedure until displaying the screen are described. For display contents and operation procedure of monitor screens, refer to the following manual. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

5 MONITOR 5.1 Monitor Screens 247

24

Function of monitor screens The following shows the functions that can be performed with the monitor screens.

Item Description System launcher Displays the menu for a module selected in the system configuration diagram, and launches a target application

from the menu.

Device monitor Monitors or tests the devices of a PLC CPU and the buffer memory of an intelligent function module.

Sequence program monitor (Ladder) Monitors the program of a QCPU or LCPU in the ladder format.

Sequence program monitor (iQ-R ladder) Monitors the program of an RCPU in the ladder format.

Sequence program monitor (iQ-F ladder) Monitors the program of an FX5CPU in the ladder format.

FX ladder monitor Monitors the program of a PLC CPU in the ladder format.

Network monitor Monitors the status of the MELSECNET/H, MELSECNET(II), CC-Link IE TSN, CC-Link IE Controller Network, and CC-Link IE Field Network.

Intelligent module monitor Monitors the buffer memory of an intelligent function module on a dedicated screen and the signal status of an I/ O module. Data change is also available on the dedicated screen.

Servo amplifier monitor Various monitor functions, parameter change, test operation, etc. of the servo amplifier are available.

Q motion monitor The servo monitor and the parameter setting of the Motion CPU (Q series) are available.

R motion monitor The servo monitor and the parameter setting of the Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series) are available.

CNC monitor The position display monitor, alarm diagnosis monitor, tool compensation parameter, and program monitor, and others, which are equivalent to the MELDAS dedicated display, are available.

CNC monitor 2 Monitors the information required for the operation, setup, diagnosis, and maintenance of the CNC C80 connected to the GOT. Setting and inputting or outputting the data of the CNC C80 are also available.

Sequence program monitor (SFC) Monitors the program of a PLC CPU in the SFC diagram format (MELSAP3 or MELSAP-L format).

Q Motion SFC monitor Monitors the motion SFC programs and device values in a Motion CPU (Q series) connected to the GOT.

R Motion SFC monitor Monitors the motion SFC programs and device values in a Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series) connected to the GOT.

Log viewer Displays the logging data collected by a high speed data logger module, PLC CPU, or BOX data logger on the GOT, and manages files.

Network status display Monitors the network status using a communication unit mounted on the GOT.

FX list editor The sequence program of FXCPU can be list edited.

CNC machining program edit Editing the machining program of the CNC connected to the GOT is available.

CNC data I/O Copying, verifying, and deleting the machining programs, parameters, and others of the CNC connected to the GOT is available.

MELSEC-L troubleshooting Displays the status of a LCPU and the buttons to call up the functions for troubleshooting.

iQSS utility Monitors iQSS-compatible sensors. Parameter change is also available.

Drive recorder Reads the data prior to and subsequent to an alarm from a connected servo amplifier, and displays the data (including motor current values and position commands) in waveform or list form on the GOT.

CC-Link IE diagnostics Performs diagnostics and troubleshooting of the CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field Network.

Motion program editor Lists the motion programs of a Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series). Editing the programs is available.

Motion program I/O Copying or deleting the G-code programs of a Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series) is available.

Servo amplifier graph Reads the waveform data measured by a servo amplifier and displays the data in graph form.

Vision sensor monitor Monitors and controls the vision sensor connected to the GOT.

8 5 MONITOR 5.1 Monitor Screens

5

Display operation of monitor screens

Displays the monitor function (in the case of device monitor)

Monitor

Touch the monitor function to be operated

5 MONITOR 5.1 Monitor Screens 249

25

MEMO

0 5 MONITOR 5.1 Monitor Screens

6

6 DATA CONTROL Page 252 Data Type and Storage Location Page 255 Alarm Information Page 262 Image File Management Page 269 Recipe Information Page 304 Logging Information Page 318 Operation Log Information Page 341 File Manager Page 356 File Print Page 363 Package Data Management Page 374 Backup/Restore Function Page 375 SRAM management Page 381 Memory Card Format Page 384 Memory Check Page 387 GOT Data Package Acquisition A system application, project data (screen data), or alarm data which is written in the GOT or data storage can be displayed, and the data can be transferred between the GOT and data storage. The format of the data storage is also possible.

System screen operation restriction function The system screen operation restriction function is available to set the GOT special registers (GS) that restrict operation on the file management screen.

For details on the GOT special registers (GS), refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

GOT special register (GS) System screen that can be restricted GS622.b0 Alarm information

Image file management Recipe information Logging information Operation log information Memory card format

GS622.b1 Package management GOT data package acquisition

GS622.b2 SRAM management

GS623.b0 to b6 Alarm information Image file management Recipe information Logging information Operation log information Memory card format

GS624.b0 to b6 Alarm information Image file management Recipe information Logging information Operation log information Memory card format

6 DATA CONTROL 251

25

6.1 Data Type and Storage Location

System The data storage location and transferring (write/read) route for each data type are shown below. Also, the data storage locations are shown below.

*1 The USB memory can be used from Utility. Page 396 Installing using the data control function (Utility)

*2 When using the project data stored in the Built-in SD card (A drive) with the GOT, hold the SD card installed to the GOT. For the USB memory, store the project data to the Built-in SD card (A drive) or built-in flash memory (C drive).

Item Data type Storage location BootOS Built in flash memory (C drive)

*1 Basic system application Built-in SD card (A drive) Built in flash memory (C drive)*2PLC communication driver

System application (Extended function) *1 Project data

(Including recipe setting, alarm conditions, time action, and GOT setup.) Built-in SD card (A drive)*2

Built-in flash memory (C drive)*2

GOT

C drive (Built-in flash memory)

System application

BootOS

Install Download

Install Download

PC GT Designer3

Project data

System application

BootOS

Project data

System application

BootOS

Project data

A drive (Standard SD card), B drive (Extended memory card)

E drive (USB drive)

USB memory (when installed in GOT)

Write

SD card (when installed

in PC)

Inserting/ Removing USB memory

(when installed in PC)

Upload

Project data

Project data

Copy files on Windows

Project data + OS

Upload

SD card (when installed in GOT)

BootOS

BootOS

System application

Project

data

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.1 Data Type and Storage Location

6

At maintenance

The data in the built-in flash memory (Project data, etc.) can be saved even if the battery voltage becomes low.

*1 The USB memory can be used from Utility. Page 396 Installing using the data control function (Utility)

*2 Only available for the logging and hard copy functions.

Item Data type Storage location Alarm log file Built-in SD card (drive A)

USB drive (drive B) *1

USB drive (drive E) *1

USB drive (drive F) *1

USB drive (drive G) *1

Network drive (drive N) *2

Recipe file

Logging file

Operation log file

BMP file, JPEG file, PDF file

PC GT Designer3

Resource data Upload

Inserting/Removing

Install, Download, Write :

Upload, Read :

Alarm

Recipe

Hard copy

Logging Operation log

Operation log

Alarm Recipe

Hard copy

Logging

GOT

Drive C (Built-in flash memory)

Copy files on Windows

Drive A (Standard SD card), Drive B (Extended memory card)

Drive E (USB drive)

USB memory (when installed

in GOT)

SD card (when installed

in GOT)

File server (when installed

in GOT)

Drive N Network drive

Logging Hard copy

Copy files on Windows

SD card (when installed

in PC)

USB memory (when installed

in PC)

Alarm

Recipe

Logging

Operation Log

Hard copy

6 DATA CONTROL 6.1 Data Type and Storage Location 253

25

OS version confirmation Confirm the system application version carefully when installing the BootOS and basic system application. When the system application is installed, the GOT checks and compares the system application version automatically.

When install BootOS When the BootOS to be installed has the older major version, GOT displays the installation disapproving message to cancel the installation so that the older version may not be written. (Even when the version of the BootOS to be installed has the same or later version, the version information and the dialog box for selecting continue/not continue will be displayed.) Depending on the installation method, the dialog to be displayed varies. When installing from the Built-in SD card, the dialog is displayed by the main unit. When installing from GT Designer3 via USB, RS-232, or Ethernet, the dialog is displayed by GT Designer3.

When install basic system application, communication driver, or system application (Extended function)

When a basic system application, communication driver, or system application (Extended function) has already been installed, the version information of the system application which has been installed and the dialog for selecting whether to continue the installation or not will be displayed. Moreover, when the different versions will coexist among all applications (basic system application, communication driver, and system application (Extended function)) by installing the system application, the installation disapproving dialog will be displayed and the installation process is canceled.

When download project data The GOT automatically compares the version between the project data to be downloaded and the installed system application. When the versions are different, the dialog confirming whether to install the system application together is displayed. When downloading the project data from a data storage, storing the project data and system application beforehand is recommended.

Version confirmation of BootOS by rating plate Confirm the version of BootOS installed in the GOT at product shipment by rating plate of GOT rear face.

Capacity confirmation of the project data downloading location When download the project data, confirm the capacity of the user area in the drive to which transferred, the transferred project data size, the transfer size and buffering area size of the system application (Extended function) in advance to judge whether to carry out the download. The capacities can be confirmed by GT Designer3. Refer to the following for details. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

MODEL

DATE

MADE IN JAPAN

SERIAL MAC ADD. 123456789012 POWER

GRAPHIC OPERATION TERMINAL PASSED

IN GT2708-VTBA

2013-09 00013910AA00000-A

MAX 100VA 100-240VAC 50/60Hz

BootOS version (In case that the BootOS is two digits, only the first digit is written.)

A A

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.1 Data Type and Storage Location

6

6.2 Alarm Information Function of alarm information This function displays the alarm log file stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card, B: USB drive, E: USB drive, F: USB drive, G: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. The USB drive only stores log files, and cannot be displayed. For details on the alarms, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

The display operation of alarm information

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders

Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 256 The display example of alarm information, Page 257 Alarm information operation

G2A CSV conversion Converts the G2A file of an advanced alarm log file to a CSV file. Page 258 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation

G2A TXT conversion Converts the G2A file of an advanced alarm log file to a Unicode text file.

Page 258 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation

Deletion Deletes the file. Page 259 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 260 Copy operation

Alarm information

Data management

Touch [Alarm information].

Operates extended alarm log file or alarm log.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information 255

25

The display example of alarm information

Display of creation date and time The creation date and time display is not updated even if a file is created or updated while displaying the alarm information display screen. If close the screen currently displayed (moving the screen to the folder of the upper hierarchy, etc.) and display the screen again, the updated contents are displayed.

Number Item Description (1) Select drive Select a drive to display files or folders.

When a USB memory is installed in a drive, the drive is displayed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive]

(2) Check box If the check box is selected, up to 512 files can be selected.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Confirm the non-displayed part with the [Copy] button, etc. Page 260 Copy operation After confirmation, touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the operation.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection.

(9) Select all files/Cancel selection Multiple files can be selected or canceled at once. Touch the [Select all files] button to select all files. If the number of the displayed files exceeds 513, the first 512 files are selected.

(10) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(11) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1)

(9) (10) (11) (8)

(2) (5)(3) (4) (6) (7)

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information

6

Alarm information operation

The display operation of alarm information 1. If touch a drive of [Select drive], the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line. If touch the button, the screen scrolls up/down by one screen.

5. Touch the check box to select the file.

6. For operations of G2A CSV conversion, G2A TXT conversion, deletion, and copy, refer to the following. G2A CSV, G2A TXT Page 258 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation Delete Page 259 Deletion operation Copy Page 260 Copy operation

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information 257

25

G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation The selected G2A file is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file.

1. Touch the check box of the G2A file which is to be converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file to select the file.

2. The following dialog box is displayed when touching the following button according to the file type to convert to. CSV file: [G2A CSV] button Unicode text file: [G2ATXT] button

3. Touch the [OK] button. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box showed below appears without starting the conversion. To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the conversion, touch the [Cancel] button. (Example: Dialog box when the [G2A CSV] button is touched)

4. The message of completion is displayed in dialog box when conversion is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information

6

Deletion operation Deletes the selected file.

1. Touch the check box of the file to delete to select the file.

2. If touch the [Del] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If touch the [OK] button, the file is deleted. If touch the [Cancel] button, the deletion is canceled.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information 259

26

Copy operation Copies the selected file.

1. Touch the check box of the file to copy to select the file.

2. If touch the [Copy] button, the message [Please select a destination.] is displayed in the following bottom of the screen.

3. If the copy destination folder is touched, the screen display is changed to the folder of copy destination. At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed.

5. Touch the [OK] button. If there is a file of the same name in the copy destination folder, the following dialog is displayed without starting the copy. If touch the [OK] button, overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels to copy.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information

6

6. When the copy is completed, the dialog box of completion is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.2 Alarm Information 261

26

6.3 Image File Management Function of image file management Deletes, copies, moves, or renames the image file (BMP file or JPEG file) created by the hard copy function or creates a new folder for such a file. For details on the hard copy function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of image file management

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders

Displays the kind, name, data size, creation date and time of the file or folder.

Page 263 Display example of image file management, Page 264 Operation of image file management

Deletion Deletes the file. Page 265 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 266 Copy operation

Move Moves the file. Page 297 Move operation

Rename Renames the file. Page 267 Rename operation

Create Folder New folder is created. Page 300 Folder create operation

Image file management

Data management

Touch [Image file management].

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management

6

Display example of image file management

*1 To display the creation date and time of a file or folder using the file server time, set the same time zone for the GOT and file server.

Display of creation date and time The creation date and time display is not updated even if a file is created or updated while the image file management screen is displayed. To display the updated creation date and time, close the screen currently displayed (by moving to the upper hierarchy folder, etc.) and display the screen again.

Number Item Description (1) Select drive Select a drive to display files or folders.

When a USB memory or network drive is used, the following drives are displayed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive] Network drive: [N: Network drive] *1

(2) Check box If the check box is selected, up to 512 files can be selected.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Confirm the non-displayed part with the [Copy] button, etc. Page 266 Copy operation After confirmation, touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the operation.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection.

(9) Select all files/Cancel selection

Multiple files can be selected or canceled at once. Touch the [Select all files] button to select all files. If the number of the displayed files exceeds 513, the first 512 files are selected.

(10) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(11) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1)

(9) (10) (11) (8)

(2) (5)(3) (4) (6) (7)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management 263

26

Operation of image file management

Display operation of image file management 1. If touch a drive of [Select drive], the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. Touch the check box to select the file.

6. For the operations of the delete, copy, and rename, refer to the following. Delete Page 265 Deletion operation Copy Page 266 Copy operation Rename Page 267 Rename operation

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management

6

Deletion operation Deletes the selected file.

1. Touch the check box of the file to delete to select the file.

2. If touch the [Del] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If touch the [OK] button, the file is deleted. If touch the [Cancel] button, the deletion is canceled.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management 265

26

Copy operation Copies the selected file.

1. Touch the check box of the file to copy to select the file.

2. If touch the [Copy] button, the message [Please select a destination.] is displayed in the left bottom of the screen.

3. If the copy destination folder is touched, the screen display is changed to the folder of copy destination. At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed.

5. Touch the [OK] button. If there is a file of the same name in the copy destination folder, the following dialog is displayed without starting the copy. If touch the [OK] button, overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels to copy.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management

6

6. When the copy is completed, the dialog box of completion is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

Rename operation Rename the selected file.

1. Select the check box of the file to be renamed by touching.

2. Touch the [Rename] button, and then the screen shown below is displayed. Input a new file name. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management 267

26

4. Touch the [OK] button, and then renaming the file is started.

5. When renaming the file is completed, a completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.3 Image File Management

6

6.4 Recipe Information

Before using recipe information For writing/reading into/from a controller with this function or editing of recipe files on the personal computer, refer to the following. Specifications and operating procedure are described. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function of recipe information The recipe file used in the recipe function can be copied, deleted, and output in a file. In addition, it is possible to writing/reading into/from a controller by using this function, without creating the screen to operate the recipe. (Recipe setting of GT Designer3 is required.)

Recipe information The following table shows the functions that can be operated on the recipe information screen.

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders

Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 272 Example of advanced recipe information display, Page 273 Recipe information operation

G2P CSV conversion Converts a G2P file of a recipe file to a CSV file. Page 274 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation

G2P TXT conversion Converts a G2P file of a recipe file to a Unicode text file. Page 274 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation

CSV/TXT G2P conversion A CSV file or Unicode text file is converted to a recipe file (G2P file). Page 276 CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation

Operation Displays the recipe operation window. Page 270 Recipe operation window

Copy Copies the file. Page 295 Copy operation

Move Moves the file. Page 297 Move operation

Rename Renames the file. Page 299 Rename operation

Create Folder Creates a new folder. Page 300 Folder create operation

Delete Deletes a file or folder. Page 301 Delete operation

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 269

27

Recipe operation window This window is a dedicated window for operating recipe files. The recipe data saved in the SRAM user area cannot be manipulated in the recipe operation window. The following table shows the functions of the recipe operation window.

Function Description Reference Recipe operation Displays the recipe operation screen. Page 273 Recipe information operation

Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 279 Recipe operation

Load recipe Writes device values of a selected record into controllers. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 279 Recipe operation Write recipe operation

Save recipe Reads the device values from controllers into a selected record.

Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 279 Recipe operation Read recipe operation

Verify recipe Verifies the device values of a selected record against those of controllers.

Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 279 Recipe operation Verify recipe operation

Update recipe Reads the selected recipe file and saves the data as a newly- named record.

Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 279 Recipe operation Update recipe operation

Copy Copies a recipe file. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 285 Copy operation

New folder Creates a new folder. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 287 Create folder operation

New recipe Creates a new recipe file. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 288 Create recipe operation

Convert Converts a G2P recipe file to a CSV file or Unicode text file. Or, converts a CSV file or Unicode text file to a G2P recipe file.

Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 291 Convert operation

Rename Renames the recipe file. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 293 Rename operation

Delete Deletes a recipe file. Page 273 Recipe information operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Page 294 Delete operation

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Display operation of recipe information

Recipe information

Data management

Operate the recipe file.

Touch [Recipe information].

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 271

27

Example of advanced recipe information display

About the displayed file The files other than that for recipe are not displayed on the recipe information screen.

Number Item Description (1) Select drive The drive which displays file or folder can be selected.

SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive]

(2) Check box If the check box is selected, up to 512 files can be selected.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Confirm the nondisplayed part with the [Rename] button, etc. Page 299 Rename operation After confirmation, touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the operation.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection.

(9) Select all files/Cancel selection Multiple files can be selected or canceled at once. Touch the [Select all files] button to select all files. If the number of the displayed files exceeds 513, the first 512 files are selected.

(10) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(11) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1)

(8) (10) (11)(9)

(2) (5)(3) (4) (6) (7)

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Recipe information operation

Display operation of recipe information 1. If touch a drive of [Select drive], the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line. If touch the button, the screen scrolls up/down by one screen.

5. Touch the check box to select the file.

6. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. G2P CSV, G2P TXT Page 274 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation CSV/TXT G2P conversion Page 276 CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation Operation Page 278 Recipe file manipulation Copy Page 295 Copy operation Move Page 297 Move operation Rename Page 299 Rename operation Create Folder Page 300 Folder create operation Delete Page 301 Delete operation

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 273

27

G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation A recipe file (G2P file) is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file that can be displayed/edited on a personal computer. The conversion source file remains intact.

1. Touch the check box of a G2P file which is to be converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file to select the file.

2. Touch the following button in accordance with destination file type. CSV file: [G2P CSV] button Unicode text file: [G2L TXT] button

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.) (Example: Dialog box if the [G2P CSV] button is touched)

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

5. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box showed below appears without starting the conversion.

To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the conversion, touch the [Cancel] button.

6. The message of completion is displayed in dialog box when conversion is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 275

27

CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation A CSV file or Unicode text file is converted to a recipe file (G2P file). The conversion source file remains intact.

1. To select the file, touch the check box of a CSV file or Unicode text file to be converted to a G2P file.

2. Touch the [CSV/TXT G2P] button to display [Please select destination] at the lower left corner of the screen.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

5. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box showed below appears without starting the conversion.

To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the conversion, touch the [Cancel] button.

6. The message of completion is displayed in dialog box when conversion is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 277

27

Recipe file manipulation Select a recipe file on the recipe file list screen to perform various operations.

1. Touch [DRV] on the recipe file list screen to display the drive selection screen. Select a drive.

2. Touch a recipe file in the file display area to select the recipe file.

3. To return to the parent folder and display its information, touch a [. . ] folder.

4. To scroll the file display area up or down one row, touch the button of the scroll bar.

5. To search for a file by keyword or file type, touch the [Search] button to display the search screen.

6. For the operation of the operation switches, refer to the following. Recipe operation Page 279 Recipe operation Copy Page 285 Copy operation New folder Page 287 Create folder operation New recipe Page 288 Create recipe operation Convert Page 291 Convert operation Rename Page 293 Rename operation Delete Page 294 Delete operation

7. Touch the [] button to close the window.

Operation switch File display area

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Recipe operation To display the recipe operation screen, select a recipe file (G2P file) and touch the [Recipe operation] button.

1. To scroll the file display area up or down one row, touch the button of the scroll bar.

2. To search for a file by record number or record name, touch the [Search] button to display the search screen.

3. Select a record name in the file display area and touch an operation switch to perform the corresponding operation as shown below.

For the operation of the operation switches, refer to the following. Load recipe Write recipe operation Save recipe Read recipe operation Verify recipe Verify recipe operation Update recipe Update recipe operation

4. Touch the [] button to return to the recipe file list screen.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 279

28

Write recipe operation

1. Select a record name in the file display area.

2. Touch the [Load recipe] button on the recipe operation screen to display the dialog shown below.

3. To write device values of the selected record into controllers, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the writing of the values, touch the [Cancel] button.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Read recipe operation

1. Touch the [Save recipe] button on the recipe operation screen to display the record name screen. Touch the record name input area to display an input key window. Enter the name of a record to be created. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

2. Touch the [Enter] button to close the input key window.

3. Touch the [OK] button on the record name screen to display the dialog shown below.

4. To read the device values from controllers into the selected record, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the reading of the values, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 281

28

Verify recipe operation

1. Select a record name in the file display area.

2. Touch the [Verify recipe] button on the recipe operation screen to display the dialog shown below. To verify the recipe file in the GOT against the one in the device, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the verification, touch the [Cancel] button.

3. When the verification is completes and the recipe file of the GOT and the one of the device match, the dialog shown below appears.

When the recipe file of the GOT and the one of the device do not match, the dialog indicating [Verification NG.] appears.

4. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Update recipe operation

1. Select a record name in the file display area.

2. Touch the [Update recipe] button on the recipe operation screen to display the record information screen.

3. Enter a record number in the record number input area. Touch the record number input area to display the input key window.

4. Touch the record name input area to display the input key window. Enter the name of a folder to be created. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

5. Touch the [Enter] button to close the input key window.

6. Touch the [OK] button on the record information screen to display the recipe file storage destination screen. To return to the parent folder and display its information, touch a [. . ] folder. To create a new folder, touch the [New folder] button to display the folder name screen. New folder Page 287 Create folder operation

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 283

28

7. Touch the [OK] button on the recipe file storage destination screen to display the file name screen. Enter a recipe file name in the input area.

8. Touch the recipe file name input area to display the input key window. Input a recipe file name. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

9. Touch the [Enter] button to close the input key window.

10. Touch the [OK] button on the file name screen to display the dialog shown below. To read the device values from controllers into the selected record, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the reading of the values, touch the [Cancel] button.

11. If the recipe read destination folder has a file of the same name, the screen shown below appears without reading device values of controllers.

To overwrite the file of the same name, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the overwriting, touch the [Cancel] button.

12.When the reading of device values from controllers completes, the completion dialog appears. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Copy operation A recipe file is copied.

1. Select a file to copy on the recipe file list screen.

2. Touch the [Copy] button to display the copy destination folder screen. Select a copy destination folder. To return to the parent folder and display its information, touch a [. . ] folder. To create a new folder, touch the [New folder] button to display the folder name screen. New folder Page 287 Create folder operation

3. Touch the [OK] button on the copy destination folder screen to display the dialog shown below. Touch the [OK] button. (The message "Processing" is displayed during processing.)

4. If the copy destination folder has a file of the same name, the screen shown below appears without starting the copy. To overwrite the file of the same name, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the copy, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 285

28

5. When the copy completes, the completion dialog appears. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Create folder operation A new folder is created.

1. Touch the [New folder] button on the recipe file list screen.

2. In the folder name screen, create a new folder. Touch the new folder name input area to display the input key window. Enter the name of a folder to be created. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

3. Touch the [Enter] button to close the input key window.

4. Touch the [OK] button on the folder name screen to display the dialog shown below and create a folder. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 287

28

Create recipe operation A new recipe file is created.

1. Touch the [New recipe] button on the recipe file list screen.

2. The new recipe screen is displayed.

3. Touch the [Generate file] button on the new recipe screen to display the recipe file storage destination screen. To return to the parent folder and display its information, touch a [. . ] folder. To create a new folder, touch the [New folder] button to display the folder name screen. New folder Page 287 Create folder operation

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

4. Touch the [OK] button on the recipe file storage destination screen to display the file name screen.

5. Touch the recipe file name input area to display the input key window. Input a recipe file name. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

6. Touch the [Enter] button to close the input key window.

7. Touch the [OK] button on the file name screen to display the dialog shown below and create a recipe file.

8. If the file storage destination folder has a file of the same name, the screen shown below appears without creating a recipe file.

To overwrite the file of the same name, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the creation of a recipe file, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 289

29

9. Touch the [OK] button to display the recipe operation screen shown below. Touch an operation switch to perform the corresponding operation as shown below. For the operation of the operation switches, refer to the following. Save recipe Page 279 Recipe operation, Read recipe operation Update recipe Page 279 Recipe operation, Update recipe operation

10. Touch the [] button to return to the new recipe screen.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Convert operation A G2P recipe file is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file. Or, a CSV file or Unicode text file is converted to a G2P recipe file. The conversion source file remains intact.

1. Select a file to be converted on the recipe file list screen. The screen displayed when the [Convert] button on the recipe file list screen is touched differs depending on the file to be converted. For G2P recipe files: The conversion file type screen is displayed. For CSV files or Unicode text files: The converted file storage destination screen is displayed.

2. For converting a G2P recipe file, touch the [Convert] button on the recipe file list screen to display the conversion file type screen.

Select the file format of a file to be created after the conversion. [CSV] Converts the file to a CSV file. [Unicode text] Converts the file to a Unicode text file.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 291

29

3. Touch the [OK] button on the conversion file type screen or the [Convert] button on the recipe file list screen to display the converted file storage destination screen.

To return to the parent folder and display its information, touch a [. . ] folder. To create a new folder, touch the [New folder] button to display the folder name screen. New folder Page 287 Create folder operation

4. Touch the [OK] button on the converted file storage destination screen to display the dialog shown below. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Rename operation A recipe file is renamed.

1. Select a file to rename on the recipe file list screen.

2. Touch the [Rename] button on the recipe file list screen to display the file name screen. Enter the file name to be renamed.

3. Touch the recipe file name input area to display the input key window. Input a recipe file name. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

4. Touch the [OK] button on the file name screen to display the dialog shown below. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 293

29

Delete operation A recipe file is deleted.

1. Touch a file to delete on the recipe file list screen.

2. Touch the [Delete] button on the recipe file list screen to display the dialog shown below. To delete the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the deletion, touch the [Cancel] button.

3. When the deletion completes, the completion dialog appears. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Copy operation Folders to be used in recipe are copied.

1. Touch the check box of the file to copy to select the file.

2. Touch the [Copy] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.) At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 295

29

5. If there is a file of the same name in the copy destination folder, the following dialog is displayed without starting the copy. If touch the [OK] button, overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels to copy.

6. When the copy is completed, the dialog box of completion is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Move operation Files to be used in recipe are moved.

1. Touch the check box of the file to be moved to select the file.

2. Touch the [Move] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for moving directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 297

29

5. When any file with the same name exists in the destination folder, the dialog box shown below appears without starting the movement.

Touching the [OK] button overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels moving.

6. When moving is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Rename operation File names to be used in recipe are changed.

1. Select the check box of the file to be renamed by touching.

2. Touch the [Rename] button, and then the screen shown below is displayed. Input the file name to be changed. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. Touch the [OK] button, and then renaming the file is started. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

5. When renaming the file is completed, a completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 299

30

Folder create operation Folders to be used in recipe are created.

1. Touch the [Create Folder] button.

2. The input key window shown below appears, then input the file name to be created. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. If touch the [OK] button, starts creating folder.

5. When creating folder is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Delete operation Folders and files to be used on recipe are deleted.

1. Touch the folder to delete or the check box of the file to delete to select the file.

2. If touch the [Del] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If touch the [OK] button, the file/folder is deleted. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.) If touch the [Cancel] button, the deletion is canceled.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4. When it cannot be deleted, the dialog box showed below appears. (Only when deleting a folder is executed.) Verify that there is no file in the folder and execute the delete operation again. Page 302 Precautions

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 301

30

Precautions

When creating or deleting folders or files Number of characters set for a folder or file name when creating a folder or file GOT recognizes file location according to path explained below. Specify folder or file name, and total characters of path cannot exceed 78 characters. Users only can rename folder or file name. (Other than folder/file name is automatically printed.) Example: CSV file path in a data storage

If folder is assigned the hierarchy. The \ mark is displayed between a folder name and folder name, a folder name and file name. The \ mark is also counted as one character.

Character strings that cannot be set to a folder/file The following character strings cannot be used as a folder name or a file name. Even small characters of those cannot be used.

In addition, the folder/file name showed below cannot be used. The folder name which begins with G2 Folder name and file name which begins with . (period) Folder name and file name which ends with . (period) Folder name and file name which has only . (one period) or ..(two periods)

For deleting the folder The folder in which the file exists cannot be deleted. Delete the folder after having deleted the files. In addition, on the recipe information screen, the file other than that for recipe is not displayed on the GOT. When the folder, in which there is no file displayed on the screen, cannot be deleted, confirm whether there is other file in the data storage by using a personal computer, etc.

Available character codes Although characters other than one-byte alphanumeric characters (ASCII) can be used for a file name, the characters become garbled when the file name is displayed on the file list of the utility screen. When operating files on the utility screen, use one-byte alphanumeric characters (ASCII) for file names.

Restrictions on the file display area of the recipe file list screen Number of files displayed in the folder display area If the number of the files stored in one folder is 501 or more, the 501st and later files are not displayed. Number of characters set for folder and file names at the creation of new folders and files Specify the folder and file names so that the number of the characters for the path is 84 or less. If the number of the characters is 85 or more, the 85th and later characters are not displayed.

COM1 to COM9 LPT1 to LPT9 AUX CON

NUL PRN CLOCK$

Max. 78 characters

Folder name .CSV\A :\

Extension

(4 characters) Drive name

(1 character)

(1 character)(2 characters)

File name

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information

6

Precautions for operation Precautions during folder/file operation (Create/Delete/Copy/File output, etc) Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is processing folders and files, the processing continues to be executed. (Example: Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is creating a folder, the folder is created.) Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the cover of the SD card interface is opened.

While GOT is accessing to other file (Alarm data, etc) When folder/file processing for the recipe is executed while the GOT is in access to other file (SD card access LED ON), the GOT executes folder/file processing for the recipe after the processing for other file has completed. Therefore, it may take some time to finish the process of recipe folder/file.(The "Processing..." message is displayed on the screen.)

Estimation of processing time The process may take time depending on the setting of advanced recipe file to be operated. (The more number of blocks increases, the longer it takes to process recipe folder/file.) The following shows the reference values for connection to a QCPU using the direct CPU connection (serial). Device point: 32767 points setting, transmission speed: 115200bps When the block setting number is 1: about 17 seconds When the block setting number is 2048: about 4 minutes

Reading or writing the device values of the recipe file moved or renamed If you move or rename a recipe file, specify the new path or file name in the [Recipe] dialog in GT Designer3. Write the project data to the GOT afterward.

Changing a folder or file name You cannot change only the case of the characters in a folder or file name. Example)

To change only the case of the characters in a folder or file name, rename the folder or file to a different name, and then rename the folder or file back to its original name with the case changed.

G2P file to which recipe data is exported In the recipe operation window, you cannot manipulate a G2P file to which recipe data is exported.

Before change

january

january

JANUARY january

JANUARY

January

After change

6 DATA CONTROL 6.4 Recipe Information 303

30

6.5 Logging Information Function of logging information Logging files created with the logging function can be copied, deleted or renamed, etc. Without using a personal computer, you can manage logging files on the GOT. For details on the logging function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of logging information

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 305 Example of logging

information display, Page 306 Logging information operation

G2L CSV conversion Converts a G2L file of a logging file to a CSV file. Page 307 G2L CSV conversion operation, G2L TXT conversion operation

G2L TXT conversion Converts a G2L file of a logging file to a Unicode text file. Page 307 G2L CSV conversion operation, G2L TXT conversion operation

Deletion Deletes a file or folder. Page 309 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 310 Copy operation

Move Moves the file. Page 312 Move operation

Rename Renames the file. Page 314 Rename operation

Create Folder New folder is created. Page 315 Folder create operation

Logging information

Touch [Logging information].

Data management

Operate the logging file.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

Example of logging information display

*1 To display the creation date and time of a file or folder using the file server time, set the same time zone for the GOT and file server.

About the displayed file The files other than that for logging are not displayed on the logging information screen.

Number Item Description (1) Select drive Select a drive to display files or folders.

When a USB memory or network drive is used, the following drives are displayed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive] Network drive: [N: Network drive] *1

(2) Check box If the check box is selected, up to 512 files can be selected.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Confirm the nondisplayed part with the [Rename] button, etc. Page 314 Rename operation After confirmation, touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the operation.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection.

(9) Select all files/Cancel selection Multiple files can be selected or canceled at once. Touch the [Select all files] button to select all files. If the number of the displayed files exceeds 513, the first 512 files are selected.

(10) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(11) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1) (8) (10) (11)(9)

(2)

(5)

(3) (4) (6) (7)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 305

30

Logging information operation

Display operation of logging information 1. If touch a drive of [Select drive], the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line. If touch the button, the screen scrolls up/down by one screen.

5. Touch the check box to select the file.

6. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. G2L CSV, G2L TXT Page 307 G2L CSV conversion operation, G2L TXT conversion operation Delete Page 309 Deletion operation Copy Page 310 Copy operation Move Page 312 Move operation Rename Page 314 Rename operation Create Folder Page 315 Folder create operation

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

G2L CSV conversion operation, G2L TXT conversion operation A logging file (G2L file) is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file that can be displayed/edited on a personal computer.

1. Touch the check box of a G2L file which is to be converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file to select the file.

2. Touch the following button in accordance with destination file type. CSV file: [G2L CSV] button Unicode text file: [G2L TXT] button

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.) (Example: Dialog box if the [G2L CSV] button is touched)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 307

30

5. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box showed below appears without starting the conversion.

To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the conversion, touch the [Cancel] button.

6. The message of completion is displayed in dialog box when conversion is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

Deletion operation Folder and file to be used on logging are deleted.

1. Touch the folder to delete or the check box of the file to delete to select the file.

2. If touch the [Del] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If touch the [OK] button, the file/folder is deleted. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.) If touch the [Cancel] button, the deletion is canceled.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4. When it cannot be deleted, the dialog box showed below appears. (Only when deleting a folder is executed.) Verify that there is no file in the folder and execute the delete operation again. Page 316 Precautions

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 309

31

Copy operation Folder to be used in logging is copied.

1. Touch the check box of the file to copy to select the file.

2. Touch the [Copy] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.) At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

5. If there is a file of the same name in the copy destination folder, the following dialog is displayed without starting the copy. If touch the [OK] button, overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels to copy.

6. When the copy is completed, the dialog box of completion is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 311

31

Move operation An operation log file is moved.

1. Touch the check box of the file to be moved to select the file.

2. Touch the [Move] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for moving directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

5. When any file with the same name exists in the destination folder, the dialog box shown below appears without starting the movement.

Touching the [OK] button overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels moving.

6. When moving is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 313

31

Rename operation An operation log file is changed.

1. Select the check box of the file to be renamed by touching.

2. Touch the [Rename] button, and then the screen shown below is displayed. Input the file name to be changed. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. Touch the [OK] button, and then renaming the file is started. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

5. When renaming the file is completed, a completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

Folder create operation An operation log folder is created.

1. Touch the [Create Folder] button.

2. The input key window shown below appears, then input the file name to be created. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. If touch the [OK] button, starts creating folder.

5. When creating folder is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 315

31

Precautions

When creating or deleting folders or files Number of characters set for a folder or file name when creating a folder or file GOT recognizes file location according to path explained below. Specify folder or file name, and total characters of path cannot exceed 78 characters. Users only can rename folder or file name. (Other than folder/file name is automatically printed.) Example: CSV file path in a data storage

If folder is assigned the hierarchy. The \ mark is displayed between a folder name and folder name, a folder name and file name. The \ mark is also counted as one character.

Character strings that cannot be set to a folder/file The following character strings cannot be used as a folder name or a file name. Even small characters of those cannot be used.

In addition, the folder/file name showed below cannot be used. The folder name which begins with G2 Folder name and file name which begins with . (period) Folder name and file name which ends with . (period) Folder name and file name which has only . (one period) or ..(two periods)

For deleting the folder The folder in which the file exists cannot be deleted. Delete the folder after having deleted the files. In addition, on the logging information screen, the files other than logging files are not displayed on GOT. When the folder, in which there is no file displayed on the screen, cannot be deleted, confirm whether there is other file in the data storage by using a personal computer, etc.

COM1 to COM9 LPT1 to LPT9 AUX CON

NUL PRN CLOCK$

Max. 78 characters

Folder name .CSV\A :\

Extension

(4 characters) Drive name

(1 character)

(1 character)(2 characters)

File name

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information

6

Precautions for operation Precautions during folder/file operation (Create/Delete/Copy/File output, etc) Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is processing folders and files, the processing continues to be executed. (Example: Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is creating a folder, the folder is created.) Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the cover of the SD card interface is opened.

While GOT is accessing to other file (Alarm data, etc) When folder/file processing for the logging is executed while the GOT is in access to other files (SD card access LED ON), the GOT executes folder/file processing for the logging after the processing for other files is completed. Therefore, it may take some time to finish the process of the logging folder/file. (The "Processing..." message is displayed on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.5 Logging Information 317

31

6.6 Operation Log Information Function of operation log information Operation log files created with the operation log function can be copied, deleted or renamed, etc. Without using a personal computer, you can manage operation log files on the GOT. For details of the operation log function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 319 Display operation of operation

log information

G2O CSV conversion Converts a G2O file of an operation log file to a CSV file. Page 323 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation

G2O TXT conversion Converts a G2O file of an operation log file to a Unicode text file. Page 323 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation

Deletion Deletes a file or folder. Page 339 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 333 Copy operation

Move Moves the file. Page 335 Move operation

Rename Renames the file. Page 337 Rename operation

Create Folder Creates a folder. Page 338 Folder create operation

List Displays operation logs in a list and allows searching. Page 327 List display

Switching the display format Changes the display format of an operation log. Page 329 Display format switching operation

Switching display order Changes the display order of an operation log. Page 329 Display order switching operation

Switching the screen image display Switches between displaying and hiding the window of the screen image on the operation log list.

Page 330 Display operation of screen image

Search Searches an operation log. Page 331 Search operation

Changing the date format Changes the date format used for the [Operation Log Data List] screen and the dialogs displayed from the [Operation Log Data List] screen.

Page 332 Date format change operation

Latest Displays the latest operation log in a list. Page 325 Latest display

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Display operation of operation log information

Default display drive when displaying the operation log information screen. When [Save to] of the [Environmental Setting] dialog is set in GT Designer3, the default display drive for displaying the operation log information screen is the drive set in GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual In the following cases, the default display drive is A drive. [Save to] is not specified in GT Designer3. The drive set as [Save to] in GT Designer3 is not found.

Operation log information

Data management

Touch [Operation log information].

Operate the operation log file.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 319

32

Example of operation log information display

Operation log information screen

About the displayed file The files other than that for operation log are not displayed on the operation log information screen.

Number Item Description (1) Select drive Select a drive to display files or folders.

When a USB memory is installed in a drive, the drive is displayed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive]

(2) Check box If the check box is selected, up to 512 files can be selected.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Confirm the nondisplayed part with the [Rename] button, etc. Page 337 Rename operation After confirmation, touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the operation.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection.

(9) Select all files/Cancel selection

Multiple files can be selected or canceled at once. Touch the [Select all files] button to select all files. If the number of the displayed files exceeds 513, the first 512 files are selected.

(10) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(11) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1)

(9) (10) (11) (8)

(2) (5)(3) (4) (6) (7)

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Operation log data list screen

*1 The display format of the mobile screens are common to base screens (GOT Mobile), overlap windows 1 and 2 (GOT Mobile), and superimpose windows 1 and 2 (GOT Mobile).

Number Item Description (1) [File Name] Displays the file name and path to the displayed operation log file.

(2) [A.D.] Displays the year when the operation log file is created.

(3) [Date] Displays the operation date.

[Time] Displays the operation time.

[Screen No.] Displays the operated screen numbers in "screen type-screen number" format. When there is no screen number, - (hyphen) is displayed. The following display formats are used to display the screen types. Base screen: B Overlap window 1: O1 Overlap window 2: O2 Overlap window 3: O3 Overlap window 4: O4 Overlap window 5: O5 Superimpose window 1: S1 Superimpose window 2: S2 Dialog: D Key window: K Operation panel: P Mobile screen*1: M

[Operation] (display format 1) Displays the operation contents.

[Operation] (display format 2) Displays the operation name. For an unnamed operation, the type of the operation is displayed.

[Change To] Displays the value after operation.

[Change From] Displays the value before operation.

(4) [Switch display] Switches between the display format 1 and display format 2. For display format switching operation, refer to the following. Page 329 Display format switching operation

(5) [Date (descending)], [Date (ascending)]

Changes the display order of an operation logs in ascending or descending order. For display order switching operation, refer to the following. Page 329 Display order switching operation

(6) [Image] Displays the window of the screen image corresponding to the operation log in the selected row. For display operation of screen image, refer to the following. Page 330 Display operation of screen image

(7) , Move the cursor up or down.

(8) [Search] Searches the operation for the operation logs by date and time. For search operation for the operation logs, refer to the following. Page 331 Search operation

(1) (4)(3) (1) (4)(3)

(2)

(5) (7)(6) (8) (5) (7)(6) (8) Display format 1 Display format 2

(2)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 321

32

Operation log information operation

Display operation of operation log information 1. If touch a drive of [Select drive], the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line. If touch the button, the screen scrolls up/down by one screen.

5. Touch the check box to select the file.

6. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. G2O CSV, G2O TXT Page 323 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation Deletion Page 339 Deletion operation Copy Page 333 Copy operation Move Page 335 Move operation Rename Page 337 Rename operation Create Folder Page 338 Folder create operation List Page 327 List display Latest Page 325 Latest display

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

Restrictions on the operations of the Operation log information screen Turning on the Prohibit Operation Log Information Operation signal (GS522.b3) restricts the operations on the Operation log information screen to only the [Latest] and [List] buttons. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation An operation log file (G2O file) is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file that can be displayed/edited on a personal computer.

1. Touch the check box of a G2O file which is to be converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file to select the file.

2. Touch the following button in accordance with destination file type. CSV file: [G2O CSV] button Unicode text file: [G2O TXT] button

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

(Example: Dialog box if the [G2O CSV] button is touched)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 323

32

5. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box showed below appears without starting the conversion.

To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the conversion, touch the [Cancel] button.

6. The message of completion is displayed in dialog box when conversion is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Latest display The latest operation log files are selected and displayed in a list.

1. If touch the [Latest] button, the latest one in the operation log files is displayed in a list.

2. Touching the [List] button displays the list. In the list, the following contents can be checked.

For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. Switch display Page 329 Display format switching operation Date (ascending/descending) Page 329 Display order switching operation Search Page 331 Search operation

Display format Display item Description Display type 1 [Date] Displays the operation date.

[Time] Displays the operation time.

[Screen No.] Displays the screen number of the operated screen.

[Operation] Displays the operation contents.

[Change To] Displays the value after operation.

Display type 2 [Date] Displays the operation date.

[Time] Displays the operation time.

[Operation] Displays the operation name. For an unnamed operation, the type of the operation is displayed.

[Change To] Displays the value after operation.

[Change From] Displays the value before operation.

Display format 1 Display format 2

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 325

32

3. For the method for displaying the detail of each operation log, refer to the following. Page 327 List display

Display format 1 Display format 2

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

List display Displays operation logs in an operation log file in a list.

1. Touch the check box of the file to display the list to select the file.

2. Touching the [List] button displays the list. In the list, the following contents can be checked.

For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. Switch display Page 329 Display format switching operation Date (ascending/descending) Page 329 Display order switching operation Image Page 330 Display operation of screen image Search Page 331 Search operation

Display type Display item Description Display type 1 [Date] Displays the operation date.

[Time] Displays the operation time.

[Screen No.] Displays the screen number of the operated screen.

[Operation] Displays the performed operation.

[Change To] Displays the value after the operation.

Display type 2 [Date] Displays the operation date.

[Time] Displays the operation time.

[Operation] Displays the operation name. For an unnamed operation, the type of the operation is displayed.

[Change To] Displays the value after operation.

[Change From] Displays the value before operation.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 327

32

3. To display the details of an operation log, touch the row for that operation log to select it. The color of the row is inverted (white black).

4. Touching the selected row again displays the detailed information for the operation log. Touch the [] button to close the dialog box.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Display format switching operation 1. Touch the [Switch display] button in the list to switch the screen between the display type 1 and 2.

Operation name display at system language switching The items appearing in [Operation] of display format 2 depend on the settings on GT Designer3, and thus the display language of the items is not changed with the system language of the GOT.

Display order switching operation 1. Touch [Date (ascending)]/[Date (descending)] in the list to switch the display order of operation logs. [Date (ascending)] and [Date (descending)] are switched every time the button is touched. The buttons show the current display order. [Date (ascending)]: Data is displayed in chronological order as collected. [Date (descending)]: Data is displayed in reverse chronological order as collected.

Selected line position after switching the display order After the display order is switched while lines are selected, the lines still remain selected. Depending on which line is selected, the selected line may not be displayed on the screen after switching the display order. Display order of operation logs in non-chronological order When the display order of operation logs are switched, the logs are displayed in order as collected, not in order as the date they are collected. In case that the displayed operation logs are not lined up in time order due to the time change of GOT clock, the displayed logs may not be lined up in order of the log dates even though the operation logs are switched.

Display format 1 Display format 2

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 329

33

Display operation of screen image 1. Touch the [Image] button in the list to switch displaying/hiding the window of the screen image corresponding to the

operation log in the selected row. Touch the title bar to move the window of the screen image. The window of the screen image is displayed until the display of the list is closed. Touch the [] button to close the window of the screen image.

When the row in the operation log is not selected, or when the row in the operation log , which indicates an error such as data damaged, is selected

The window color of the screen image is a gray. Whether to display the screen image or not Whether the screen image is displayed or not depends on the object type or the operation type. Precautions for displaying the screen image The screen image to be displayed is an object or a shape based on the object data. Therefore, if the numerical display, the lamp display, and others exist on the screen, the numeric value and the status of the lamp in the actual operation are not displayed. If the project data when the operation log is collected is different from that currently in operation, the screen image might not be dislayed properly.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Search operation 1. Touching [Search] in the list enables searching of a log using the following items. Item: Date Time

2. Input the date or time to be searched.

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (When processing is being executed, the "Processing" message is displayed on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 331

33

4. The results found are displayed and the dialog box shown below is displayed. To continue a search, touch the [OK] button. To stop a search, touch the [Cancel] button.

5. When searching is completed, a completion message is displayed in the dialog box. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

Date format change operation Use GS632 to change the data format for the [Operation Log Data List] screen and the dialogs displayed from the [Operation Log Data List] screen. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Copy operation An operation log file is copied.

1. Touch the check box of the file to copy to select the file.

2. Touch the [Copy] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for outputting directly below the drive.) At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 333

33

5. If there is a file of the same name in the copy destination folder, the following dialog is displayed without starting the copy. If touch the [OK] button, overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels to copy.

6. When the copy is completed, the dialog box of completion is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Move operation An operation log file is moved.

1. Touch the check box of the file to be moved to select the file.

2. Touch the [Move] button.

3. Select the target folder. (Selecting a folder is not needed for moving directly below the drive.)

4. If touch the [Exec] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 335

33

5. When any file with the same name exists in the destination folder, the dialog box shown below appears without starting the movement.

Touching the [OK] button overwrites the file. If touch the [Cancel] button, cancels moving.

6. When moving is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Rename operation An operation log file is changed.

1. Select the check box of the file to be renamed by touching.

2. Touch the [Rename] button, and then the screen shown below is displayed. Input the file name to be changed. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. Touch the [OK] button, and then renaming the file is started. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.)

5. When renaming the file is completed, a completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 337

33

Folder create operation An operation log folder is created.

1. Touch the [Create Folder] button.

2. The input key window shown below appears, then input the file name to be created. By touching the following button, input text type is changed. [A-Z]: Alphabet capital [0-9]: Numeric/Symbol

3. Touch the [Enter] button, and then the dialog box shown below is displayed.

4. If touch the [OK] button, starts creating folder.

5. When creating folder is completed, completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

Deletion operation Folder and file to be used on operation log are deleted.

1. Touch the folder to delete or the check box of the file to delete to select the file.

2. If touch the [Del] button, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If touch the [OK] button, the file/folder is deleted. (While executing, "Processing..." message appears on the screen.) If touch the [Cancel] button, the deletion is canceled.

3. When the deletion is completed, the completion dialog box is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

4. When it cannot be deleted, the dialog box showed below appears. (Only when deleting a folder is executed.) Verify that there is no file in the folder and execute the delete operation again. Page 340 Precautions

6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information 339

34

Precautions

When creating or deleting folders or files Number of characters set for a folder or file name when creating a folder or file GOT recognizes file location according to path explained below. Specify folder or file name, and total characters of path cannot exceed 78 characters. Users only can rename folder or file name. (Other than folder/file name is automatically printed.) Example: CSV file path in a data storage

If folder is assigned the hierarchy. The \ mark is displayed between a folder name and folder name, a folder name and file name. The \ mark is also counted as one character.

Character strings that cannot be set to folder/file The following character strings cannot be used as a folder name or a file name. Even small characters of those cannot be used.

In addition, the folder/file name showed below cannot be used. The folder name which begins with G2 Folder name and file name which begins with . (period) Folder name and file name which ends with . (period) Folder name and file name which has only . (one period) or ..(two periods)

For deleting the folder The folder in which the file exists cannot be deleted. Delete the folder after having deleted the files. In addition, on the operation log information screen, the file other than that for operation log is not displayed on GOT. When the folder, in which there is no file displayed on the screen, cannot be deleted, confirm whether there is other file in the data storage by using a personal computer, etc.

Precautions for operation Precautions during folder/file operation (Create/Delete/Copy/File output, etc) Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is processing folders and files, the processing continues to be executed. (Example: Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is creating a folder, the folder is created.) Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the cover of the SD card interface is opened.

COM1 to COM9 LPT1 to LPT9 AUX CON

NUL PRN CLOCK$

Max. 78 characters

Folder name .CSV\A :\

Extension

(4 characters) Drive name

(1 character)

(1 character)(2 characters)

File name

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.6 Operation Log Information

6

6.7 File Manager You can manipulate or sort the folders and files stored in each drive of the GOT.

Required system application (extended function) The system application (extended function) for the file manager is required.

System application (extended function) Write the package data that contains the system application (extended function) for the file manager to the GOT. For the communication method with the GOT, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

System application (extended function) size To install a system application (extended function) to the GOT, enough space in the user area is required. For information on how to check the available space of the user area and each data size, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Reference Folder and file list Displays the type, name, size, and updated date and time of each folder or

file.The folders and files can be sorted in ascending or descending order. Page 342 Display operation of the file manager screen Page 345 Sorting folders and files

Copy Copies a folder or file . Page 346 Copy

Move Moves a folder or file. Page 348 Move

New folder Creates a folder. Page 350 New folder

Delete Deletes a folder or file. Page 351 Delete

Rename Renames a folder or file. Page 352 Rename

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 341

34

Display operation of the file manager screen

Manipulate a file or folder.

Touch [File manager].

Data management

File manager

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

Display example of the file manager screen

Number Item Description (1) [DRV] button Displays the [Select drive] screen to select a target drive.

SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive] Network drive: [N: Network drive]

(2) Drive and folder path display Displays the path to the drive or folder that stores the currently listed folders or files.If the number of characters in the path exceeds the limit, only the characters within the limit are displayed.

(3) Move-to-parent folder button Moves to the parent folder.

(4) Check box Select a checkbox to select a folder or file.To select all folders and files, select the top checkbox.

(5) Type Displays the folder and file icons.

Name Displays the folder and file names.A long folder or file name does not wrap to the next line, and the portion of the name that lies off the display area is invisible.A folder or file is not listed in the following cases.The full path to the folder or file contains 79 or more characters including delimiters (\).The folder or file name starts with G2 or G1

Size Displays the file size.This item is not displayed for folders.

Updated Displays the updated date and time of folders and files.

(6) Drive information Displays the information of the drive, folders, or files.The following information is displayed.Available space and capacity of the selected driveNumber of selected folders and files, and their total size

(7) Operation buttons Execute intended operations.

(3)

(2)

(4) (5)

(6)

(7)

(1)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 343

34

Operations on the file manager screen

Data display operation 1. Touch the [DRV] button to display the [Select drive] screen. Select a drive to list the data stored in the drive.

2. Double-touch a folder name to list the data stored in the folder.

3. Touch the move-to-parent folder button to list the data stored in the parent folder.

4. Scroll through the list by using the scroll bar or sliding the file display area.

5. Touch a checkbox to select a folder or file.

6. For the operation of the operation buttons, refer to the following. Page 346 Copy Page 348 Move Page 350 New folder Page 351 Delete Page 352 Rename

7. Touch the [] button to close the screen.

File display area

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

Sorting folders and files The folders and files can be sorted in ascending or descending order. The mark or is displayed in the header of the column by which the list is sorted. The following shows the applicable column headers. Type Name Size Updated Example) When sorting the folders and files alphabetically

1. Touch the [Name] header to sort the folders and files alphabetically in ascending order.

2. Touch the [Name] header again to sort them alphabetically in descending order.

Header

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 345

34

Copy A selected folder or file is copied.

1. Touch a checkbox to select a folder or file.

2. Touch the [Copy] button to copy the selected folder or file, switching the display of the operation buttons and the drive information contents.

3. Touch a copy destination folder. You cannot paste the selected folder or file in the same folder. Select a different folder to store.

4. Touch the [OK] button to display a confirmation dialog.

5. Touch the [OK] button to start the copy. To cancel the copy, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

6. If the copy destination folder has a folder or file with the same name, the overwrite confirmation dialog appears. To overwrite the folder or file with the same name, touch the [YES] button. To not to copy the folder or file, touch the [NO] button. To cancel the copy, touch the [Cancel] button.

7. If the copy destination folder has multiple folders or files with the same name, another confirmation dialog appears. To perform the same process for the rest of folders or files, touch the [YES] button.To display the overwrite confirmation dialog for the next folder or file, touch the [NO] button.

8. Upon completion of the copy process, the confirmation dialog appears saying the numbers of successes and failures. Touch the [OK] button to close the confirmation dialog.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 347

34

Move A selected folder or file is moved.

1. Touch a checkbox to select a folder or file.

2. Touch the [Move] button to move the selected folder or file, switching the display of the operation buttons and the drive information contents.

3. Touch a move destination folder.

4. Touch the [OK] button to display a confirmation dialog.

5. Touch the [OK] button to start the move. To cancel the move, touch the [Cancel] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

6. If the move destination folder has a folder or file with the same name, the overwrite confirmation dialog appears. To overwrite the folder or file with the same name, touch the [YES] button. To not to move the folder or file, touch the [NO] button. To cancel the move, touch the [Cancel] button.

7. If the move destination folder has multiple folders or files with the same name, another confirmation dialog appears. To perform the same process for the rest of folders or files, touch the [YES] button. To display the overwrite confirmation dialog for the next folder or file, touch the [NO] button.

8. Upon completion of the move process, the confirmation dialog appears saying the numbers of successes and failures. Touch the [OK] button to close the confirmation dialog.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 349

35

New folder A folder is created.

1. Touch the [New folder] button to display the [Folder name] screen.

2. Touch the text box to display the key window.

3. Enter a folder name with the key window. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

4. Touch the [Enter] button to confirm the entry.

5. Touch the [OK] button to create the folder.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

Delete A selected folder or file is deleted.

1. Touch a checkbox to select a folder or file.

2. Touch the [Delete] button to display a confirmation dialog.

3. Touch the [OK] button to start the deletion. To cancel the deletion, touch the [Cancel] button.

4. Upon completion of the delete process, the confirmation dialog appears saying the numbers of successes and failures. Touch the [OK] button to close the confirmation dialog.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 351

35

Rename A selected folder or file is renamed.

1. Touch a checkbox to select a folder or file.

2. Touch the [Rename] button to display the [Folder name] screen or the [File name] screen.

3. Touch the text box to display the key window.

4. Enter a new name with the key window. To change the character type, touch any of the following buttons. [A-Z]: Uppercase alphabet [a-z]: Lowercase alphabet [@]: Symbols [0-9]: Numeric characters, A to F

5. Touch the [Enter] button to confirm the entry.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

6. Touch the [OK] button to rename the folder or file.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 353

35

Precautions

When creating or deleting folders or files Number of characters in the folder or file name GOT recognizes file location according to path explained below. Specify folder or file name, and total characters of path cannot exceed 78 characters. Users only can rename folder or file name. (Other than folder/file name is automatically printed.) Example: CSV file path in a data storage

If folder is assigned the hierarchy. The \ mark is displayed between a folder name and folder name, a folder name and file name. The \ mark is also counted as one character.

Character strings that cannot be set to a folder/file The following character strings cannot be used as a folder name or a file name. Even small characters of those cannot be used. COM1 to COM9, LPT1 to LPT9, AUX, CON, NUL, PRN, CLOCK$ In addition, the folder/file name showed below cannot be used. Folder and file names starting with G2 or G1 Folder and file names starting with a period (.) Folder and file names ending with a period (.)

Unavailable characters in the folder name One-byte spaces and the following characters cannot be used in a folder name. / \ ? * : " < >

For deleting the folder The deletion of a folder is executed even if another function is using a file in the folder. If such a file is deleted, the function that is using the file may not operate properly. Do not delete a folder that is set for another function.

Available character codes Although characters other than one-byte alphanumeric characters (ASCII) can be entered for a folder or file name, the characters become garbled when the file name is displayed in the file list of the utility screen. To manipulate folders or files on the utility screen, use one-byte alphanumeric characters (ASCII) for folder and file names.

Max. 78 characters

Folder name .CSV\A :\

Extension

(4 characters) Drive name

(1 character)

(1 character)(2 characters)

File name

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager

6

Precautions for operation Precautions during folder/file operation (Create/Delete/Copy/File output, etc) Even if the cover of the SD card interface is opened while the GOT is processing folders and files, the processing continues to be executed. Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the cover of the SD card interface is opened.

While the GOT is accessing another file (such as alarm data) If you manipulate a folder or file while the GOT is accessing another file, the GOT completes the current process and then executes the manipulation process. In such a case, the manipulation process may take a longer time than usual.

Copying or moving a folder When a folder is copied or moved to another folder with the same name, if the folders contain a file with the same name, the file in the destination folder is automatically replaced.

Changing a folder or file name You cannot change only the case of the characters in a folder or file name. Example)

To change only the case of the characters in a folder or file name, rename the folder or file to a different name, and then rename the folder or file back to its original name with the case changed.

Maximum number of folders and files displayable in the list Up to 2000 folders and files stored in the same path are displayable in the list. If the number of folders and files stored in the same path is 2001 or more, the overflow folders and files are not displayed. You cannot select or sort the overflow folders and files. To display all folders and files stored in the same path, reduce the number of folders and files to 2000 or less by deleting unnecessary folders or files, storing folders or files to a different folder, or other methods.

Copying or moving a file to a folder in which a read-only file with the same name is stored A read-only file cannot be overwritten. To copy or move a file to a folder in which a read-only file with the same name is stored, rename the source file before copying or moving it to the folder.

Before change

january

january

JANUARY january

JANUARY

January

After change

6 DATA CONTROL 6.7 File Manager 355

35

6.8 File Print Preview or print a report file created with the report function. For the details of the report function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Required system application (extended function) The system application (extended function) for the file print is required.

System application (extended function) Write the package data that contains the following system applications (extended function) to the GOT. [File Print] [Printer(PictBridge)], [Printer(Serial)], or [Printer(ESC/P-R, PCL5)] [Report] For the communication method with the GOT, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Data size of the system application (extended function) To install a system application (extended function) to the GOT, enough space in the user area is required. For information on how to check the available space of the user area and each data size, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Reference Print file list display Displays the type, name, data size, and updated date and time of each file. Page 358 Display example of the file print

screen

Print Prints the file selected in the list. Page 360 Print

Preview Previews the file selected in the list. Page 361 Preview

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print

6

Display operation of the file print

Preview or print a file.

Touch [File print].

Data management

Print file list display

6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print 357

35

Display example of the file print screen

Number Item Description 1) [DRV] button Displays the [Select drive] screen to select a target drive.

SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive] Network drive: [N: Network drive]

2) Drive and folder path display Displays the path to the drive or folder that stores the currently listed folders or files. If the number of characters in the path exceeds the limit, only the characters within the limit are displayed.

3) Move-to-parent folder button Moves to the parent folder.

4) Checkbox to select a file to be printed

Select a checkbox to select a file.

5) Drive information Displays the information of the selected file. The following information is displayed. Free space and capacity of the drive Number of selected files and the total data size

6) Scroll keys Scroll the list up or down by row.

7) Scroll bar Touch the empty area above or below the scroll bar knob to scroll one page up or down. Alternatively, touch and hold the knob, and slide the knob up or down to scroll the page to the desired position.

8) Type Displays the folder and file icons.

Name Displays the folder and file names. Up to 2000 folders and files can be displayed. (For GT23: Up to 500 folders and files) Only report files (*.G2R) are listed. The folder or file whose full path contains 79 characters or more is not listed. A long folder or file name does not wrap to the next line, and the portion of the name that lies off the display area is invisible.

Swiping up or down scrolls the screen. Double touching a folder name moves to the folder. Touching a file name selects the row.

Size Displays files sizes. This item is not displayed for folders.

Updated Displays the updated date and time of folders and files.

9) Operation buttons [Print]: Prints the selected files. [Preview]: Previews the selected files. [Select all]: Selects all files. [Cancel all]: Deselects all files.

3)

2)

4)

8)

6)

7)

6) 5)

9)

1)

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print

6

Operation of the file print

Sorting folders and files The folders and files can be sorted in ascending or descending order. The mark or is displayed in the header of the column by which the list is sorted. The following shows the applicable column headers. Print Type Name Size Updated Example) When sorting the folders and files alphabetically

1. Touch the [Name] header to sort the folders and files alphabetically in ascending order.

2. Touch the [Name] header again to sort them alphabetically in descending order.

Header

6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print 359

36

Print Print the selected file.

1. Touch a check box to select the file.

2. Touch the [Print] button to display a confirmation dialog.

3. Touch the [OK] button to start printing. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the printing job.

4. After the printing starts, a progress dialog appears to display the progress of printing. Touch the [Cancel] button to abort printing and close the progress dialog.

Restriction on printing Use GS522.b4 to disable printing. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print

6

Preview Preview the selected file.

1. Touch a row to select the file.

2. Touch the [Preview] button to preview the file.

Number Item Description 1) Preview Print preview

For a file exceeding 1000 pages, 1001st and later pages cannot be displayed.

2) Scroll buttons Scroll the preview screen up, down, right, or left.

3) Display magnification Display magnification of the preview screen Change the display magnification with the zoom in or zoom out button.

4) Previous page button Displays the previous page.

5) Next page button Displays the next page.

6) [Page] Displays the page number of the currently displayed page and the total number of pages. Displays the key window. Enter a page number to be displayed.

7) [Print] button Prints the currently displayed file.

8) Return button Returns to the print file list display screen.

2)

1)

3) 4)

7)

8)

5)6)

6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print 361

36

Precautions

Position of a page break on the preview screen and in the printed file When the printer type is set to [Serial] and [Output Timing] is set to [At the time of data collection], the position of a page break may differ between the preview screen and the printed file.

Displayable page layout on the preview screen when using a serial printer For the page layout of a report screen to be previewed, set 70 lines or less and 124 columns or less, when the printer type is [Serial]. Setting the lines and columns above the limit may fail to preview the report screen.

Operating the [Print preview] screen during a page refresh You cannot perform the following operations on the [Print preview] screen during a page refresh. Page turning with the previous or next page button Page turning by a flick For a page turning across multiple pages, touch the current page number and enter a new page number to move to in the key window.

Print preview and the printed output The print preview and printed output may be inconsistent. Print a file and check the layout and others of the printed output.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.8 File Print

6

6.9 Package Data Management Function of package data management The package data held by each drive (A: Built-in SD card, B: USB drive, C: built-in flash memory, E: USB drive, F: USB drive, G: USB drive) is displayed. The following operations can be performed.

Display operation of package data management

Function Description Reference Install All package data written in drive A (Built-in SD card), drive B (USB drive), drive E (USB drive),

drive F (USB drive), and drive G (USB drive) can be installed in drive C (Built-in flash memory). Page 366 Installation operation

Upload All package data written in drive C (Built-in flash memory) can be uploaded to drive A (Built-in SD card), drive B (USB drive), drive E (USB drive), drive F (USB drive), and drive G (USB drive).

Page 368 Upload operation

Property The versions of system applications and communication drivers, and other information can be checked.

Page 369 Property operation

Data check The contents of package data can be checked. Page 371 Data check operation

Delete all labels All pieces of label name resolution information can be deleted. Page 372 Delete all labels operation

Sort out labels Unused label name resolution information can be deleted. Page 372 Sort out labels operation

Package management

Data management

Touch [Package management].

Operate the package data.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 363

36

Display example of package data management

Number Item Description (1) Select drive The drive which displays file or folder can be selected.

When an SD card or USB memory is not installed, the following drives are not displayed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive]

(2) Folder which stores the running project

[*] indicates the folder which stores the running project.

(3) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(4) Name The file name or folder name which is stored in the selected drive or folder is displayed. When the file name or folder name exceeds 20 characters, the exceeding characters (the 21th character or after) are not displayed.

(5) Path name Displays the path name of drive /folder which is currently displayed.

(6) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(7) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(8) The size of drive Displays the size of free area and the entire size of the drive which is selected by drive selection. Note that this item is not displayed when drive C is selected.

(9) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(10) Number and size of files Displays the number of the selected files, the total file size, and the selectable number of files in the folder.

(1) (2) (3) (4) (6) (7)

(5)

(8) (10)

(9)

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management

6

Operation of package data management

Display operation of package data 1. If touch a drive in [Select drive], the information of the first folder of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If touch a folder name, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If touch a folder of ". .", the information of the folder of the one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If touch the button of the scrollbar, the screen scrolls up/down by one line. If touch the button, the screen scrolls up/down by one screen.

5. If touch a file name, the touched file name is selected and inverted.

6. For the operation of installation, upload, data check, and global labels, refer to the following. Installation Page 366 Operation of package data management Upload Page 368 Operation of package data management Property Page 369 Property operation Data check Page 371 Data check operation Delete all labels Page 372 Delete all labels operation Sort out labels Page 372 Sort out labels operation

7. If touch the [] button, the screen is closed.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 365

36

Installation operation BootOS and OS which are written in drive A (Built-in SD card), drive B (USB drive), drive E (USB drive), drive F (USB drive), and drive G (USB drive) can be installed in GOT. (The following procedure uses drive A as an example.)

1. Install the data storage to which package data to be installed is written to the GOT. For installation/removal procedure of data storages, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

2. Touch [A:Built-in SD card] in the drive selection.

3. Touch the [Install] button.

4. Touch the installation destination drive.

5. Touch the [Exec.] button.

6. In the dialog shown below, touch the [OK] button to start the installation. To cancel the installation, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management

6

7. If the installation destination drive has package data with the same name, the dialog shown below appears. To delete the package data from the installation destination drive and then start the installation, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the installation, touch the [Cancel] button.

8. When the installation completes, the dialog shown below appears. Touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 367

36

Upload operation Package data written in drive C (Built-in flash memory) can be uploaded to drive A (Built-in SD card), drive B (USB drive), drive E (USB drive), drive F (USB drive), and drive G (USB drive). The data storage after uploading can be used for installing the package data on another GOT. Page 391 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION (The following procedure uses drive A as an example.)

1. Install the data storage used as the uploading destination to the GOT. For installation/removal procedure of data storages, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

2. Touch the upload source drive ([C:Flash Memory]) in [Select drive].

3. Touch the [Upload] button.

4. Touch the upload destination drive.

5. Touch the [Exec.] button to start uploading the package.

6. When the upload is completed, the dialog box shown below is displayed. Touch the [OK] button to close the dialog.

4.

5.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management

6

Property operation The versions of system applications and communication drivers, and other information can be checked.

1. Open a target package folder in the [G2PACKAGE] folder.

2. Open one of the following folders. [G2SYS] folder System applications (standard functions) and system applications (extended functions) are stored. [G2COM] folder Communication drivers are stored. [G2PROJECT] folder Project data are stored. [G2SPC] folder Special data are stored.

3. Touch the [Property] button to display the properties of the files in the folder.

1.

2.

3.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 369

37

4. Check the properties. For the [G2SYS] folder, the properties of system applications are displayed. For the [G2COM] folder, the properties of communication drivers are displayed. [File Name]: Displays the file names. [Size]: Displays the file size. [Kind]: Displays the file types. [Basic]: System application (standard function) [Extend]: System application (extended function) [Comm.]: Communication driver [Version]: Displays the file versions. [Date Time]: Displays the date and time of the file creation.

For the [G2PROJECT] folder, the project property and the screen numbers used in the project are displayed. The project property includes the following information. [Date]: Creation date of the project data [Author]: Creator of the project data [GT Designer3 Version]: Version of GT Designer3 (GOT2000) from which the project data is written [System version]: GOT system version

Property displayed for the [G2SYS] folder

Property displayed for the [G2PROJECT] folder

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management

6

For the [G2SPC] folder, the project property and the special data are displayed. The project property includes the following information. [Date]: Creation date of the project data [Author]: Creator of the project data [GT Designer3 Version]: Version of GT Designer3 (GOT2000) from which the project data is written

Data check operation The contents of the selected package data are checked.

1. Touch the [Data check] button after selecting the package data for data check. The data check is executed and the result is displayed by the dialog box shown below.

2. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

Property displayed for the [G2SPC] folder

Dialog at data check normal

Dialog at data check abnormal

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 371

37

Delete all labels operation All pieces of label name resolution information are deleted. For the details of the label name resolution information, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

1. Touch the [Delete all labels] button to display the dialog shown below.

2. To delete all pieces of label name resolution information, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the deletion and close the dialog, touch the [Cancel] button.

Sort out labels operation Unused label name resolution information is deleted. For the details of the label name resolution information, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

1. Touch the [Sort out labels] button to display the dialog shown below.

2. To delete unused label name resolution information, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the deletion and close the dialog, touch the [Cancel] button.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management

6

Precautions

Precautions for upload operations When the project in drive C is protected with a security key, uploading data from drive C to the other drives is not available. For the details of the security key, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

6 DATA CONTROL 6.9 Package Data Management 373

37

6.10 Backup/Restore Function Backup/restore function Executing backups, executing restorations, and deleting backup data are possible. For details on the backup/restoration function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor) For using the backup/restoration function on GT21, refer to the following. Page 614 Backup and Restoration

Display operation of backup/restoration

Operation of backup/restoration Backup/restore data from the controller to GOT, or erase backup data with the backup/restoration. GOT data package acquisition is also possible. For details on the backup/restoration function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Backup/restoration

Data management

Touch [Backup restoration].

Touch an item to be changed.

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.10 Backup/Restore Function

6

6.11 SRAM management Function of SRAM management The SRAM user area usage can be confirmed, data in the SRAM user area can be backed up or restored, and the SRAM user area is initialiized. For the available functions in the SRAM user area, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of SRAM management

SRAM management

Data management

Touch [SRAM management].

6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management 375

37

Display example of SRAM management

Number Item Description (1) Check box Touch the check box to select or clear the item.

(2) Function name Displays the functions that use the SRAM in the order of system alarm, user alarm, logging, recipe, and internal device.

(3) Setting ID Displays the setting IDs. For the system alarm function, the setting IDs are not displayed.

(4) Size Displays the data size.

(5) Setting name Displays the setting name. For the setting name, only characters within the display range are displayed.

(6) Date and time Displays the creation date and time of each data.

(7) n item(s) has/have been selected.

Displays the information of the items currently selected.

(8) SRAM Free space Displays the current free space size or total space size of the SRAM user area.

(9) Free space Displays the current free space size or total space size of the drive selected for [Select drive].

(10) Initialize all Initializes all areas of the SRAM user area.

(11) Initialize selected area Select each area of the SRAM user area to initialize multiple areas of the SRAM user area.

(12) Select drive Switches drives to be used for the data backup or restoration in the SRAM user area. The following drives can be switched only when an SD card or USB memory is installed. SD card: [A: Built-in SD card] USB memory: [B: USB Drive], [E: USB Drive], [F: USB Drive], and [G: USB Drive]

(13) Restoration Saves data in the selected drive to the SRAM user area.

(14) Backup all area Saves data in the SRAM user area to the selected drive.

(1)

(2) (3) (4) (5) (6)

(7) (8)

(9) (10) (11)

(12) (13) (14)

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management

6

SRAM management operation

Operation to initialize all or selected areas of the SRAM user area 1. Perform any of the following operations. To initialize all areas of the SRAM user area, touch the [Initialize all] button. To initialize selected areas of the SRAM user area, select the check box of the area to be initialized, and then touch the [Initialize selected area] button.

2. The dialog box shown below appears. Check the description of the dialog box. To initialize the SRAM user area, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the initialization, touch the [Cancel] button. (Example: Dialog box if the [Initialize all] button is touched)

3. When touching the [OK] button in step2, the dialog box shown below appears for recheck. To start the initialization, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the initialization, touch the [Cancel] button.

4. The completion dialog box appears when the initialization is completed. To close the dialog box and restart the GOT, touch the [OK] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management 377

37

Operation to restore data 1. To restore data in the SRAM user area to a drive Select the drive where the data is stored, and then touch the [Restoration] button.

2. The dialog box shown below appears. Check the description of the dialog box. To restore all data in the SRAM user area, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the restoration, touch the [Cancel] button.

3. When touching the [OK] button in step2, the dialog box shown below appears for recheck. To start the restoration, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the restoration, touch the [Cancel] button.

4. The completion dialog box appears when the restoration is completed. To close the dialog box and restart the GOT, touch the [OK] button.

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management

6

Operation to back up all data in the SRAM user area 1. To back up data in the SRAM user area to a drive Select the drive where the data is stored, and then touch the [Backup all area] button.

2. The dialog box shown below appears. Check the description of the dialog box. To back up all data in the SRAM user area, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the backup, touch the [Cancel] button.

3. When touching the [OK] button in step 2, the dialog box shown below appears for recheck. To start the backup, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the backup, touch the [Cancel] button.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management 379

38

4. When the file, whose name is the same, exists in the destination folder, the dialog box shown below appears without starting the backup.

To overwrite the file, touch the [OK] button. To cancel the backup, touch the [Cancel] button.

5. The completion dialog box appears when the backup is completed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.11 SRAM management

6

6.12 Memory Card Format The data storage is formatted.

Display operation of memory card format

Memory card format

Data management

Touch [Memory card format].

6 DATA CONTROL 6.12 Memory Card Format 381

38

Operating the memory card format 1. Install a data storage to the GOT. For installation/removal procedure of data storages, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

2. Touch and select the drive to format by drive selection.

3. If touch the [Format] button, the password input screen is displayed.

4. Type [1] [1] [1] [1] and touch the [Enter] key. The dialog box shown below will appear. (The password is fixed to 1111.) Confirm the contents of the dialog box, and touch the [OK] button to format of the data storage. To cancel the format of the data storage, touch the [Cancel] button.

5. If touch the [OK] button by step4, the dialog mentioned below is displayed for reconfirm.

6. Reconfirm whether to format the data storage. Touch the [OK] button to start the format. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the format of the data storage.

2 6 DATA CONTROL 6.12 Memory Card Format

6

7. When the formatting is completed, the completion dialog mentioned below is displayed.

8. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

Restrictions on formatting When using an unformatted data storage in the GOT, format it by a personal computer. The GOT cannot

format the unformatted data storage. The format of the GOT does not change the file system (Example: FAT16) of the data storage and inherits

the file system before the format.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.12 Memory Card Format 383

38

6.13 Memory Check Memory check function Memory check function carries out the write/read check of drive A (Built-in SD card), drive B (USB drive), C (Built-in flash memory), drive E (USB drive), drive F (USB drive), and drive G (USB drive).

Display operation of memory check

Function Description A drive memory check Checks whether the memory (Built-in SD card) of the A drive can be read/written normally.

B drive memory check Checks whether the memory (USB drive) of the B drive can be read/written normally.

C drive memory check Checks whether the memory (Built-in flash memory) of the C drive can be read/written normally.

E drive memory check Checks whether the memory (USB drive) of the E drive can be read/written normally.

F drive memory check Checks whether the memory (USB drive) of the F drive can be read/written normally.

G drive memory check Checks whether the memory (USB drive) of the G drive can be read/written normally.

Memory check

Data management

Select the memory to check and touch [Check].

Touch [Memory check].

4 6 DATA CONTROL 6.13 Memory Check

6

Memory check operation Carries out write/read check of memory.

When drive is not displayed When the drive (memory) to check is not displayed, confirm the mounting procedure or memory type with reference to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) When no faults are found in mounting, etc, a memory failure may be arosen. Replace the data storage or built-in flash memory (C drive). For details of built-in flash memory, contact your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service. The following example explains about Memory Check using built-in flash memory (C drive). For the Built-in SD card (A drive) memory check, install the SD card before carrying out the same key operations as those for the built-in flash memory check. For the USB drive (B drive, E drive, F drive, or G drive) memory check, install the USB memory before carrying out the check operations.

1. Select [Flash Memory] in the Memory check setting screen. If select the [OK] button, the numeric keyboard window is displayed. If select [Cancel] button, returns to the initial menu.

2. Touch to input password ([5] [9] [2] [0]) and touch the [Enter] key. If touch the [Enter] key,executes read/write check for the built-in flash memory, which is completed in around 10 seconds.

6 DATA CONTROL 6.13 Memory Check 385

38

Password chang The password cannot be changed.

When input password error, the cancel dialog box is displayed. If touch the [OK], returns to the Memory check screen.

When error is found in memory When error is found by memory check, the dialog box indicating the area in which the error occurred is displayed. In case of error, contact your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service.

If touch the [OK], returns to the Memory check screen.

6 6 DATA CONTROL 6.13 Memory Check

6

6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition GOT data package acquisition function The GOT data package acquisition function copies the following the system applications installed in the GOT and data in the GOT to a data storage. System application(BootOS, basic system application, communication driver, and system application (Extended function)) Special data Project data The copied data can be utilized for backup or creating the same GOT system by installing the data. For installation function of the GOT, refer to the following. Page 393 Installation Using Data Storage The GOT data package acquisition can be executed at the timing of the trigger backup. For information on the trigger backup, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Monitor)

Display operation of GOT data package acquisition

GOT data package acquisition

Data management

Touch [GOT data package acquisition].

6 DATA CONTROL 6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition 387

38

Display example of GOT data package acquisition

Number Item Description (1) Select drive Displays the drive where OS and data can be copied.

When an SD card is not installed, [A: Built-in SD card] is not displayed. When a USB memory is installed, the recognized USB drive is displayed. When a USB memory is not installed, no USB drive is recognized and displayed.

(2) Copy Touching the button starts copying.

(1)

(2)

8 6 DATA CONTROL 6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition

6

GOT data package acquisition operation

Display operation of GOT data package acquisition The GOT data package acquisition function copies the system applications installed in the GOT and data in the GOT to a data storage. (This item explains using the A drive.)

1. Touching the drive name below [Select Drive] inverts the touched drive name. Touching the [Copy] button starts copying.

2. The display depends on the status of copy destination and setup. Operate following the displayed dialog box. (Example: Dialog box after touching the [Copy] button)

3. After copying the system application and data, the dialog box for notifying the completion appears. Touching the [OK] button closes the dialog box.

Estimation of processing time The time required for the processing depends on conditions such as system application, data capacity, and file structure. (Reference value) When the capacity is 4 Mbytes: Around 6 seconds When the capacity is 12 Mbytes: Around 18 seconds

6 DATA CONTROL 6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition 389

39

Precautions for operation Copying project data If the Boot source drive and copy destination drive for project data is the same, the project data cannot be copied. If the drives are the same, cancel the setup.

When project data are copied to the GOT If the system application or project data is copied to the GOT using the data storage created with the GOT data package acquisition, the utility setting is also copied. Check each utility setting after copying to the GOT and change the setting according to need.

Data storage to be used When performing the GOT data package acquisition, do not store other data to the data storage. If doing so, the previous data will be unavailable.

When a project in drive C is protected with a security key You cannot copy the project in drive C even by selecting the destination drive and then touching the [Copy] button. For the details of the security key, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

0 6 DATA CONTROL 6.14 GOT Data Package Acquisition

7

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION Page 392 Preparation before Installation Page 393 Installation Using Data Storage Page 398 When Installing the Different Version To execute the GOT utility, install the BootOS and system applications on the C drive (built-in flash memory) of the GOT, or set the boot drive of the system application to [A: Built-in SD card] and insert an SD card with system applications into the GOT. (BootOS is installed in the GOT at factory shipment. It is not necessary to install BootOS when upgrading of it is unnecessary.) This chapter explains the installation using GOT.

*1 When execute installation with a USB memory, the system applications have to be installed in GOT in advance. Refer to the following for the installation which uses GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual The following BootOS and system application are necessary to execute the utility. BootOS Operating system required for control of the GOT and communication between the personal computer and the GOT It is installed at factory shipment. (BootOS can be installed from GT Designer3, or the SD card. When the installation has completed, the GOT is initialized to be the factory shipment status. Also, the basic system applications must be pre-installed in the GOT when the BootOS is installed again.) Basic system application System application required for the GOT operations including the monitoring function, installation and deletion of the system application or project data, touch key control, and display of the screen, guidance, user-created screen, and utility screen. It is not installed in the GOT at factory shipment. Install it from GT Designer3 or the data storage.

When GOT is remote, installed easily using a data storage

The GOT can starts without a system application installed.

Install the SD card in GOT

Install the SD card in GOT

Set the OS boot drive to [A:Built-in SD card].

Install a data storage in the GOT.Data storage

Install from GOT to GOT using a data storage.

SD card

BootOS or system application installation

BootOS or system application installation

Data storage

GOT

*1

*1

GT Designer3 Data storage GOT

GOT Data storage GOT

Write system

application

Write system

application

System application

upload

GT Designer3

GOT

GOT

GOT

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 391

39

7.1 Preparation before Installation For the installation using GOT, the data storage that is storing BootOS or the system application is required. There are the following three methods for the installation of BootOS and system application.

To Memory Card] from GT Designer3 GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Uploading from other GOT (BootOS or system application has been installed) 6 DATA CONTROL

Using an SD card that stores data with OS boot drive set to A drive GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Precautions on writing BootOS, system applications in a data storage When writing BootOS, system applications or others into the data storage, be sure to execute by the utility of other GOT or GT Designer3. The installation is not executed properly with the storage to which uploaded from the utility of GOT or copied by software other than GT Designer3. Note the available capacity of the data storage. The available capacity of BootOS and system applications can be confirmed by [Write to Memory Card] or [Write Option] of GT Designer3.

[Communicate with Memory Card] dialog

[Write Option] dialog

Available space of the system application

Available space of the data storage

2 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.1 Preparation before Installation

7

7.2 Installation Using Data Storage There are the following two types for the installation of BootOS and system applications using a data storage.

Installing when starting the GOT Page 394 Installing when starting the GOT All the system applications and project data stored in the data storage are transferred to the GOT when powering on the GOT. This installing method is effective in the following cases. The GOT utility cannot be displayed. The system application is not installed.

Installing using the data control function (Utility) Page 396 Installing using the data control function (Utility) By operating the utility, select the system application or project data stored in the data storage and transfer them to the GOT.

Precautions on installing BootOS, system applications Installing both BootOS and system applications After completing BootOS installation, install system applications. When installing BootOS, the built-in flash memory in the GOT is initialized and goes to the status at factory shipment. (All system applications and project data are erased.) BootOS is installed in the GOT at factory shipment. It is not necessary to install BootOS when not upgrading it. Copying project data using a data storage After installing BootOS and system applications, download the project data. At this time, match the version of the system application in the GOT with the version of the system application with which the project data was created. When system applications and project data are in the data storage (when using GT Designer3) For S.MODE switch-pressing installation, after the system application installation has completed, the project data is downloaded. If installation is performed on GT2505-V by touching the lower right of the screen, the project data is downloaded after the system application installation is complete. When installing with the utility, install the system application and download the project data from their respective operation screens. Installation cannot be interrupted. Do not perform any of the following during a BootOS or system application installation. Failure to do so may result in installation failure, causing the GOT malfunction. Powering off the GOT Pressing the reset button of the GOT Opening the cover of the SD card interface Removing the data storage If the installation failure and the GOT malfunction occur, take the following action. If BootOS installation failed: Touch the screen according to the displayed dialog to restart the GOT. After restarting the GOT, the GOT is initialized to be the factory shipment status. If the basic system application installation failed: Install BootOS. Page 394 Installing when starting the GOT

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage 393

39

Installing when starting the GOT The displayed message is different depending on the installation condition of the basic system application in the GOT. When the screen requesting operation is displayed, operate the GOT according to the instructions on the screen.

S.MODE switch-pressing installation function When the data storage that stores data with the OS boot drive set to the A drive is used, the S.MODE switch- pressing installation function is not available.

Operation procedure The S.MODE switch is on the back or top of the GOT.

When installing with an SD card 1. Power OFF the GOT, and install the SD card where the BootOS, system application or project data is stored in the SD

card interface of the GOT.

2. Close the cover of the SD card interface of the GOT.

3. Power on the GOT. Hold down the S.MODE switch and power on the GOT. For GT2505-V, power on the GOT while touching the lower right of the screen. (1-point press installation function)

4. The BootOS or system application is installed in the built-in flash memory. The SD card access LED is lit during the install execution. Do not pull out the SD card or power OFF the GOT while the SD card access LED is lit.

5. The GOT restarts automatically after the installation is completed. (If the system application is already installed, touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT.)

6. After confirming normal restart, confirm that the SD card access LED is not lit, and remove the SD card from the SD card interface of the GOT.

S.MODE switch

For GT2712 For GT2506HS-V

S.MODE switch

Now installing BootOS.

Reboot.

4 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage

7

When installing with USB memory 1. Power off the GOT, and install the USB memory where the BootOS, system application or project data is stored in the

USB interface of the GOT. The BootOS cannot be stored in the USB memory where the system application or project data is stored.

2. Power on the GOT. While pressing the S.MODE switch, power on the GOT. When using GT2505-V, while pressing the lower right of the GOT screen, power on the GOT. (1-point press installation function)

3. The BootOS or system application is installed in the built-in flash memory. The USB memory access LED is lit during the installation execution. Do not pull out the USB memory or power off the GOT while the USB memory access LED is lit.

4. The GOT restarts automatically after the installation is completed. (If the system application is already installed, touch the [OK] button to restart the GOT.)

5. After confirming normal restart, confirm that the USB memory access LED is not lit, and remove the USB memory from the USB interface of the GOT.

For removing methods of the USB memory, refer to the following. Page 220 USB device status display operation

Now installing BootOS.

Reboot.

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage 395

39

Installing using the data control function (Utility) For details of data control function, refer to the following. Page 251 DATA CONTROL

Precautions on executing data control function When execute data control function, system application has to be installed in GOT in advance. Thus, this function cannot be used for the initial installation of BootOS, system application after purchasing GOT. Install system application by the following two methods. GT Designer3 Installing when starting the GOT

Operation procedure When installing with an SD card 1. Install the SD card where the BootOS, system application or project data is stored in the SD card interface of the GOT.

2. Close the cover of the SD card interface of the GOT.

3. Display the data control function screen (Utility) on the GOT, and install BootOS, system application from the SD card to GOT.

4. The SD card access LED is lit during the install execution. Do not pull out the SD card or open the SD card interface while the SD card access card is lit.

5. GOT restarts automatically after installation is completed.

6. After confirming normal restart, confirm that the SD card access LED is not lit, and remove the SD card from the SD card interface of the GOT.

Touch [Install]

Now installing BootOS.

Reboot.

6 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage

7

When installing with USB memory 1. Install the USB memory where the BootOS, system application or project data is stored in the USB interface of the GOT.

2. Display the data control function screen (Utility) on the GOT, and install basic system application from the USB drive to GOT.

3. The USB memory access LED is lit during install execution. Do not pull out the USB memory or power OFF the GOT while the USB memory access LED is lit.

4. The GOT restarts automatically after the installation is completed.

5. After confirming normal restart, confirm that the USB memory access LED is not lit. Display the USB device status screen and remove the USB memory from the USB interface of GOT. Page 220 USB device status display operation

Touch [Install]

Now installing BootOS.

Reboot.

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.2 Installation Using Data Storage 397

39

7.3 When Installing the Different Version

BootOS installation When installing BootOS, GOT compares the version of the BootOS to be installed with the version of BootOS which is already installed. If the major version of BootOS to be installed is old, execute the following operations to prevent it from being rewritten. (When installing from GT Designer3, a message is displayed on the personal computer screen. Follow the instructions in that message.)

When only BootOS is stored in the data storage The message indicating disabled installation is displayed.

Touch the [OK] button to cancel the installation. After canceling installation, restart the GOT.

When BootOS and system application are stored in the data storage Skip the BootOS installation and install the system application. If the system application has already installed in the GOT, the following message is displayed.

Touch the [OK] button to execute the installation. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the installation. After executing or canceling installation, restart the GOT.

8 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.3 When Installing the Different Version

7

When the version is the same or newer regardless of the stored data (BootOS only or BootOS and system application) in the data storage

The version information and a dialog for selecting whether or not to continue installation are displayed.

Touch the [OK] button to execute the installation. Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the installation.

System application installation Version of each system application Match the version of each system application when installing system applications. System applications cannot be installed if the version of each system application does not match.

When using package data created with GT Designer3 Version1.122C or later If package data created with an earlier version of GT Designer3 than 1.122C or later is installed, the GOT ID No. and the communication settings may not be reflected. To reflect the GOT ID No. and the communication settings, them in the utility. Page 58 Unique Information Page 99 Controller

Checking method of BootOS, system application version Confirm the version of BootOS installed in the GOT at product shipment by rating plate of GOT rear face

When the installation process is discontinued. When the installation process is normally executed. Basic system application : 1. . Communication driver : 2. . System application (Extended function) : 2. .

Basic system application : 2. . Communication driver : 2. . System application (Extended function) : 2. .

Please match the number.

BootOS version (In case that the BootOS is two digits, only the first digit is written.)

A A

MODEL

DATE

MADE IN JAPAN

SERIAL MAC ADD. 123456789012 POWER

GRAPHIC OPERATION TERMINAL PASSED

IN GT2708-VTBA

2013-09 00013910AA00000-A

MAX 100VA 100-240VAC 50/60Hz

7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.3 When Installing the Different Version 399

40

MEMO

0 7 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 7.3 When Installing the Different Version

8

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST Page 401 Display on the GOT Page 403 Error Codes and System Alarm List This chapter describes the system alarms displayed on the GOT.

8.1 Display on the GOT The following shows the displayed contents and checking method of the system alarm on the GOT.

Display contents of the system alarm The display contents differ according to the error source. Controller error

GOT error

GOT Mobile error

Network error

CPU error

*1 Displays the error code of the error occurred in the RCPU or FX5CPU.

M0101-104 Parameter error. Error message Error code Classification code Manufacturer code Identification code

G01-402Communication timeout. Confirm communication pathway or modules. Error message Error code Classification code Identification code (fixed to G)

W101-660Failed to obtain op. authority. Server does not respond. Error message Error code Classification code GOT Mobile function client No. Identification code (fixed to W)

N21-803 Transient error. Error message Error code Classification code Identification code (fixed to N)

M0128-1000 Runaway or error of the main CPU was detected.(R:3C00) Error message Error code Classification code Manufacturer code Identification code

Error code of the CPU*1

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.1 Display on the GOT 401

40

How to check system alarms Checking method when the system alarm settings are configured on GT Designer3 The system alarm settings can be configured on GT Designer3. For the details of the settings on GT Designer3 and the display contents, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Checking method using the utility When the system alarm settings are not configured on GT Designer3, you can check system alarms using the system alarm display in the utility. Page 226 System Alarm

How to check the error code and channel number You can check the following for the error code and channel number. Error code Error code storage area for the system information function Channel No. GOT special registers (GS262 to GS264) For details of the system information and GOT special register, refer to the following manual. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.1 Display on the GOT

8

8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

Error codes displayed on the GOT The following shows the error codes displayed on the GOT and the relevant manuals.

GOT error codes and network error codes

*1 For the details of the GOT special registers (GS262 to GS264), refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

*2 FXCPU has error codes 100 to 109, indicating the status of M8060 to M8069. (Example) If error code (100) occurs, handle the error according to the M8060 description.

*3 The GOT displays the error code displayed on the servo amplifier (hexadecimal) in decimal + 20000. Therefore, when referring to the manual of the servo amplifier with the error code displayed on the GOT using the system alarm, subtract 20000 from the GOT error code and convert the last 3 digits into the hexadecimal number. (Example: When the GOT system alarm shows 20144, the error code of the servo amplifier is 90H.)

*4 Channel No. will not be stored depending on the error code. For the details of the channel No. storage by error code, refer to the following. Page 409 System alarm list

*5 With the system alarm related to the file access, you cannot identify the drive where the alarm occurs. However, you can identify the drive by checking the File Access Error signal (b7 to b10) of System signal 2-2.

*6 The GOT displays the error code corresponding to an error occurring in the multiple CPU system. Check the error details with MT Developer or MT Works2. For error handling, refer to the manual of the Motion CPU.

Error source

Error code Description Channel No. storage destination*1

Reference

Controller 0 to 99 (Value of D9008)

Error code of CPU (ACPU) GS263 User's Manual of the ACPU connected to the GOT

100 to 299 Error code of the following controllers FXCPU*2 Non-Mitsubishi Electric PLC Temperature controller (OMRON temperature controller only)

Manual of the controller connected to the GOT Deal with errors according to the error messages.

GOT*5 300 to 399 Error code of the GOT main unit function GS262*4 Page 409 System alarm list

400 to 499 Error code of the GOT communication function

500 to 699 Error code of the GOT main unit function

Network 800 to 999 Error code of network GS264

CPU 1000 to 10000 (Value of SD0)

Error code of the CPU (QCPU, LCPU, or QnACPU)

GS263 User's Manual of the QCPU, LCPU, or QnACPU connected to the GOT

Error code of an RCPU or Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series)

A system alarm message appears to indicate the code of the error occurring in an RCPU. Page 401 Display contents of the system alarm For error handling, check the manual of the RCPU.

Error code of an FX5CPU A system alarm message appears to indicate the code of the error occurring in an FX5CPU. Page 401 Display contents of the system alarm For error handling, check the manual of the FX5CPU.

Motion CPU 10001 to 10999 Error code of a Motion CPU (Q173D (S)CPU/Q172D (S)CPU/Q170M (S)CPU)

*6

CNC C70 11000 to 11999 Error code of the CNC (Q173NCCPU)

*7

Robot controller

12000 to 12999 Error code of the robot controller *8

CPU 15000 to 15999 Error code of an RCPU *9

16000 Error code of an FX5CPU *10

Servo amplifier*3

20016 to 21121 Error code of the servo amplifier User's Manual of the servo amplifier connected to the GOT

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 403

40

*7 The GOT displays the error code corresponding to an error occurring in the multiple CPU system. Check the error details with the CNC monitor. For error handling, refer to the manual of the CNC.

*8 The GOT displays the error code corresponding to an error occurring in a robot controller in the multiple CPU system or a standalone robot controller. Check the error details with RT ToolBox2 or RT ToolBox3. For error handling, refer to the manual of the robot controller.

*9 The GOT displays the error code corresponding to an error occurring in an RCPU or Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series). Check the error details with GX Works3 or MT Works2. For error handling, refer to the manual of the RCPU or Motion CPU (MELSEC iQ-R series).

*10 The GOT displays the error code corresponding to an error occurring in an FX5CPU. Check the error details with GX Works3. For error handling, refer to the manual of the FX5CPU.

Controller error codes

*1 For the details of the GOT special registers (GS262 to GS264), refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

*2 For the FXCPU, error code 100 to 109 correspond to M8060 to M8069 respectively. Example) For error code 100, take the corrective action for M8060.

*3 For the hexadecimal error code of the servo amplifier, the GOT displays the error code in decimal incremented by 2000. When referring to the manual of servo amplifier by the error code displayed as a GOT system alarm, subtract 20000 from the GOT error code and change its lower three digits to the hexadecimal number. Example) The GOT system alarm 20144 refers to the servo amplifier error code 90H.

Error source

Error code Description Channel No. storage destination*1

Reference

Controller 1 to 32767 Error codes for the controller*2*3 GS263 Manual of the controller

4 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

Identification/manufacturer/classification code of the system alarm A system alarm contains an identification code, manufacturer code, and classification code. The identification code indicates the category of the error. The manufacturer code and classification code indicate the area where the error occurred. The following shows the details of the identification code, manufacturer code, and classification code.

Identification code

Manufacturer code

Identification code Description G GOT error

W GOT Mobile error

N Network error (in the network unit that is mounted on the GOT)

M Mitsubishi Electric controller error

C Non-Mitsubishi Electric controller, microcomputer, or MODBUS error

Manufacturer code Description 01h Mitsubishi Electric Corporation

20h Computer, MODBUS

21h OMRON

22h KEYENCE

23h FUJI ELECTRIC (PLC)

24h FUJI ELECTRIC (Temperature controller)

25h YASKAWA

26h YOKOGAWA

27h PANASONIC, PANASONIC IDS

28h TOSHIBA

29h SHIBAURA MACHINE

2Ah HITACHI IES

2Bh HITACHI

2Ch KOYO EI

2Dh SHARP

2Eh JTEKT

30h SHINKO

31h CHINO

32h AZBIL

33h RKC

34h IAI

36h ALLEN-BRADLEY

37h GE IP

38h LS IS

39h SICK

3Ah SIEMENS

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 405

40

Classification code The details of the classification code differ according to the identification code and manufacturer code.

Identification code Manufacturer code Classification code Description G, W - 00h Related to the monitor function or object function

01h Related to the communication or controllers

02h Related to operations

03h Related to the file access

N - 21h [MELSECNET/H]

22h [CC-Link IE Controller Network]

23h [CC-Link IE Field Network]

24h [CC-Link Ver.2(ID)]

25h [PROFIBUS DP]

26h [DeviceNet]

27h [CC-Link IE Field Network Basic]

28h [CC-Link IE TSN]

M 01h 00h [Serial(MELSEC)]

01h [CC-Link(G4)]

02h [Multidrop(Slave)]

03h [AJ71QC24,MELDAS C6*]

04h [AJ71C24/UC24]

05h [MELSEC-FX]

06h [MELSEC-WS]

10h [Ethernet(MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC),Gateway]

11h [Ethernet(FX),Gateway]

20h [BUS(Q)]

21h [MELSECNET/H]

22h [CC-Link IE Controller Network]

23h [CC-Link IE Field Network]]

24h [CC-Link Ver.2(ID)]

25h [Bus(A/QnA)]

27h [CC-Link IE Field Network Basic]

28h [CC-Link IE TSN]

30h [MELSERVO-J4,J3,J2S/M,JE]

40h [Ethernet(MELSERVO),Gateway]

50h [FREQROL 500/700/800,SENSORLESS SERVO]

51h [FREQROL 800]

52 h [FREQROL(batch monitor)]

60h [Ethernet(FREQROL),Gateway]

61h [Ethernet(FREQROL(Batch monitor)), Gateway]

C 20h E0h [MODBUS/RTU Master]

E1h [Computer]

E2h [MODBUS/RTU Slave]

25h [PROFIBUS DP]

26h [DeviceNet]

F0h [MODBUS/TCP Master,Gateway]

F1h [Computer]

F2h [Ethernet(SLMP),Gateway]

F3h [MODBUS/TCP Slave,Gateway]

F4h [OPC]

6 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

C 21h 00h [OMRON SYSMAC]

10h [Ethernet(OMRON),Gateway]

11h [Ethernet(OMRON NJ/NX), Gateway]

70h [OMRON THERMAC/INPANEL NEO]

71h [OMRON Digital Temperature Controller]

22h 00h [Serial(KEYENCE)]

10h [Ethernet(KEYENCE),Gateway]

23h 00h [FUJI MICREX-F]

24h 70h [FUJI Temperature Controller/Digital Controller]

25h 00h [YASKAWA GL]

01h [YASKAWA MP2000/MP900/CP9200SH]

02h [YASKAWA CP9200(H)]

03h [YASKAWA CP9300MS(MC compatible)]

10h [Ethernet(YASKAWA),Gateway]

11h [Ethernet(YASKAWA MP3000),Gateway]

12h [Ethernet(YASKAWA High Speed Ethernet Server), Gateway]

26h 00h [YOKOGAWA FA500/FA-M3/STARDOM]

10h [Ethernet(YOKOGAWA),Gateway]

70h [YOKOGAWA GREEN/UT100/UT2000/UT Advance]

27h 00h [Panasonic MEWNET-FP]

01h [Panasonic MEWTOCOL-7]

30h [Panasonic MINAS-A4]

31h [Panasonic MINAS-A5]

28h 00h [TOSHIBA PROSEC T/V]

29h 00h [SHIBAURA MACHINE TCmini]

2Ah 00h [HITACHI IES HIDIC H]

01h [HITACHI IES HIDIC H(Protocol2)]

10h [Ethernet(HITACHI IES), Gateway]

2Bh 00h [HITACHI S10mini/S10V]

10h [Ethernet(HITACHI), Gateway]

2Ch 00h [KOYO KOSTAC/DL]

2Dh 00h [SHARP JW]

2Eh 00h [JTECT TOYOPUC-PC]

2Fh 00h [Muratec MPC]

01h [Muratec MPR]

30h 70h [SHINKO TECHNOS CONTROLLER]

31h 70h [CHINO MODBUS device]

32h 70h [Azbil SDC/DMC]

71h [Azbil DMC50]

33h 70h [RKC SR Mini HG(MODBUS)]

34h 90h [IAI ROBO CYLINDER]

91h [IAI X-SEL]

35h 90h [Hirata HNC]

36h 00h [AB SLC500,AB 1:N]

01h [AB MicroLogix]

02h [AB Control/CompactLogix]

03h [AB MicroLogix(Extended)]

04h [AB DH485]

10h [Ethernet(AB), Gateway]

11h [Ethernet(AB Tag), Gateway]

12h [Ethernet(AB MicroLogix), Gateway]

37h 00h [GE (SNP-X)]

Identification code Manufacturer code Classification code Description

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 407

40

C 38h 00h [LS Industrial Systems MASTER-K]

10h [Ethernet(LS Industrial Systems XGK), Gateway]

39h 00h [SICK Flexi Soft]

3Ah 00h [SIEMENS S7-200]

01h [SIEMENS S7-300/400]

10h [Ethernet(SIEMENS S7),Gateway]

11h [Ethernet(SIEMENS OP),Gateway]

Identification code Manufacturer code Classification code Description

8 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

System alarm list The system alarm detected with GOT is shown below.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

300 Project data contains unsupported objects. Install the latest version of GT Designer3 and write the package data again to the GOT.

301 Project data contains unsupported functions.

Install the latest version of GT Designer3 and write the package data again to the GOT.

302 Project data contains unsupported settings.

Install the latest version of GT Designer3 and write the package data again to the GOT.

303 Set monitor points too large. Decrease setting points.

Decrease the number of objects from the displayed screen. For the number of maximum objects for 1 screen, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Place the objects with quantity limit on either of the following screens when outputting a hidden screen's image using the hard copy function. If placed on both screens, the objects will not appear in the outputted file. Displayed monitor screen Hard copy output target screen

305 Background loading of the system package failed.

Check that the data storage, which stores the package data and GOT project data, is installed and the data is not damaged.

306 No project data. Download screen data. The project data is not downloaded or the screen data is not sufficient. Download the project data or screen data.

307 Monitor device not set The monitor device of the object is not set. Set the monitor device of the object.

308 No comment data. Download comment. The comment file does not exist. Create the comment file and download to GOT.

309 Device reading error. Correct device. The error occurred when reading a continuous device. Correct the device.

310 Project data does not exist or out of range. Specified base screen / window screen does not exist in the project data. Specified base screen / window screen is out of the permissible area. Specify the existing base screen / window screen.

311 No. of alarm has exceeded upper limit. Delete restored alarm.

The number of alarm histories that can be observed by the alarm history display function has exceeded the maximum points. Delete the restored history to decrease the number of alarm histories.

312 No. of sampling has exceeded upper limit. Delete collected data.

The collection frequency exceeded the upper limit when "Store Memory" and "Accumulate/Average" were set in the scatter graph. Approve "Clear trigger" setup in the scatter graph. Set the "Operation at frequency over time" to "Initialize and Continue" in scatter

graph.

313 Insufficient key window design information. Download extended system application.

Install a system application (extended function) of [Key Window Design Information] on the GOT.

315 Device writing error. Correct device. Error occurred while writing in the device. Correct the device.

316 Cannot display or input operation value. Review expression.

In indirect specification of comment/parts number, the data operation result exceeded the range in which device type can be expressed. Review the data operational expression, in order not exceeding the range in which

the device type can be expressed.

317 Too high frequency of data collection. Review conditions.

Data of an object, to which [Collect data only when trigger conditions are satisfied] is set, are collected too frequently, or the number of objects has exceeded the number of objects collectable simultaneously. Set a longer cycle for trigger occurrence to each object. Make the settings so that 257 or more display triggers of objects, to which [Collect

data only when trigger conditions are satisfied] is set, do not occur simultaneously.

318 The sound data with the specified number does not exist.

The sound data with the specified number does not exist in the sound file list. Check the specified number. Register a sound file with the specified number.

320 Specified object does not exist or out of range.

The part file does not exist. Create the part file and download to GOT.

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 409

41

322 Dedicated device is out of range. Confirm device range.

The monitored device No. is out of the permissible area of the targeted PLC CPU. Check the PLC CPU to be monitored and its parameter settings, and set a valid

device in GT Designer3.

The specified data type is not supported by the devices of the connected controller. Check the controller settings and specify a data type supported by the devices of

the controller.

Consecutive device setting is specified for devices that cannot be specified as consecutive devices. Change the device so that consecutive device setting can be specified, or do not

set consecutive devices. For how to set the devices, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

326 The data type of labels/tags do not match. Please check the settings.

The data type of the device assigned to the label or tag is incorrect. For the usable data types, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

The data types are inconsistent between the object or others and the label or tag set on the PLC side. Correct the data type of the object or others according to that of the label or tag

set on the PLC side.

String-type labels or tags may have not been imported. If the labels or tags have not been imported, import them with GT Designer3.

327 Label names have not been resolved. Resolve label names again.

Check the connection status of the PLC and execute the label name resolution again. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

328 There are label/tag settings that can not be monitored. Check the label/tag settings or resolve the label name again.

The label or tag is set for the PLC which does not support labels. Correct the network No. and station number. The label name or tag name specified in the project data does not exist on the

PLC side. Check if the label name or tag name specified in the project data exists on the PLC side. The GOT access the label or tag inaccessible from external devices.

Enable the access from external devices in the label/tag setting on the PLC side. When a global label of structure has members to which devices are manually

assigned, the GOT fails to perform the label name resolution. Perform operations so that the devices are automatically assigned to the members, or directly set the manually assigned devices as monitor devices. Label name resolution cannot be performed during the PLC initial processing.

Change the title display time of the GOT so as to execute the label name resolution after the PLC initial processing.

329 Station numbers cannot be switched when label/ tag devices are used.

Do not perform the station No. switching to the station using labels or tags.

330 Insufficient memory media capacity. Confirm M-card capacity.

The available space of the memory card is insufficient. Check the available space of the memory card. For the checking method, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

331 Cannot access the memory card. Please check the memory card (inserted)/ SD card cover/access switch.

No memory card is installed in the drive, the SD card cover is open, or the SD card access switch is turned off. Install the memory card in the specified drive. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. Turn on the SD card access switch to make the SD card accessible.

332 Memory media is not formatted. Memory card (build-in SD card) is not formatted or formatted incorrectly. Format the memory card.

333 Unable to overwrite. Memory card is write- protected.

Memory card (build-in SD card) is write-protected. Cancel the write-protection of memory card.

334 Memory media error. Replace memory media.

Memory card (build-in SD card) is faulty. Replace the memory card.

336 Access failed because the target file size is too large.

The size of the file that the GOT attempts to access is not supported. Make sure that the file size does not exceed 2 GB. For GT27 and GT25, the size of the target file for a hard copy output must be less

than 3840 KB. For GT23, the size of the target file for a hard copy output must be less than 300

KB.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

0 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

337 File output failed. Confirm output file path. Either of the following folder or file with the name same as the file to be created exists in the storage destination SD card or USB memory. Folder storing data Write-protect file

Delete the above folder or file, or change the name of the file to be created.

338 Modem is not connected correctly or the power is not turned on.

There is no response to the initializing command because the modem is not connected correctly or the power is not turned on. Confirm the modem connection. Turn on the power of the modem.

339 Failed to initialize the modem. Check initialization command.

An error is returned from the modem because the initializing command is invalid. Confirm the initializing command of the modem.

340 Printer error or power failure Printer is faulty or the printer power supply has not been turned on. Confirm the printer. Turn on the power supply of the printer.

342 External power is not supplied to external I/ O unit

Error occurred at the external I/O interface module. If an external power supply (24VDC) is not supplied, supply the external power

supply. If an external power supply is supplied, replace the external I/O interface module.

343 External I/O unit installation error. Check if firmly installed.

The external I/O interface module is not installed correctly. Install the external I/O interface module correctly.

345 BCD/BIN conversion error Correct data Any value that cannot be converted to a BCD/BIN value is being displayed/input. Change the device data to be displayed to the BCD value. Correct the input value to the 4 digits integer.

346 There are no valid report screen settings.

The specified save destination of the report file is invalid. Check the following report file settings. The report screen exists in the report file specified as the save destination. The report file specified as the save destination of a report screen does not

specify another report file as its save destination.

351 The specified comment file does not exist. The comment file was inaccessible at the GOT startup. Check that the comment file is in the read source folder.

352 The format of the comment file is invalid. Reading the comment file has failed due to one of the following causes. The format of the comment file is incorrect. The comment file does not have a comment column or comment row.

Correct the format of the comment file, and read the file again.

353 Failed to read the comment file due to insufficient user area.

The user area does not have enough space for reading comments. Reduce the size of the project data by deleting unnecessary data or performing

other operations.

359 Thumbnail output is not available. Thumbnail output is not supported if the output format or output target is set as shown below. Disable thumbnail output and execute the output again. The output format is PDF. The output target is one of overlap windows 1 to 5 being displayed. The output target is a hidden window screen.

360 0 divisor division error. Confirm operation expression.

Zero division occurred by the data operational expression. Review the data operational expression so that the divisor should not become 0.

361 Specified device No. is out of range. The entered file number is out of range. Check the entered file number, and enter a valid value (1 to 9999).

362 Invalid device value in time action setting When controllers are controlled with the GOT's time action function, the set No. is our of range, or the set device values regarding the operation settings are out of range or invalid. Set valid values.

363 The file number exceeds the limitation. File output failed.

Delete the file that has the largest file No. and unnecessary files.

364 Cannot start hard copy. Confirm destination setting.

Check if the output destination specified with the special function switch in which the hard copy start is set and the output destination specified by setting of the hard copy are matched.

365 Cannot start hard copy. Output target is not displayed.

The overlap window specified for the output target is not displayed. Display the target overlap window and start a hard copy output.

366 Unable to output hard copy. Confirm output target setting.

An invalid setting or screen operation is detected while the image of a screen other than the displayed monitor screen is being output. For the corrective actions, refer to the following manual. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 411

41

367 Cannot start hard copy. Confirm the external control device value.

Invalid values are set for the following external control devices. Set valid values. Output file format Output target screen Number of output target screens

368 Unable to output hard copy. The specified screen is invalid.

Correct the settings of the output target screen. A hard copy output is not executed if any of the following applies. Even one of sequentially numbered screens out of the specified number of

screens is missing. The security level is insufficient. The screen number of the displayed screen is included.

369 Unable to output hard copy. The output screen data size exceeds the user area.

The data size of the output target screen exceeds the user area size (20 MB). Adjust the number of output target screens and the contents of those screens.

370 Upper and lower limit value error. Confirm value setting.

The setting of lower/upper limit value is [Upper limit Lower limit]. Correct the setting so as to be "Upper limit > Lower limit".

372 Cannot display bookmark contents over 1000.

Set the number of bookmarks of the PDF file so that it does not exceed 1000.

373 Overflow occurred in 64-bit bitwise operations. Confirm operation expression.

An overflow has occurred in a 64-bit data operation. Correct the expression for a data operation.

380 Insufficient USB drive capacity. Confirm the drive capacity.

Available memory of the extention drive is insufficient. Confirm the available memory of the extention drive, and increase the memory if it is low.

381 USB drive is not installed or in a removable state.

Install the extention drive if it is not installed. Reinstall the extention drive if it is in the removable status.

382 USB drive is not formatted. Extention drive is not formatted or formatted incompatible with GOT. Reformat the extention drive.

383 Unable to overwrite. USB drive is write- protected

Extention driver is write-protected. Cancel the write-protection of extention drive.

384 USB drive error. Replace USB drive. Extention drive is faulty. Replace the extention drive.

390 Failed to connect to the file server. Exceeded the share limit of the server.

The number of clients connected the shared folder on the file server has exceeded the limit. Disconnect any client or raise the maximum number of connections to the shared folder.

391 Failed to connect to the file server. Authentication failed on the server.

The user name and password settings are inconsistent between the GOT and the file server. Correct the user name and password settings.

392 Failed to connect to the file server. Cannot find the destination.

The specified shared folder does not exist on the file server. Check that the specified shared folder name is consistent between the GOT and the file server.

393 Failed to connect to the file server. Accessed with a locked user.

The specified user name has been locked out on the server. Specify an unlocked user name, or unlock the user name.

394 Failed to connect to the file server. An invalid volume was specified.

The hard disk specified as the network drive is inaccessible. Check the settings of the hard disk.

395 Cannot use the network drive. File server does not respond (timeout).

After the GOT is connected to the file server, the IP address of the server or shared folder name is changed, the holder becomes unshared, or the server is turned off.

Check if the above conditions have occurred. The connected file server is not validated.

Check if the file server has been validated.

396 An unexpected error was detected in the network drive.

An error occurred in the file server. Contact the manufacturer of the file server.

401 An error response has been received from the connected device.

Eliminate the cause of the CPU error. Review the operating conditions of the CPU, parameters, and others.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

2 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

402 Communication timeout. Confirm communication pathway or modules.

The time-out error occurred during communicating. Confirm the cable omission, the communication unit mounting status and status of

the PLC. Channel No. is not displayed in error code or error message in the case an error occurs when using the multi-channel function. Refer to the following manual to identify the channel No. in error. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for GT Works3 and a controller used (1.6 Checking for Normal Monitoring) This error may occur when the load of PLC CPU becomes heavier while

accessing other stations. In such case, transfer the data of the other station to the host station PLC CPU and monitor them at the host.

Put COM instruction when the PLC scanning is long. Check if the version of the communication driver supports the controller.

For how to check the version of the communication driver, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

403 SIO status error. Confirm communication pathway or modules.

Either of the overrun error, parity bit error or flaming error was generated when the RS-422 / RS-232 communication was received. Confirm the cable omission, the communication module mounting status, status of the PLC.and the transmission speed of the computer link. Channel No. is not displayed in error code or error message in the case an error occurs when using the multi-channel function. Refer to the following manual to identify the channel No. in error. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for GT Works3 and a controller used (1.6 Checking for Normal Monitoring)

404 Response does not match communication request.

Resolve crosstalk on the line. Lengthen the communication timeout time.

Change the communication timeout time by one of the following methods. Changing the setting in [Detail setting] of the utility. Page 108 Communication detail setting Changing the setting of the communication detail settings in GT Designer3. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used

406 Specified station access is out of range. Confirm station no.

Station numbers other than master/local station are specified at the CC-Link connection (via G4).

A PLC CPU other than QCPU is accessed. Confirm the station number of the project data.

407 Accessed other network. Change network setting.

When monitoring the same network as the GOT The GOT accesses the other networks with the MELSECNET/H, MELSECNET/10 (PLC to PLC network), or CC-Link IE Controller Network connection. Confirm the network number of the project data so as not to access to other networks. When monitoring other networks

Reconfigure the [Routing Information Setting] of GT Designer3 or the [Routing Information Setting] of GX Developer. When using GT15-75J71LP23-Z/ GT15-75J71BR13-Z

Other networks cannot be monitored. Confirm the network number of the project data so as not to access to other networks.

410 Cannot perform operation because of PLC run mode. stop the PLC.

The operation, which could not be performed during RUN of PLC CPU, was performed. Stop the PLC CPU.

411 Memory cassette is write-protected. Check the memory cassette.

The memory cassette installed in the PLC CPU is EPROM or E2PROM, and it is in a protected status. Confirm the memory cassette installed in PLC CPU.

412 Cannot read/write device protected by keyword. Remove keyword.

The key word is set in PLC CPU. Cancel the key word.

413 Unsupported CPU has been accessed. Check the latest manual to see if the CPU is supported. Write package data created with the latest version of GT Designer3. Connect a servo amplifier of the same model as the one specified in GT

Designer3.

414 Data cannot be written to a writeprotected device. Please review the settings.

The external write-protection setting of the device is set to the CPU to which data was attempted to be written. Perform one of the following actions. Do not write data to a device to which the external write-protection setting of the

device is set. Write data to the available device again. Disable the external write-protection setting of the device and write data again.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 413

41

415 Failed to write a file to the connected device because the write-protection setting of the device was enabled.

The external write-protection setting of the device is set to the CPU to which a file was attempted to be written. Perform one of the following actions. Do not write a device initial value file or file register file. Disable the external write-protection setting of the device and write data again.

416 Failed to write to a file because the external operation prohibition setting of the operation history file was enabled.

[Disable clearing operation history] is enabled in the CPU to which a file was attempted to be written. Disable this setting and write the file again.

420 E71 specification is ASCII. [ASCII code] is selected in [Ethernet operations] of the PLC side setting. Select [Binary code].

421 E71 is set as read-only. Clear setting. The Ethernet module on the PLC side is set in read-only. Set the Ethernet module on the PLC side to write-enabled.

422 Not communicating between CPU and E71. Confirm CPU error.

PLC CPU error. Communication between PLC CPU and the PLC side Ethernet module impossible. Confirm whether there is error in PLC CPU by GX Developer etc. (Confirm buffer memory)

423 Insufficient network table information. Add station no.

The station number set in the project data and the station number set in the switching station No. device do not exist in the Ethernet setting of GT Designer3. Add the station number set in the project data to the Ethernet setting of GT

Designer3. When using the station No. switching function, check the data of the switching

station No. device. When the station number specified in the switching station No. device is not set in the Ethernet setting, add the station number to the Ethernet setting. When the station number does not exist in the system, change the data of the switching station No. device. (Set the station number so that it becomes the same as the station number of the PLC side Ethernet module set in the parameter setting of GX Developer.)

424 Same sta. on GOT & project data. Review communication parameter.

The station number set in the GOT's utility is the same as the station number set in the Ethernet setting of GT Designer3 (the station number of the PLC side Ethernet module) or in the project data. Check the following contents so that the multiple station numbers should not be the same. Check the GOT's station number in the GOT's utility. Check the station number set in the project data. Check the station number set in the Ethernet setting.

(Set the station number so that it becomes the same as the station number of the PLC side Ethernet module set in the parameter setting of GX Developer.) When using the station No. switching function, check the data of the switching

station No. device.

425 A duplicate IP address has been detected. Confirm the setting.

The GOT has the same IP address as another device. Change the IP address of the GOT or the device.

430 Wireless LAN unit is not mounted or a hardware error occurred.

The wireless LAN communication unit is not installed on the side interface. Check that the unit is installed properly.

431 Connectable access point is not found. Check the setting for an accessible access point, and the wireless LAN connection setting.

432 Wireless LAN connection settings are not specified.

After configuring the wireless LAN connection setting, enable the wireless LAN connection function. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

433 Failed to authenticate the access point. Check if the authentication method specified in the wireless LAN connection setting is the same as that on the access point side.

434 GOT hardware version not supported by wireless LAN connection

Use a GOT with hardware version B or later. For how to check the hardware version, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

440 The label information has been updated. The label name resolution will be executed automatically. Wait for the completion.

441 The specified CPU is updating the label information.

The global label information of the specified CPU will be updated. Wait for the completion.

442 Resolving the label information. Do not turn off the power during the process.

The label name resolution is being executed. Wait for the completion.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

4 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

443 Label names were resolved with the batch method because the firmware version of the programmable controller CPU does not support the split method. It may take time to complete the process.

The firmware of the PLC CPU does not support performing the label name resolution in units of global label blocks. Update the firmware version of the PLC CPU.

445 Failed to resolve label names. Resolve label names after completing initial processing of programmable controller CPU or confirm label name settings.

Label name resolution cannot be performed during the PLC initial processing. Turn on the GOT after the PLC initial processing, or set the title display time of the GOT so that the GOT is started after the PLC initial processing. The label name specified in the project data does not exist on the PLC side.

Check if the label name exists on the PLC side. The GOT accesses the label inaccessible from external devices.

Enable the access from external devices in the label setting on the PLC side. When a global label of structure has members to which devices are manually

assigned, the GOT fails to perform the label name resolution. Perform operations so that the devices are automatically assigned to the members, or directly set the manually assigned devices as monitor devices.

448 PLC cannot handle as requested. Correct devices.

A device outside the range of PLC CPU file registers and the buffer memory was specified.

Correct the monitor device by setting file register of the PLC CPU. The label of the PLC CPU is assigned with a device out of the device range.

Assign a device within the device range to the label.

449 Dedicated device is out of range. Confirm device range.

Check the PLC CPU to be monitored and its parameter settings, and set a valid device in GT Designer3.

Set the address for the special function module in the GOT monitor available range.

450 Path has changed or timeout occurred in redundant system.

The path has been switched or timeout occurred in the redundant system. Check the PLC CPU to know if the path has been switched. Check the cable connection status, the communication unit installation status, and

the PLC CPU status. This error may occur when the load of the PLC CPU becomes heavier when

accessing other stations. In such a case, transfer the data of the other stations to the host station PLC CPU and monitor them at the host.

Perform one of the following operations if the PLC scanning time is long: COM instruction/Extension of END processing/Setting of the number of processing times for general data/Data update batch processing.

451 MELSEC redundant system settings and current config. do not match.

Change the MELSEC redundant setting in accordance with the actual MELSEC redundant system.

452 System (A/B) and system status (control/ standby) not determined in redundant system.

Set one system as system A or control system and the other system as system B or standby system.

Do not specify any connection destination system (request destination module I/O number).

453 The standby system is set in a system other than the MELSEC iQ-R redundant system.

When the MELSEC redundant setting is not configured, delete the specified device of the standby system.

Configure the redundant system using the MELSEC iQ-R series.

460 Communication unit error Reset the power of the GOT. Replace the unit. Correct the detail settings in the controller setting in GT Designer3.

461 Communication error occurred between option units and the GOT.

Check the following manual for the vibration resistance specifications and the method of mounting the option units. After that, reset the GOT power supply. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

470 No routing params. Communication not established with specified sta.

Set routing parameters.

471 No IP address info. (Ethernet table) of connection destination.

Set the network information about the destination for [Ethernet setting].

480 Communication channel not set. Set channel number on Utility.

Channel (CH.No.1 to 4) to communicate with a controller is not set. After setting the Communication Settings on the GT Designer3, download it to the

GOT. Change the channel assignment in the Communication Setting on the utility.

*1

481 Communication unit not mounted to the slot of active channel.

The interface where the channel (CH No.1 to 4) is set does not have a communication unit installed. Install a communication unit to the interface where the channel (CH No.1 to 4) is

set. Change assignment of the channel (CH No.1 to 4) in the Communication Setting.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 415

41

482 Too many same units are mounted. Confirm the no of units.

Units are mounted on the GOT exceeding the maximum number of mountable units. Check the number of units, and remove unnecessary units.

*1

483 Simultaneous mounting of the units are not allowed.

Two or more units which cannot be mounted on the GOT simultaneously are mounted. Check the mounted units, and remove unnecessary units.

*1

484 Unit mounted incorrectly. Move the unit to correct position.

The unit is not mounted on the GOT in the correct position. Confirm the mounting position of the unit.

*1

485 Too many units mounted on GOT. Reduce units.

Units are mounted on the GOT exceeding the maximum number of mountable units. Check the number of units, and remove unnecessary units.

*1

486 Communication unit not corresponded to set communication driver.

The communication driver set in the Communication Setting and the communication unit installed on the GOT do not match. Check whether the communication driver set in the Communication Setting is

correct. Check whether any incorrect communication unit has been installed on the GOT.

*1

487 Please turn on the PLC and the GOT again.

Turn the power of the PLC and GOT on again.

488 Too many units mounted on GOT. Reduce units.

Units are mounted on the GOT exceeding the maximum number of mountable units.Check the number of units, and remove unnecessary units.

*1

489 Inactive channel has been selected at Communication Settings.

Inactive channel No. has been set in the project data. Check whether any unnecessary channel No. has been set in the project data. Check whether channel Nos. set in the project data are set in the Communication

Settings.

*1

492 Unusable communication units are mounted.

Unit unusable for GOT is installed. Remove the unusable unit.

*1

493 Installation of extension units may be inappropriate.

Check if the extension units are securely mounted on the GOT.

496 GOT settings do not meet operating conditions of the comm. driver.

An unavailable IP address has been set. Set the IP address within the range of 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254.

Multiple Ethernet interfaces are set to access the same network. Set an IP address and a subnet mask for each Ethernet interface so that each interface accesses a different network.

Another device uses port No. 61451. Change the port number for the device.

497 Failed to start communication driver(s). Install the communication driver(s) again.

500 Warning! Built-in battery voltage is low. The voltage of the GOT built-in battery is decreased. Replace the GOT built-in battery.

510 Clock data input out of range The value that is input as clock data is out of the input enabled range. In this case, the input value is not accepted. Confirm the input range of the value to be input as clock data, and input the proper value again.

511 Detected a decrease in brightness or a failure of the liquid crystal backlight.

The liquid crystal backlight has a decrease in brightness or a failure. If the error is repeatedly detected, consult your local sales office.

522 Unnecessary file deleted to create new file. The old file of different contents has been deleted and a new file has been created. Note that the old file is deleted and the new file is created if the file of the same name with different contents exists when creating files.

523 The read alarm log file has a different number of alarm points.

When the alarm settings (including the number of monitored alarms and the hierarchy) are changed, the alarm log file before the change is read, but alarms are collected according to the new settings. An alarm displayed after the change may differ from one before the change. Delete the alarm log file as necessary.

525 Unable to read/write alarm log files under different projects.

Unable to read the alarm log file saved by the different project. Confirm the alarm log file and where to store the alarm log file.

526 File conversion failed. The file specified for the file conversion does not exist. Check the settings for specifying a file to be converted.

527 Insufficient SRAM capacity. The capacity for the SRAM user area is insufficient. Confirm the available memory in the SRAM user area.

528 Error in SRAM. Failed to write data.

The error may be caused by a failure in the GOT main unit. Contact your local Mitsubishi representative.

529 Data error in SRAM. Check the battery life. Error in SRAM data due to battery voltage low, etc. Confirm the battery status.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

6 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

532 Cannot access the files. Check the memory card.

Check if the file name is appropriate. The file name contains invalid characters. For the character type and the number of characters available for file names, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

533 Cannot access Files. Check the memory card

Insert a SD card or USB memory. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. If the SD card or USB memory have unnecessary files, delete the files.

535 Cannot open image file. Check if the target file is stored in the SD card or USB memory.

536 Image file error or invalid file format. Check if the image files in the SD card, USB memory, or drive V are normal. Check if any image file of invalid format is stored.

537 The display position of the image file is invalid.

If a part containing an image file is used in GOT Graphic Ver.1 and the part lies beyond the top or left of the screen, the image file is not displayed. Adjust the position of the part.

562 Install the font appropriate for the specified system language.

No font appropriate for the system language specified at the system language switching is installed. Install the appropriate font.

565 Files for the extended system application are missing.

Install again system application (extended function) that you failed to execute.

571 Capacity shortage of user memory (RAM) There is no empty area/space in D drive. Format the D drive in the memory to secure free area.

577 Newly readable records do not exist. The space for reading records is insufficient. Delete unnecessary records.

578 The specified record name is invalid. Check the record name.

A blank record with no name and device value does not exist. Set such a blank record in advance.

579 Recipe is in process. Cannot operate the recipe file.

Another recipe processing is in progress. After the processing is complete, perform the recipe file operation again.

580 Selected recipe setting is not the recipe file operation target.

The specified recipe setting has no G2P recipe file. Specify a G2P file.

581 Abnormal Advanced recipe file Recipe cannot be executed for recipe file with incorrect contents. Take one of the following corrective actions. Delete the recipe file from the SD card or USB memory. Delete the relevant recipe data with the SRAM management function, and perform

the recipe operation again.

582 Cannot generate Advanced recipe file. Cannot generate recipe file. Confirm the following and execute recipe processing again. Confirm whether the SD card or USB memory is installed. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. Confirm the available memory of the SD card or USB memory. Check that the SRAM user area has enough free space.

583 Unable to save device value to Advanced recipe file.

Unable to save device value to recipe file. Confirm the write-protection of the SD card or USB memory. Confirm whether the attribute of saving file is for reading only.

584 Advance recipe file save error An error has occurred at the time of writing the recipe file or recipe data. Take one of the following corrective actions. If the recipe file is set to be saved in a data storage (SD card or USB memory), do

not remove the data storage during the operation. If the recipe data is set to be saved in the SRAM user area, the GOT physical

memory may be corrupted. Consult your local sales office.

585 Advanced recipe file upload error An error has occurred at the time of writing the recipe file or recipe data. Take one of the following corrective actions. If the recipe file is set to be saved in a data storage (SD card or USB memory), do

not remove the data storage during the operation. If the recipe data is set to be saved in the SRAM user area, the GOT physical

memory may be corrupted. Consult your local sales office.

586 Specified Advanced recipe number does not exist.

The recipe of non-existing number is about to be executed. Execute recipe of existing number.

587 Specified record number does not exist. The advanced record of non-existing number is about to be executed. Execute record of existing number.

588 Cannot save recipe data to read only record.

Saving recipe is about to be executed to the record of which recipe device value cannot be edited. Make the recipe device value of the record editable with Recipe Setting of GT Designer3 or specify the record of which recipe device value can be edited.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 417

41

589 Recipe device read/conversion error. The file save destination is not specified.

Saving recipe is about to be executed to the recipe setting that is set for not using file. Specify a different recipe setting in which recipe data is set to be saved.

590 Recipe device upload error. Recipe device value does not exist.

You tried to read device values into the recipe setting in which recipe data is set not to be saved. Specify the record of which recipe device value is set.

591 Advanced Recipe error. Check recipe data. The recipe setting is not correct. Confirm the recipe setting of the project data and download it to the GOT again.

592 The extension specified to the recipe file is invalid.

Check if the file name is appropriate. The file name contains invalid characters. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

593 The setting of G1P file of the original diversion is different from the project data.

The settings of the sourcMatch the settings of the advanced recipe file and those of the GOT2000 recipe file, or delete an unnecessary advanced recipe file from the memory card.e advanced recipe file are not matched with those of the GOT2000 recipe file, or incorrect.

594 Abnormal device values were detected in the conversion source recipe file.

A value outside the setting range or a character that cannot be converted into a numerical value is included in the device value of the conversion source recipe file or CSV/Unicode text file. Check the file and correct the device value.

595 Logging file error. Logging file error.The setting of G1P file of the original diversion is different from the project data.The setting of G1P file of the original diversion is different from the project data. When collecting data again, delete logging files and management files.

596 Logging setting does not exist or setting value error.

Logging setting does not exist or setting value error. Specify an existing logging setting in the historical trend graph setting and the historical data list setting.

597 The specified logging ID does not exist. Check the logging ID in the historical trend graph setting. Specify an existing logging ID in the Logging ID External Control device. Select the graph offset function to specify an existing logging ID in the logging

setting

598 The specified logging setting is incompatible.

Configure the setting so that the number of logging devices set for the logging ID exceeds that of data lines on the historical trend graph.

Configure the setting so that the data type of the logging device set for the logging ID is the same as that of the device specified in the historical trend graph.

601 Printer unit error. The printer unit is installed incorrectly. The built-in flash memory of the printer unit is broken or the guaranteed life has been elapsed. Check that the printer unit is installed correctly. When the printer unit has been installed correctly, the built-in flash memory is broken or the guaranteed life has been elapsed. Replace the printer unit with new one.

602 Video/RGB unit not mounted Check if the video/RGB input unit is installed. Check if the GOT used supports video/RGB input.

603 External I/O unit error Check if the external I/O unit is correctly installed.

604 Sound output unit error Check if the sound output unit is correctly installed.

605 USB device I/F error The error may be caused by a failure in the GOT. Contact your local Mitsubishi representative.

606 Multimedia processing unit is not mounted. Multimedia unit is installed incorrectly. Check that the multimedia unit is installed correctly.

607 Video RGB input object has too many. Please reduce the number of settings.

Reduce the number of the video/RGB display objects to be displayed simultaneously.

608 Hierarchical relationship of video RGB input object can not be represented correctly.

Make sure that multiple video/RGB display objects do not overlap each other.

609 Communication/Option unit is not mounted.

Mount the communication unit or option unit correctly.

610 Insufficient memory capacity. The memory capacity for the MES interface function is insufficient. Delete unnecessary files, and reserve memory.

611 Improper job files. Confirm job setting. The contents for job files are unmatched with the settings for job files. Check if there are mistakes in the settings on the setting screen.

612 Cannot access Logging Files Check the memory card

Insert a SD card or USB memory. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. If the SD card or USB memory have unnecessary files, delete the files.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

8

613 Error in writing logfile Insert a SD card or USB memory. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. Check if the SD card or USB memory is writable.

614 Error in reading logfile Insert a SD card or USB memory. Close the SD card cover to make the SD card accessible. Check if the SD card or USB memory is readable.

615 Cannot connect to MES Server. Check the Server.

The server does not work normally or the connection path to the server is made up incorrectly. Check the operating conditions of the server. Check the network to the server.

616 Cannot connect to SNTP Server. Check the Server.

The settings for the SNTP server are wrong or the network to the SNTP server is made up incorrectly. Check the operating conditions of the STNP server. Check the network to the SNTP server.

620 Trial connection has started. While the license number of the GOT Mobile function is unregistered, the GOT is accessed by information devices. To use the GOT Mobile function in the full version, register the license number on the GOT.

621 Failed to start the GOT Mobile function. Check if the HTTP connection port number is duplicated. (For GT SoftGOT2000, use the set port number, the port number +1, and the port number +2.) Restart the personal computer.

622 Cannot display the overlap window having a width wider than the base screen.

Set the width (excluding the frame width) of an overlap window with the title bar equal or less than the width of the base screen.

630 Failed to save a video file. Check the CF card available area, installation status, cancellation of write-protect, format status and number of saved files.

631 Failed to save a video file on network. Check the activation status of personal computer linkage software in file server, the setting of Ethernet FTP function of GOT, the network setting of GOT and file server and the available area of SD card installed in the GOT main unit.

632 Error detected during multimedia processing.

Switch off the GOT and check the installation status of multimedia unit, or change the multimedia unit.

633 The version of the unit software is not the latest.

Install the latest compatible multimedia unit software using the utility of the GOT.

634 No space remaining in the multimedia CF card. Terminating long time recording.

Change the CF card installed on the multimedia unit, or delete unnecessary files.

640 An error occurred in a File transfer process.

Correct the settings for the file transfer function (FTP transfer). Check the operating status and network line of the FTP server. For the error details, check GS989 (File Transfer Error No.). GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual This system alarm does not occur when GS989 stores error code 600 or higher.

641 The license key has not been registered. Confirm your license.

On the GOT, register the license number for the VNC server function, the remote personal computer operation function (Ethernet), the MES interface function, or the GOT Mobile function.

643 The version of the DB connection service is not supported by GOT.

Use DB Connection Service Version 1.14Q or later, or Version 2 or later.

650 The operator management information file is invalid.

Prepare a normal operator management information file and import it ,or store the operator management information file in a specified location.

651 Cannot access the operator management information file.

Check if the destination drive that stores the specified operator management information file is accessible by the GOT.

660 Failed to obtain op. authority. Server does not respond.

Make sure that the master GOT has been connected and started. Make sure that the GOT network interaction function is enabled in the master GOT.

670 Current alarms exceeded the max no. that can be procd. at a time.

A hundred or more system alarms have occurred simultaneously. Eliminate the cause of the output system alarms and check system alarms again.

697 Package writing of the old version is not allowed.

Install the latest version of GT Designer3, and then perform the operation again.

698 Insufficient CoreOS version. Install the latest version of CoreOS.

699 Insufficient BootOS version. Install the latest version of BootOS

800 Abnormal module status A module status error has occurred on the connected network. For the causes and corrective actions, refer to the network manual.

801 Abnormal baton passing status Refer to explanations of SB0047 on the applicable network manual.

802 Abnormal cyclic transmission status Refer to explanations of SB0049 on the applicable network manual.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List 419

42

*1 When there is an error, "0" is stored to the channel No.

803 Transient error Refer to explanations of SB00EE on the applicable network manual.

804 The cable on the IN side is disconnected or is not connected.

Refer to explanations of SB0067 on the applicable network manual.

805 The cable on the OUT side is disconnected or is not connected.

Refer to explanations of SB0068 on the applicable network manual.

820 A duplicate IP address has been detected. Confirm the setting.

Change the IP address of the CC-Link IE TSN communication unit or another device. Do not duplicate the IP address.

840 PROFIBUS master is not started. Turn on the PROFIBUS master module.

841 I/O setting of the PROFIBUS master and slaves do not match.

Use the GSD file, a configuration file provided by MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC. (Edit prohibited)

Correct relevant settings, and turn off and then on the GOT.

850 CC-Link switch setting error Check if the switch settings have no error. Check error codes stored in SW006A. Refer to explanations of SB006A on the applicable network manual.

851 Abnormal cyclic transmission status Check if terminating resistors are connected. Check error codes for the PLC CPU. Check the parameter for the PLC CPU on the master station(specified control station). Check the error status of the master station(specified control station). Refer to explanations of SB006E on the applicable network manual.

852 Abnormal host line status Check if the cable is unplugged or not. Refer to explanations of SB0090 on the applicable network manual.

853 Transient error Check the transient error occurrence status for each station stored in SW0094 to SW0097. Refer to explanations of SB0094.

854 Duplicate master stations are set in the same network.

Set only one master station(specified control station) in the network.

855 Disconnected. The GOT is waiting for a request from the master station(specified control station). Check the status of the master station(specified control station).

860 Off line or the network power is off. Check the module status LED indicator. Turn on the network. Check that cables are connected properly. Match the communication speed of the GOT to that of the master equipment.

861 No connections are established. Check the settings of the master equipment. Turn on the master equipment.

862 Critical link error The controller has failed, or has an error disabling network communication. (MAC IDs are duplicated, or Bus-off is detected.) Check the controller.

863 Incomplete configuration The controller setting is not configured, or the setting is inadequate or incorrect. Review the controller setting.

864 Unrecoverable fault(s) The controller has an uncorrectable error.

865 Recoverable fault(s) The error is automatically corrected. If the module status LED indicator does not turn green, the controller may have a failure.

Error code

Error message Action Channel No. storage

0 8 SYSTEM ALARM DISPLAY AND LIST 8.2 Error Codes and System Alarm List

PART 2 UTILITY FOR GT21

9 UTILITY FUNCTION

10 LANGUAGE SETTING

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA

16 DEBUG

17 MAINTENANCE

18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION

19 ERROR MESSAGE LIST

421

42

9 UTILITY FUNCTION Page 422 Utility Execution Page 423 Utility Function List Page 425 Utility Display Utility is a function, which carries out connection of GOT and controller, screen display and operation method settings, program/data control and self-check etc.

9.1 Utility Execution For utility execution, utility has to be displayed by installing BootOS and package data in the C drive (built in flash memory). (BootOS is installed in the GOT at factory shipment. It is not necessary to install BootOS when upgrading of it is unnecessary.) There are following two methods for installing BootOS and package data.

Refer to the following for the installation which uses GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual For the installation methods of package data with an SD card, refer to the following. Page 693 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION

Install directly from GT Designer3 Via a USB interface or

Ethernet interface

GT Designer3

GT Designer3

Writing package data

2) GT Designer3 SD card GOT

GOT

Installing package data

Installing BootOS or package data

When the GOT is located in a remote place, package data can be easily installed with a SD card.

Install an SD card to the GOT.SD card

1) GT Designer3 GOT

GOT

2 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.1 Utility Execution

9

9.2 Utility Function List The items in the following list can be set/operated on the utility screens.

Item Function overview Reference Language Switching message languages Page 433 LANGUAGE

SETTING

Communication setting

standard I/F setting Assigning channel number and communication driver to communication interface

Page 435 Standard I/F

GOT IP Address*1 Configuring GOT Ethernet setting Page 451 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only)

Ethernet communication*1 Displaying the contents of Ethernet setting, changing the host Page 456 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

Comm. Monitor Checking the serial communication port communication Page 464 Communication Monitor

Ethernet check*1 Checking the Ethernet communication port communication Page 469 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only)

Transparent setting Setting the channel No. to be used for the communication for the FA transparent function

Page 471 Setting the Transparent Mode

Keyword Setting or deleting sequence program protection key words and canceling sequence program protection status for the FXCPU connection

Page 472 Keyword

Ethernet printer Setting the IP address of the Ethernet printer Page 480 Ethernet Printer

GOT Setup Display settings Setting the title display period Page 486 Display SettingsSetting the screen save time

Adjusting brightness

Operation Setting the buzzer sound Page 492 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

Setting the window move buzzer

Setting the key reaction speed

Touch panel calibration

Setting the utility call keys

Unique information Setting the GOT ID No. Page 502 Inherent Information

USB host Setting the USB mouse/keyboard (GT2107-W) Page 503 USB Host

Backup/restoration setting Setting the storage location for backup and restoration (GT2107-W) Page 506 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration

GOT internal device monitor Setting the Use/Disuse the GOT internal device monitor of GOTdiagnostics

Page 508 GOT Internal Device Monitor

VNC server function Setting the VNC server function (GT2107-W) Page 510 VNC Server Function

License Management Display screen for Register or delete the license (GT2107-W) Page 512 License Management

IP filter setting*1 Setting the IP filter usage, filtering method, target IP address, and exception IP address

Page 514 IP filter setting

Security setting Security level authentication Changing the security level Page 521 Security Level Authentication

Operator Authentication Operator management Page 523 Operator AuthenticationPassword change

Function setting

Login/Logout Page 536 Login/Logout

Time setting Time setting Page 537 Time Setting and Display

9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.2 Utility Function List 423

42

*1 Only available to the models with an Ethernet interface.

Data control OS information OS information Page 558 OS information

Resource data Alarm Information

Deleting or copying alarm log files Converting alarm log files in G2A format CSV/TXT format

Page 559 Alarm information

Recipe Information

Converting recipe files in G2P format CSV/TXT format Converting CSV/TXT format Recipe files in G2P format Deleting or copying recipe files

Page 569 Recipe information

Logging Information

Deleting or copying logging files Page 580 Logging information

Image File Management

Deleting or copying hard copy files Page 587 Image file management

Operation log information

Deleting or copying operation log files Converting operation log files in G2O format CSV/TXT format

Page 594 Operation log information

SD card acce Setting the access permission of the SD card Page 600 SD Card Access

SD card format Formatting the SD card Page 601 SD Card Format

Clear data Clearing the project data and resource data on the GOT Page 605 Clear Data

Data copy Installing or updating package data Page 609 Data Copy

Backup/restore Backing up or restoring sequence programs, parameters, and setting values

Page 614 Backup and Restoration

USB device management Displaying the status of USB device (GT2107-W) Page 636 USB Device Management

Debug Device monitor Device monitor of PLC, test function, current value change of the buffer memory and the buffer memory monitor of intelligent module

Page 639 Device Monitor Function

FX list editor Changing parameters and sequence program of FX PLC Page 653 FX List Editor

FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function

Configuring the communication setting for FX3U-ENET-ADP stored in the FXCPU

Page 683 FX3U-ENET- ADP Communication Setting Function

Maintenance Touch panel calibration Calibrating the touch panel reading error Page 687 Touch Panel Calibration

Touch panel check Checking the touch panel operation Page 690 Touch Panel Check

Clean Displaying the screen for cleaning the display Page 692 Clean

Item Function overview Reference

4 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.2 Utility Function List

9

9.3 Utility Display To display setting screens for each utility, the main menu has to be displayed first. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Main menu The menu items that can be set at the GOT utility are displayed. Touching a menu item in the main menu will display the setting screen or following selection screen for the item.

9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display 425

42

System message switch button This button switches the language used for the utility or system alarms. Touching the [Language] button displays the Language screen.

1. Touch the language button of a desired language and touch the [OK] button to select the language.

2. Touching the [] button switches the utility language to the selected language.

When starting the GOT without selecting any language or the selected language and the installed fonts are not matched

The following screen will be displayed. Touching the button of a desired language restarts the GOT and the language is switched to the selected one.

Selectable languages The system message switch button is displayed only for the selectable languages. The selectable languages differ depending on the fonts installed in the GOT. For the relation between the selectable languages and the fonts, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual System language switching using the device The system language can be switched using the system language switching device set with GT Designer3. For the setting method of the system language switching device, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

6 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display

9

Display operation of main menu The following four types of operation can display the main menu. (Display the main menu after installing the package data from GT Designer3 to the GOT built in flash memory.)

When project data is undownloaded After the GOT is turned on, a dialog box for notifying of absence of project data is displayed. After the dialog box is displayed, touch the [OK] button to display the main menu.

When touching utility call key If you touch the utility call key while user-created screen is displayed, the main menu is displayed. The utility call key is set in the position on the GOT screen upper left corner at factory shipment.

The utility function windows appear in the horizontal format, and this format cannot be changed. The utility call key can be set by the GOT utility or GT Designer3. For the setting method of the utility call key, refer to the following. Page 499 Setting the utility call keys GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Prohibited simultaneous 2-point presses Do not touch 2 points or more on the GOT screen simultaneously. Touching 2 points or more simultaneously may activate a part other than the touched point. Press time of the utility call key When having set [Press time] of the utility call key setting screen to other than "0 (s)", keep pressing the touch panel for the period set to [Press time] or more before leaving the finger from the touch panel. For utility call key setting, refer to the following. Page 499 Setting the utility call keys When the utility call key is not set Even when the utility call key is not set (set to the zero point), you can display the main menu by performing the following operation. Pressing the special function switch set on the user-created screen Selecting [Utility] from the startup mode selection screen

When the GOT is powered on

Touch the OK button.

Horizontal format Vertical format

9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display 427

42

When touching special function switch (utility) If you touch the special function switch (utility) while user-created screen is displayed, the main menu is displayed. The special function switch (utility) can be set as a touch switch that is displayed on a user-created screen by GT Designer3.

For the details of the special function switch, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

When limiting the display and operation of the utility When limiting the display and operating users, set a password to the GOT using GT Designer3. If a user tries to display the main menu of the utility, the password is displayed. Refer to the following for the details related to the password setting. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Special function switch (Utility)

8 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display

9

Utility basic configuration The basic configuration of utility is as follows.

Title display The screen title name is displayed in title display part.

Close/Return button When a middle screen of the layers is displayed, if the [] (Close/return) button in the right corner of screen is touched, returns to the previous screen. If this button is touched when directly displayed from monitor screen, the screen is closed and returns to monitor screen.

Scroll button For screens in which the content does not fit on one screen page, there is a right or down scroll button on the screen.

Scroll one line/column.

Title display Close/Return button

Screen

Scroll button

Title display

Title display

9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display 429

43

Basic operation of settings change

Change of setting value

Setting item, select button Touch the select button to change the settings. The setting methods differ depending on the setting items. The following types of setting method are available. Switching the setting value The button repeats every time it is pressed. Enter the setting value with a keyboard. Use these keys to enter numerical values. Touch the button to display a keyboard on the GOT screen. For the keyboard operations, refer to the next page. Keyboard operations Move to another setting screen. Touch the button to move to each setting screen. For the setting method of each setting item, refer to the setting operation of each setting screen.

[] (Close/Return) button Reflect or cancel the changed settings. [] (Close/Return) button Touching this button closes the screen. Depending on the setting item, the GOT restarts. Touching the [] button displays the dialog box shown below. (If no setting is changed, the dialog is not displayed.) Follow the instruction in the dialog.

Setting item Select button Setting item Select button

ON OFF

0 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display

9

Save message screen In a setting screen having the [Save] button shown below, touching the [] button does not show the save message screen shown above and returns to the previous screen when the setting is changed. To save the setting contents, always touch the [Save] button.

Keyboard operations 1. Touch the numerical value to be changed.

2. The keyboard for entering numerical values and a cursor are displayed. The display position of the keyboard differs depending on the position of the touched numerical value. (The keyboard is displayed at a position that does not disturb users to input numerical values.)

3. Input numerical value by the keyboard. [0] to [9] Key: Enter numerical values. [Enter] Key: Completes the numerical value input and closes the keyboard. [Cancel] Key: Cancels the numerical value input and closes the keyboard. [Del] Key: Deletes one character. [AC] Key: Deletes all characters.

4. Touching the [Enter] key completes the numerical value input and closes the keyboard.

Keyboard

Cursor

9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display 431

43

MEMO

2 9 UTILITY FUNCTION 9.3 Utility Display

10

10 LANGUAGE SETTING Page 433 Display Language Setting

10.1 Display Language Setting Display language setting function This function allows display language selection. The items which can be set are shown below.

Language setting operation

Language 1. Touch [Language] to bring up the set up screen.

2. Select a display language by touching the corresponding button.

3. After changing the setting, touch the [] button. The setting is saved and the setting screen is closed.

Item Description Setting range Language Display language in which the utility functions and dialog windows are

displayed can be selected or confirmed in this menu Japanese/English/Chinese

Main menu

Touch Language.

Touch a desired language.

Touch

10 LANGUAGE SETTING 10.1 Display Language Setting 433

43

Switching the display language of the utility by devices Any device can be used for switching the display language of the utility. For details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual When using devices to switch the display language of the utility, it does not change even if the display language is switched from the GOT utility screen. Selectable languages The system message switch button is displayed only for the selectable languages. The selectable languages differ depending on the fonts installed in the GOT. For the relation between the selectable languages and the fonts, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

4 10 LANGUAGE SETTING 10.1 Display Language Setting

11

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING Page 435 Standard I/F Page 451 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) Page 456 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) Page 464 Communication Monitor Page 469 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only) Page 471 Setting the Transparent Mode Page 472 Keyword Page 480 Ethernet Printer The following communication interface setting can be configured.

*1 Only available to Ethernet models.

11.1 Standard I/F Standard I/F functions

Item Function overview Reference Communication setting

Standard I/F Assigning channel number and communication driver to communication interface

Page 435 Standard I/F

GOT IP Address*1 Configuring GOT Ethernet setting Page 451 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only)

Ethernet communication*1

Displaying the contents of Ethernet setting, changing the host Page 456 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

Comm.Monitor Checking the serial communication port communication Page 464 Communication Monitor

Ethernet check*1 Checking the Ethernet communication port communication Page 469 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only)

Transparent mode Setting the channel No. to be used for the communication for the FA transparent function

Page 471 Setting the Transparent Mode

Keyword Setting or deleting sequence program protection key words and canceling sequence program protection status for the FXCPU connection

Page 472 Keyword

Ethernet Printer Setting the IP address of the Ethernet printer Page 480 Ethernet Printer

Function Description Channel no. display Displays the channel number (CH No) that has been assigned by drawing software

Communication driver display Displays the communication driver that has been assigned by drawing software

Communication parameters display Displays the communication parameters of the controllers that has been assigned by drawing software

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 435

43

Standard I/F display operation

GT2107-W

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Main menu

Touch [Standard I/F].

Communication settings

Standard I/F

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Standard I/F].

Standard I/F

6 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu Communication settings

Standard I/F

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Standard I/F].

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 437

43

Display contents of standard I/F Described below are the display items on the standard I/F menu and their functions.

Display item

Driver display BOX

Drv button

Standard interface display BOX

Channel No. specification menu BOX

8 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

Standard interface display BOX The standard interface includes the following four types. Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485, RS-232 or RS-422): For communication with PLC, microcomputer and other equipment Standard I/F-2(RS-232): For communication with other equipment, bar code reader, RFID and transparent Standard I/F-3(USB): For communication with PC (drawing software) and transparent Standard I/F-4(Ethermet): For communication with PC (drawing software) and other equipment Available standard interfaces differ depending on the GOT model used. : Available, : Not available

For GT2107-WTBD, GT2107-WTSD

GOT Standard I/F-1 Standard I/F-2 Standard I/F-3 Standard I/F-4

RS-422/485 RS-232 RS-422 RS-232 USB Ethernet GT2107-WTBD GT2107-WTSD

GT2105-QTBDS GT2105-QMBDS

GT2104-RTBD

GT2104-PMBD

GT2104-PMBDS

GT2104-PMBDS2

GT2104-PMBLS

GT2103-PMBD

GT2103-PMBDS

GT2103-PMBDS2

GT2103-PMBLS

[GOT front] [GOT back]

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-4(Ethernet)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 439

44

For GT2105-QTBDS, GT2105-QMBDS

For GT2104-RTBD

For GT2104-PMBD

[GOT front] [GOT back]

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-4(Ethernet)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-4(Ethernet)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

0 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

For GT2104-PMBDS

For GT2104-PMBDS2

For GT2104-PMBLS

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-1(RS-232)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422)

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 441

44

For GT2103-PMBD

For GT2103-PMBDS

For GT2103-PMBDS2

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-4(Ethernet)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422/485)

Standard I/F-2(RS-232)

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-232)

2 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

For GT2103-PMBLS

Channel No. specification menu BOX Set a channel number to be used by the standard interface. Page 448 Channel setting operation For communication drivers that can be assigned for channels, refer to the following. Page 443 Driver display BOX

"9" is automatically set to the standard I/F-3(USB).

Driver display BOX The driver display box displays the names of communication drivers assigned to channels or the communication drivers set

in the communication settings of drawing software. For details on communication drivers to be displayed, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual "Disuse" is displayed in the driver display box in the following cases: The communication driver is not installed. Page 558 OS information "0" is set in the channel number specification menu box. The channel number of the standard I/F-3(USB) is fixed to "9".

[Drv] button Displays the driver setting screen. Select a communication driver to be used on the driver setting screen. Page 450 Driver setting operation The [Drv] button is displayed in the following case. When a channel number other than channel 0 or 9 is set to the standard I/F-1, standard I/F-2, and standard I/F-4

0: Set when the communication interface is not used.

1, 2: Set when connecting to a controller.

8: Set when connecting to a bar code reader, RFID or GOT (Extended Computer).

9:*1 Set when connecting to a PC (drawing software).

When multiple GOTs are connected, set this channel for the connection with the 2nd GOT.

Set this channel when the Ethernet download function is used.

A: Set this channel when connecting to a printer.

Standard I/F-3(USB)

Standard I/F-1(RS-422)

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 443

44

Precautions for communication between GOT and connected devices Installing [Communication driver] and downloading [Communication Settings] To perform communication with the connected device, the following actions are necessary. 1) Installing communication drivers (Up to 2 drivers) 2) Assigning channel numbers and communication drivers to communication interfaces 3) Downloading contents (project data) assigned in step 2) Perform 1), 2) and 3) with drawing software.

For details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual When the communication settings have not been downloaded If the communication settings have not been downloaded with drawing software, set the communication settings on the drawing software or in the GOT utility screen.

4 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

Detail information setting operation

For Standard I/F-1(RS422) and Standard I/F-2(RS232) 1. Touch each driver display box of the standard I/F-1 and standard I/F-2.

2. The screen jumps to the detailed information screen and the communication parameter will appear. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P and GT2103-P)

Touch the driver display BOX.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 445

44

3. Touch the numerical values of baud rate to switch them repeatedly.

The numerical values are set using the ten-key depending on the setting.

"0" to "9": Use these keys to enter numerical values. Enter "0" to disable the screen saver function. "ESC": Closes the ten-key window without saving any value entered "AC": Deletes the entire string of numerical characters that are being entered "DEL": Deletes a digit from a string of numerical characters that are being entered "ENT": Enters the value for the clock that has been entered and closes the ten-key pad window "+/-": Switches between positive and negative values. (Only positive values are valid for the clock setting.) ".": Invalid key (not used)

4. Touch the [] button to display the window confirming whether to save the settings.

5. Touch the [YES] button to save the settings and restart. Touch the [NO] button to discard the changes.

Communication parameters The communication parameter setting items depend on the type of communication driver installed on the GOT in use. For details on the setting of each communication driver, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Example: 4800 bps 9600 bps 19200 bps

6 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

For Standard I/F-4(Ethernet) 1. Touch the driver display box of a communication parameter to be set.

2. The screen is switched to the communication detail setting. Set the communication parameter on this screen. GOT IP address setting Page 451 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only)

3. When the [] button is touched, it returns to the previous screen.

4. Touch the [] button to display the window confirming whether to save the settings.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 447

44

5. Touch the [YES] button to save the settings and restart. Touch the [NO] button to discard the changes.

Communication parameter setting by drawing software Set the communication parameter for each communication driver by selecting [Common] [Controller Setting]. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Channel setting operation

Channel number setting operation 1. Touch the channel No. specification menu box to be set.

2. When the channel setting window appears, select the channel number.

Touch

Touch

8 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

3. When the channel number is selected, the settings are fixed and the window returns to the previous one. Therefore, touch the [] button.

4. Touch the [] button to display the window confirming whether to save the settings.

5. Touch the [YES] button to save the settings and restart. Touch the [NO] button to discard the changes.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F 449

45

Driver setting operation

Driver setting operation 1. Touch [Drv] button to bring up the driver setting window.

2. The available communication driver names are displayed on the driver setting screen. Select the communication driver to be used.

3. When the channel number is selected, the settings are fixed and the window returns to the previous one. Therefore, touch the [] button.

4. Touch the [] button to display the window confirming whether to save the settings.

5. Touch the [YES] button to save the settings and restart. Touch the [NO] button to discard the changes.

Touch Drv.

Touch

0 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.1 Standard I/F

11

11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) This section describes the GOT Ethernet setting. The GOT Ethernet setting can also be set with drawing software. For details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Standard The table below shows the communication setting items and setting range.

*1 Set the value "0.0.0.0" when not using the subnet mask pattern and default router IP address.

Display operation of GOT IP address

GT2107-W

Communication setting items Setting range Remark IP address 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254 If a value outside the setting range is entered, the error

message "SET NUMBER IS INCORRECT." appears.Subnet mask*1 192.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.252

Default gateway*1 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254

Per. S/W port No. 1024 to 5010, 5014 to 49152, 49171 to 65534 Set the port number for the GOT download.

Transparent port No. 1024 to 5010, 5014 to 49152, 49171 to 65534 Set the port number for the transparent of the GOT.

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [GOT IP Address].

GOT IP address

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) 451

45

GT2104-R

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [GOT IP Address].

Communication settings

GOT IP address

2 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only)

11

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Communication settings

Touch [GOT IP Address].

GOT IP address

GOT IP address

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) 453

45

Setting operation 1. Touch the numerical part of the octet to be changed among the 1st to 4th octets. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. When the numeric pad appears, enter a numerical value in up to three digits, and touch the [ENT] key.

If a numerical value outside the setting range is entered, the following error message appears. Enter a numerical value again.

For the details of the setting range, refer to the following. Page 683 Specifications

3. For GT2104-P, GT2103-P, touch the [Next]. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

Touch the numerical part of the octet to be changed.

Touch

4 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only)

11

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

4. If necessary, change the setting of [Per. S/W port No.] and [Transparent port No.].

5. After the setting change, touch the [] key.

6. When the screen shown below appears, touch the [YES] key.

Touch .

Touch YES.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.2 GOT IP Address Setting (Ethernet models only) 455

45

11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) Setting function for Ethernet communication The contents of the Ethernet set in GT Designer3 can be checked. The setting of the host station can be changed. For the Ethernet setting, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used

Display operation of Ethernet communication

GT2107-W

Touch [Comm. Setting].

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [Ethernet setting].

Channel Setting

Ethernet setting

Select a channel.

6 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

11

GT2104-R

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Setting].

Communication settings

Touch [Ethernet setting].

Channel Setting

Ethernet setting

Select a channel.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) 457

45

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Channel Setting

Ethernet setting

Comm. SettingMain menu

Touch [Comm. Setting].

Touch [Ethernet setting].

Select a channel.

8 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

11

Display contents of Ethernet setting The following describes the setting items and the display contents of the Ethernet setting.

How to cancel the change of the setting in the [Ethernet setting] screen. Cancel the settings changed in the [Ethernet setting] screen with the [Restore default settings] button. The changed settings remain until they are canceled with the [Restore default settings] button. The changed settings are not canceled even if writing the project data or system application to the GOT. When the project data is written to the GOT without canceling the changed settings, those changed settings are reflected to the Ethernet setting of the written project data. (If the written project data does not have a channel with same Ethernet settings as that of the channel changed in [Ethernet setting] screen, the changed settings are not reflected.)

No. Item Description Reference (1) Host Check or set a controller to be connected as a host.

Asterisk (*) is displayed with the selected Ethernet setting. Page 460 Change of host

(2) N/W Check or set the network No. of the controller. Page 461 Change of Net No.

(3) ST Check or set the station number of the controller. Page 462 Change of station No.

(4) Model Displays the product name of the controller. -

(5) IP Address Check or set the IP address of the controller. Page 463 Change of IP address

(6) Channel select tab Switches the channel for which the Ethernet setting is to be configured. -

(7) Scroll keys Scrolls the display up or down. -

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)(For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(6) (2) (3) (4) (5)

(1)

(5)

(6)

(1)

(3) (4)(2) (7)

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) 459

46

Change of host 1. Touch the device to be set as the host. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. After the setting change, touch the [] key. When the screen shown below appears, touch the [YES] key.

Touch YES.

0 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

11

Change of Net No. 1. Touch the Net No. to be changed, and input the network No. to be changed by the numeric keypad displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. After the setting change, touch the [] key. When the screen shown below appears, touch the [YES] key.

Touch YES.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) 461

46

Change of station No. 1. Touch the station No. to be changed, and input the station No. of the destination Ethernet module to be changed by the

numeric keypad displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. After the setting change, touch the [] key. When the screen shown below appears, touch the [YES] key.

Touch YES.

2 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only)

11

Change of IP address 1. Touch the IP address to be changed, input the destination IP address to be changed by the numeric keypad displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. After the setting change, touch the [] key. When the screen shown below appears, touch the [YES] key.

Touch YES.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.3 Ethernet Communication (Ethernet models only) 463

46

11.4 Communication Monitor Communication monitor functions

Communication monitor display operation

GT2107-W

Function Description Communication port-selection status display Indicates the connection status of Standard I/F-1, I/F-2, I/F-3 and I/F-4.

Communication status display Displays the communication status (SD: send, RD: receive).

Communication error status display Displays an error message when a communication error occurs.

Touch [Comm. Setting].

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Monitor].

Communication Monitor

4 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.4 Communication Monitor

11

GT2105-Q

GT2104-R

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Monitor].

Communication Monitor

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Monitor].

Communication Monitor

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.4 Communication Monitor 465

46

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Comm. Monitor].

Communication settings

Communication Monitor

6 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.4 Communication Monitor

11

Screen display content

1)Connection status of the communication ports Indicates the connection status of Standard I/F-1 and I/F-2. Listed in the table below are display items and the connection status (channel number).

2)Communication status Displays the communication status of each communication port. The SD and RD symbols appear in black on gray ( , ) while data are not being sent or received. While data are being sent or received, the SD and RD symbols appear as follows. GT2104-P, GT2103-P: in black on white ( , ). GT2105-QMBDS: in white on light gray ( , ). GT2107-W, GT2105-QTBDS, GT2104-R: in white on red ( , ). They may appear lit depending on the communication status. The SD and RD symbols on the screen indicate normal communication or cable disconnection. Setting example

[During normal communication] The SD and RD of the I/F-1 flash. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-QTBDS, GT2104-R)

(For GT2105-QMBDS)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Display item Channel number Remark PLC Ch1 "PLC" appears when connected to a controller (PLC or microcomputer).

BCR Ch8 "BCR" appears when connected to a barcode reader or RFID.

TRANS. Ch9 "TRANS." appears when the controller that is allocated to one of the communication ports supports the transparent mode. "TRANS." automatically changes to "PC" when communicating with the screen design software.

PC Ch9 "PC" appears when connected to a screen design software.

PRT ChA Appears when connected to a printer.

Port Channel number Controller type I/F-1 Ch1 MELSEC-FX

I/F-2 Ch8, Ch9 -

1) 3)

2)

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.4 Communication Monitor 467

46

[When the connecting cable with the controller is disconnected] Only the SD of the I/F-1 flashes. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-QTBDS, GT2104-R)

(For GT2105-QMBDS)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

3)Communication error status Communication error status of each port is displayed on this screen. The following table describes the communication status that each display item shows.

Error occurring in a station When the GOT monitors multiple controllers of a channel by switching between stations, the communication monitor function cannot detect errors occurring in the stations that are not being monitored. To check the errors occurring in these stations, use the following GOT resisters. Faulty Station Information (CH1): GS281 to GS288 Faulty Station Information (CH2): GS301 to GS308 Faulty Station Information (CH3): GS321 to GS328 Faulty Station Information (CH4): GS341 to GS348 For the details of the GOT special registers, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display item Status Action NO ERROR No error Communication is executed normally.

ERR Ovr. Overrun error The receive data is sent continuously with a short interval. Let the baud rate (communication speed) be equivalent between the GOT and counterpart equipment.

ERR Frm. Framing error The communication frames of GOT and PLC are inconsistent. Confirm the communication settings of GOT and PLC, such as data length, stop bit and baud rate.

ERR Prt. Parity error The parity check conditions of GOT and PLC are inconsistent. Let the parity check condition (odd or even) of GOT and PLC be consistent.

ERR Text Text error The sum data is inconsistent. Or the contents of the receive data are not consistent with the send command from the GOT. Let the communication settings and contents of data be consistent between the GOT and counterpart equipment. (If NAK is received while the GOT is connected to the microcomputer board, a text error occurs.)

TIME OUT Communication timeout Though receiving is started, receive data is not sent. Check the wiring between the GOT and its communication target. (When the GOT is connected to the microcomputer board, confirm the terminator, CR, wiring, etc.)

ERR Line Control line error The control line is not operating correctly. Confirm the wiring of the control line.

ERR Cmd. Command error A command contained in the receive data is not consistent with the send command from the GOT.

8 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.4 Communication Monitor

11

11.5 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only)

Ethernet check function The Ethernet status check function sends a ping to check the connection status of Ethernet.

Display operation of Ethernet check

*1 Refer to the following for display operation of main menu. Page 425 Utility Display

Ethernet Check

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Main menu*1 Communication settings

Communication settings

Touch [Ethernet check].

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.5 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only) 469

47

Operation of Ethernet status check 1. If the select button of [Destination IP] is touched, a keyboard is displayed. Enter the IP address of the other terminal with the keyboard.

2. If the [Send ping] button is touched, a ping is sent to the IP address entered in [Destination IP]. The timeout time is five seconds.

When the communication is completed The [Response received.] dialog box is displayed. When a communication error occurs The [Timeout occurred.] dialog box is displayed.

Touch

0 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.5 Ethernet Check (Ethernet models only)

11

11.6 Setting the Transparent Mode

Function of the transparent mode When using the multi-channel function, the channel No. of a controller to which the FA transparent function is executed can be set. For details on the multi-channel and FA transparent functions, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Electric Product) For GT Works3 Version1

Display operation of the transparent mode setting

*1 Refer to the following for display operation of main menu. Page 425 Utility Display

Transparent mode setting operation 1. When the transparent ChNo. (numerical part) below is touched, the screen for selecting a communication driver is

displayed. Select the channel to execute the FA transparent function.

2. Touching the [] button restarts the GOT when the settings have been changed.

Function Description Setting range ChNo. The channel No. of a controller to which the FA transparent function is executed can be set. 1/2

(Default: 1)

Communication settingsTransparent mode setting

Main menu*1 Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Transparent mode].

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.6 Setting the Transparent Mode 471

47

11.7 Keyword Keyword functions The operation related to a keyword of the FX series PLC can be performed.

Keyword display operation

Function Description Regist Keyword is registered.

Delete Registered keyword is deleted.

Clear Keyword protection is cleared.

Protect A keyword with cleared protection is reactivated for protection.

Main menu Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Communication settings

Channel settingKeyword

Touch [Keyword].

Communication settings

2 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword

11

Regist Keyword is registered.

1. Touch "Regist" to display the selection screen for the registration. For the FX series PLC, which is not compatible with Customer Keyword, the keyword entry screen of [Step3] is displayed. Start the operation from [Step3]. For the Customer Keyword compatible models, refer to the manual of the PLC to be used.

2. Select [Keyword] or [Keyword+Custom]. To register only Keyword and 2nd keyword, touch [Keyword]. To register Customer Keyword, touch [Keyword+Custom].

3. Input a keyword. Touch the display part of the keyword to be registered.

4. The keyboard for entering a keyword is displayed. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [A-F] or [0-9] button. Enter a keyword and touch the [ENT] key.

For the keyword, 8 digits from 0 to 9 or A to F must be set.

5. After completing the keyword entry, touch [Next]. When [Keyword+Custom] is selected on the selection screen for the registration, the Customer Keyword entry screen is displayed. Enter it in the same way as for Keyword and 2nd keyword.

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword 473

47

6. Set Registration conciliation. Touch Registration conciliation to change the setting contents.

7. After setting Registration conciliation, touch the [Execute] key. The registration of the keyword is completed.

8. The registration of the keyword is completed. Touch [OK].

All Protect Write Protect Read/Write Protect

Touch

Touch

Touch

4 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword

11

Selection availability of Registration conciliation The following table lists the PLCs that can select Registration conciliation.

*1 Refer to the manual for the PLC in use for the models that are compatible with the 2nd keyword. *2 Registration options can be selected among "R/W Protect", "Write Protect", or "All online operation protection". For access restrictions of

each setting, refer to the manual of the PLC to be used.

Selection of keyword protection level For the devices which can perform the online operation of FX PLC, 3 levels of protection can be set. When the monitoring or setting change by online devices is needed, set the keyword taking the following into consideration.

When only keyword is registered Protection level is selected by the head character of keyword. All Protect: Set the keyword starting with one of A, D to F, or 0 to 9. Read/incorrect write protection: Set the keyword starting with B. Erroneous write prohibition: Set the keyword starting with C.

When keyword and 2nd keyword are registered

Applicability of monitoring for each keyword protection level The applicability of monitoring for each protection level is as follows.

*1 When the T, C set values are specified indirectly, changing devices is available.

Difference between "All online operation protection" and "All Protect" When "All online operation protection" is selected, both device display and input by the programming tool or GOT are prohibited. When "All Protect" is selected, device display and input are possible although operations by the programming tool are all prohibited.

Target PLC Setting

When keyword and 2nd keyword are registered When only keyword is registered FX PLC compatible with 2nd keyword*1 Registration options can be selected.*2 Registration options*2 cannot be selected.

FX PLC not compatible with 2nd keyword*1 -

Item When only keyword is registered When keyword and 2nd keyword are registered

Keyword unregistered /protection canceled

All protection

Erroneous write/read protection

Erroneous write protection

All online operation protection

Read/Write Protection

Write Protection

Device monitoring

Device change

T, C setting values and file register (from D1000)

*1 *1 *1

Other than the above

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword 475

47

Delete Registered keyword is deleted.

1. Touch [Delete] to display the keyword entry screen.

2. Input a keyword. Touch the display part of the registered keyword.

3. The keyboard for entering a keyword is displayed. Enter a keyword and touch the [ENT] key. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [A-F] or [0-9] button.

4. After completing the keyword entry, touch [Next].

5. Touch the [Execute] key.

Target PLC Setting FX PLC compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to be deleted.

FX PLC not compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to be deleted only into "keyword". "2nd keyword" is ignored.

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

6 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword

11

6. The keyword is deleted. Touch [OK].

Touch

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword 477

47

Clear To access an FX PLC where a keyword has been registered, keyword protection is cancelled.

1. Touch [Clear] to display the keyword entry screen.

2. Input a keyword. Touch the display part of the registered keyword.

3. The keyboard for entering a keyword is displayed. Enter a keyword and touch the [ENT] key. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [A-F] or [0-9] button.

4. After completing the keyword entry, touch [Next].

5. Touch the [Execute] key.

Target PLC Setting FX PLC compatible with customer keyword Input a keyword or customer keyword to clear the protection.

FX PLC compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword to clear the protection.

FX PLC not compatible with 2nd keyword Input a keyword into "keyword" to clear the protection. "2nd keyword" is ignored.

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

8 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword

11

6. The protection is cleared. Touch [OK].

Protect A keyword with cleared protection is reactivated for protection. Keyword protection function is valid when the 2nd keyword is registered.

1. Touch [Protect] to switch to the keyword protection status.

2. The keyword is protected. Touch [OK].

Touch

Touch

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.7 Keyword 479

48

11.8 Ethernet Printer Ethernet printer setting Set the IP address of an Ethernet printer.

Display operation of the Ethernet printer

GT2107-W

Item Description Setting range IP address Set the IP address of the Ethernet printer to be connected. 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Ethernet printer].

Communication settings

Ethernet printer

0 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.8 Ethernet Printer

11

GT2104-R

Main menu

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Communication settings

Communication settings

Touch [Ethernet printer].

Ethernet printer

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.8 Ethernet Printer 481

48

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu Communication settings

Communication settings

Communication settings

Touch [Comm. Settings].

Touch [Ethernet printer].

Ethernet printer

2 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.8 Ethernet Printer

11

Procedure for setting an Ethernet printer 1. Touch the input area of [IP Address] to display a keyboard. Input values with the keyboard. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. Touch the [] button on the [Ethernet printer] screen to display the dialog shown below. (If no setting is changed, the dialog is not displayed.) Operate following the message of the dialog box.

11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.8 Ethernet Printer 483

48

MEMO

4 11 COMMUNICATION INTERFACE SETTING 11.8 Ethernet Printer

12

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS Page 486 Display Settings Page 492 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) Page 502 Inherent Information Page 503 USB Host Page 506 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration Page 508 GOT Internal Device Monitor Page 510 VNC Server Function Page 512 License Management Page 514 IP filter setting You can display the setting screens related to the display, operation, and others from the utility screen. In the setting screen for display and the setting screen for operation, the following settings can be set.

*1 Only available to Ethernet interface equipped models.

Item Description Reference Display settings Setting the startup screen display time and screen saving time Page 486 Display functions

Brightness

Turning on/off the POWER LED (GT2105-Q only)

Operation Setting buzzer volume, window move buzzer, and key reaction Page 495 Setting operation of operation

Touch panel calibration Page 497 Position correction of the touch panel (touch panel calibration setting)

Utility call key Page 497 Position correction of the touch panel (touch panel calibration setting)

IP filter setting*1 IP filter usage, specification of filtering method, and specifications of target IP address and exception IP address

Page 515 Setting procedure for the IP filter

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 485

48

12.1 Display Settings Display functions Setting regarding display is possible. The items which can be set are described below. If touch the each item part, the respective setting becomes possible.

Display setting by GT Designer3 Set title display period, screen save time and screen save backlight by selecting [Common] [GOT Environmental Setting] [GOT Setup...] on GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Screen save time By using the system information function, the screen save function can forcibly enabled from a controller (Forced Screen Saver Disable Signal) or the screen saving time set in the utility can be disabled (Automatic Screen Saver Disable Signal). GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Item Description Setting range Opening time The title display period at the main unit boot can be set. 0 to 60 seconds

(At factory shipment: 1 seconds)

Screen save time The period from the user stops the touch panel operation till the screen save function starts can be set.

0 to 60 minutes (At factory shipment: 0 minute)

Brightness Brightness can be adjusted. Page 490 Brightness

-

6 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings

12

Display operation of display setting

GT2107-W

GT2105-Q

Main menu

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [Display].

GOT setup

Display settings

Main menu

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [Display].

GOT setup

Display settings

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings 487

48

GT2104-R

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu

Touch [GOT Setup].

GOT setup

Touch [Display].

Display settings

Main menu

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [Display].

GOT setup

Display settings

8 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings

12

Display setting operations

The title display period and screen saving time 1. If the setting items (numbers) are touched, a keyboard is displayed. Input numeric with the keyboard. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2105-Q)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. Set the title display period with the ten-key pad window and touch "ENT".

Touch

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings 489

49

Brightness 1. Touch [Brightness] to bring up the Brightness setting window. (For GT2107-W, GT2104-R)

(For GT2105-Q)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. The Brightness setting window is displayed. Touch an item to be set. (a) Test Color (GT2104-P, GT2103-P only) Touch this item to change the backlight color, [White], [Green], [Red], [Pink], or [Orange], that is used for a color test. (b) Brightness Mode Touch this item to switch [Normal] or [Low Brightness]. (c) Brightness Touch the [+] and [-] keys to adjust the brightness of the screen. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

0 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings

12

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

3. Touch the [] button to reflect the setting. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

POWER LED (GT2105 only) 1. Touch a setting item to change the setting.

POWER LED:

2. Touch the [] button to save the changes.

Touch

Touch

OFFON

Touch

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.1 Display Settings 491

49

12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) Operation setting functions Setting regarding GOT operation can be set. The items which can be set are described below. If touch the each item part, the respective setting becomes possible.

*1 The more the value set for [Key reaction] is high, the more the key reaction speed slows.

For example, when the GOT recognizes touching the GOT screen once as touching the screen twice, set a higher value for [Key reaction].

Operation setting by GT Designer3 Set buzzer volume and window move buzzer volume by selecting [Common] [GOT Environmental Setting] [GOT Setup...] of GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Setting range Buzzer volume Buzzer volume setting can be changed. OFF/SHORT/LONG

(At factory shipment: SHORT)

Window move buzzer Whether turn ON/OFF buzzer when move window can be selected. ON/OFF (At factory shipment: ON)

Key reaction The touch panel sensitivity when touching the GOT screen can be set. (For preventing chattering)

0 to +120*1

Calibration Calibrates the touch panel sensitivity. Page 497 Position correction of the touch panel (touch panel calibration setting)

-

Utility call Utility call key setting screen can be displayed. Page 499 Setting the utility call keys

-

"Key reaction" [ms] Standard (0) +10 +20 +40 +80 +120

2 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

12

Display operation of operation setting

GT2107-W

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

Touch [GOT Setup].

Main menu GOT setup

Touch [Operation].

Operation settings

Touch [GOT Setup].

Main menu GOT setup

Touch [Operation].

Operation settings

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) 493

49

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Main menu

Touch [GOT Setup].

GOT setup

Touch [Operation].

Operation settingsOperation settings

4 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

12

Setting operation of operation

Buzzer volume 1. Touch a setting item to change the setting. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

(Buzzer sound: )

2. Touch the [] button to save the changes.

Window move buzzer 1. Touch a setting item to change the setting. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

(Window move buzzer: )

2. Touch the [] button to save the changes.

SHORT LONG OFF

ON OFF

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) 495

49

Key reaction setting 1. If touching the setup item, the setup contents*1 are changed. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. After changing the setting, touch the [] button. The setting is saved and the setting screen is closed. *1 The more the value set for [Key reaction] is high, the more the key reaction speed slows.

For example, when the GOT recognizes touching the GOT screen once as touching the screen twice, set a higher value for [Key reaction].

"Key reaction" [ms] Standard (0) +10 +20 +40 +80 +120

6 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

12

Position correction of the touch panel (touch panel calibration setting)

Touch panel calibration setting function Touch panel reading error can be corrected. Normally the adjustment is not required, however, the difference between a touched position and the object position may occur as the period of use elapses. When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, correct the position with this function.

Touch panel calibration setting display operation For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

For GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Run Stop Run Stop

The [Run] will operate though you intended to touch the [Stop] button.

The [Stop] button can be touched without fail.

After adjustmentBefore adjustment

Operation settings

Touch panel calibration

Touch [Calibration].

Operation settings Operation settings

Touch [Calibration].

Touch panel calibration

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) 497

49

Touch panel calibration operation Touch [+] displayed on the screen with the finger one by one to make the setting.

1. Touch the center of [+] displayed on the upper left precisely.

2. Touch [+] displayed on the lower left.

3. Touch [+] displayed on the upper right.

4. Touch [+] displayed on the lower right.

5. Step 4 completes the calibration process, and the [Operation] window will reappear.

Touch panel calibration error If touch panel calibration results in inoperability of the panel, the following message will appear.

[YES] button: Returns to the touch panel calibration screen. [NO] button: Aborts calibration without saving any changes to the touch panel setting.

8 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

12

Setting the utility call keys

Utility call key setting function The key position for calling the main menu of the utility can be specified. For the key position, the specification of 1 point from 4 corners on the screen, or no specification (0 point), can be set. By keeping pressing the screen, a setting to switch the screen to the utility is available. This prevents a switching to the utility by an unintentional operation.

Operation setting by GT Designer3 Set the utility call key by selecting [Common] [GOT Environmental Setting] [GOT Setup...] from GT Designer3. When change a part of the setting, change the setting by the GOT display setting after downloading the project data. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Utility call key display operation (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Operation Utility call key

Touch the button to be set as a utility call key.

Touch [Utility call].

Operation Operation

Touch [Utility call].

Touch the button to be set as a utility call key.

Utility call key

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) 499

50

Utility call key setting operation 1. Touch or displayed at the four corners of the setting screen. The button repeats every time it is

pressed. Change the part to be set as a key position to . For the key position, 0 or 1 point can be specified. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. When setting 1 point, specify the time to switch to the utility in case of keeping pressing the key position. Touch the time input area. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

3. Touching the input area displays a keyboard. Input numeric with the keyboard.

4. Touch the [] button to save the changes.

0 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation)

12

When the utility call key is not set (set to 0-point) Even when the utility call key is not set (set to the zero point), you can display the main menu by performing the following operation. Pressing the special function switch set on the user-created screen Page 427 Display operation of main menu When limiting the display and operation of the utility When limiting the display and operating users, set a password to the GOT using GT Designer3. If a user tries to display the main menu of the utility, the password is displayed. Refer to the following for the details related to the password setting. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.2 Operation Settings (Settings for Operation) 501

50

12.3 Inherent Information Setting function for inherent information Configure inherent information settings.

Display operation of inherent information

Setting operation for inherent information 1. If touching the setting items, keyboard is displayed. Input numeric with the keyboard.

2. If touching the [] button, the GOT restarts and operates with the changed settings.

Item Description Setting range GOT ID No. Set the ID No. as the inherent information for the GOT. 0 to 32767

Main menu GOT setup

Inherent information

Touch [Unique info.].Touch

[GOT Setup].

2 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.3 Inherent Information

12

12.4 USB Host Only available to GT2107-W.

USB host setting To install and use the USB mouse/keyboard on the GOT, set the USB mouse/keyboard.

Display operation of the USB host setting

Item Description Setting range Use USB mouse Set whether to use a USB mouse. YES/NO

Interlock with mouse cursor touch operation The mouse cursor can be moved to the touched position. YES/NO

Use USB keyboard/barcode Set whether to use a USB keyboard/barcode. Use/Disuse

USB keyboard type Set the USB keyboard type. Japanese 106 keyboard/English 101 keyboard

Main menu GOT setup

USB host

Touch [USB host].

Touch [GOT setup].

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.4 USB Host 503

50

Setting operation of USB host 1. To use a USB mouse, touch the current selection of [USB mouse]. The setting content is changed by touching.

2. To move the mouse cursor to a touched position, touch the current selection of [Interlock with mouse]. The setting content is changed by touching.

3. To use a USB keyboard or a USB barcode reader, touch the current selection of [USB keyboard/barcode]. The setting content is changed by touching.

1.

2.

3.

4 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.4 USB Host

12

4. To use the USB keyboard, touch the setting item of [USB keyboard type]. The setting content is changed by touching.

5. Touch the [] button to apply the new setting and close the setting screen.

4.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.4 USB Host 505

50

12.5 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration

Backup/restoration setting Only available to GT2107-W. The save destination for backup setting and backup data is settable. For how to use the backup/restoration, refer to the following. Page 614 Backup and Restoration Set the following items with touching the items on the GOT.

Display operation for setting the storage location for backup and restoration

Item Description Setting range Drive for backup setting The drive for storing backup settings, including parameters and passwords for

controllers, can be selected. A: SD card E: USB Drive X: Drive

Drive for backup data The drive for storing backup data can be selected. A: SD card E: USB Drive X: Drive

Main menu GOT setup

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [Backup/restore].

Backup/Restoration

6 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.5 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration

12

Backup/restoration setting operation

Drive for backup setting, drive for backup data 1. If touch the setup item, the setup contents are changed.

2. Touch the [] button to apply the new setting and close the setting screen.

1.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.5 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration 507

50

12.6 GOT Internal Device Monitor Setting the GOT internal device monitor Set whether to Use/Disuse the GOT internal device monitor of GOT diagnostics. The following explanation uses GT2104-R as an example.

GOT internal device monitor display operation

Item Description Setting range GOT dev. monitor Set whether to Use/Disuse the GOT internal device monitor of GOT

diagnostics. Disuse/Use

GOT device change Set whether to Allow/Forbid the GOT internal devices to be changed. Forbid/Allow

Main menu GOT setup

GOT dev. monitor (When using [GOT dev. monitor])

GOT dev. monitor (When not using [GOT dev. monitor])

Touch [GOT dev. monitor].

Touch [GOT Setup].

8 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.6 GOT Internal Device Monitor

12

GOT internal device monitor setting operation 1. When using the GOT internal device monitor of GOT diagnostics, touch the setting item and set [Use].

2. When allowing the GOT internal devices to be changed, touch the setting item of [GOT device change] and set [Allow].

3. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.6 GOT Internal Device Monitor 509

51

12.7 VNC Server Function Only available to GT2107-W.

VNC server function setting In the VNC server function setting, the authorization guarantee time for the VNC server function can be set. For the details of the VNC server function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Authorization guarantee time cancel signal (GS1792.b8) When the Authorization guarantee time cancel signal (GS1792.b8) turns on, the authorization guarantee time setting is disabled. Relationship with the GOT network interaction function setting The VNC server function setting is independent of the GOT network interaction function setting. Both of the settings are enabled.

Display operation of the VNC server function setting

Item Description Setting range Operating priority guaranteed time

The time that the authorized equipment holds the authorization after you operate the authorized equipment can be set. (The unauthorized equipment cannot obtain the authorization until the set time elapses.)

0 to 3600 seconds

Main menu GOT setup

VNC server

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [VNC server].

0 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.7 VNC Server Function

12

VNC server function setting operation

Operating priority guaranteed time 1. Touch the input field for [Ope. guaranteed time] to display a keyboard. Input the authorization guarantee time with the keyboard.

2. Touch the [] button to apply the new setting and close the setting screen.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.7 VNC Server Function 511

51

12.8 License Management Only available to GT2107-W.

License management setting To use functions which require a license, register the license to the GOT. To delete the license registered to the GOT, perform the operation also on the license management screen.

You can register or delete licenses for the VNC server function. For details on the VNC server function, refer to the following. Page 510 VNC Server Function

Display operation of the license management setting

Item Description Setting range VNC server function Register or delete the license for the VNC server function. -

Main menu GOT setup

License manager

Touch [GOT Setup].

Touch [License manager].

2 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.8 License Management

12

Setting operation of license management

When registering a license number for the GOT 1. Touch the license number input area on the license management screen, and then the keyboard appears on the bottom

of the screen.

2. Touch the [Regist] button to register the input license number. If the [] button is touched without touching the [Regist] button, the license number is not registered.

3. After a license number is registered, touch the [] button to close the license management screen.

When unregistering a license number for the GOT 1. Touch the [Cancel reg.] button to release the registered license number.

2. Touch the [] button to close the license management screen.

How to obtain a license number For how to obtain a license number, consult your local sales office.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.8 License Management 513

51

12.9 IP filter setting IP filter setting IP addresses from which access to the GOT is allowed or blocked can be set. Not available to GT2105-Q. For the details of the IP filter setting, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

*1 Leave the boxes blank if you do not set any IP addresses.

Display operation of the IP filter setting

Item Description Setting range IP filter usage You can set whether to use or not the IP filter function. Yes/No

Transmit/Block You can set whether to allow or block access from the IP addresses specified in [IP address setting]. If [Transmit] is selected

Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Target IP address] is blocked. Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Exception IP address] is disallowed. If [Block] is selected

Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Target IP address] is blocked. Access from the IP addresses that are set for [Exception IP address] is allowed.

Transmit/Block

IP address setting Range You can set whether to register IP addresses by specifying a range. To specify a range, set the start IP address and the end IP address for [Target IP address].

Selected/Not selected

Target IP address You can set IP addresses or IP address ranges to be filtered. Up to 4 ranges can be set.

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255*1

Exception IP address

This item can be set only when [Range] is selected. For an IP address range specified in [Target IP address], set IP addresses excluded from being filtered. Up to 16 addresses can be set for one range specified in [Target IP address].

0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255*1

Touch [IP filter setting].

GOT setup

IP filter setting

4 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting

12

Setting procedure for the IP filter

Setting the IP filter 1. Select [Yes] for [IP filter usage] by touching the current selection.

2. Select [Transmit] or [Block] for [Transmit/Block] by touching the current selection.

3. Touch the [Setting] button of [IP address setting] to display the [IP address setting] screen.

Refer to the following, and set an IP address. Page 516 Adding a target IP address Page 517 Deleting a target IP address Page 518 Specifying IP address ranges Page 519 Setting exception IP addresses

4. After configuring the settings, touch the [] button to display the [IP filter setting] screen.

5. Touch the [] button to display the following screen.

6. Touch the [YES] button to restart the GOT and reflect the setting. To cancel the new settings, touch the [NO] button to return to the [GOT setup] screen.

1.

2.

3.

1.4

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting 515

51

Adding a target IP address 1. Touch a target row to select it.

2. Touch the same row again to display the following screen.

3. Touch a number to display a software keyboard. Input an IP address to be added.

4. Touch the [] button to display the previous screen.

1.

1.3

1.4

6 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting

12

Deleting a target IP address 1. Touch a target row to select it.

2. Touch the [Del] button to display the following screen.

3. Touch the [YES] button to delete the selected IP address. To cancel the deletion and return to the previous screen, touch the [NO] button.

1.

2.

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting 517

51

Specifying IP address ranges 1. Touch a checkbox in [Range] to select the row.

2. Touch the same row again to display the screen shown below.

3. Touch a number to display a software keyboard. Input the start IP address and end IP address of the range to be filtered.

4. Touch the [] button to display the previous screen.

1. 1.2

1.3

1.3

1.4

8 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting

12

Setting exception IP addresses [Exception IP address] can be set only when [Range] is selected.

1. Select a target row, and touch the [Setting] button.

2. Touch a target row to select it.

3. Touch the same row again to display the screen shown below.

4. Touch a number to display a software keyboard. Input an exception IP address.

5. After completing the entry, touch the [] button.

6. On the displayed screen, touch the [] button to display the previous screen.

1.

1.2

1.4

1.5

1.6

12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting 519

52

MEMO

0 12 DISPLAY AND OPERATION SETTINGS 12.9 IP filter setting

13

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS Page 521 Security Level Authentication Page 523 Operator Authentication Page 536 Login/Logout

13.1 Security Level Authentication

Security level change functions Changes the security level to the same security level set by each object or screen switch. To change the security level, enter the password for the security level set with GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Restrictions on screen display The security level change screen cannot be displayed when project data do not exist in GOT. Change the security level after downloading the project data to GOT.

Display operation of security level change

Touch [Level Change].

Main menu Security setting

Security level authenticationChanging the security level

Touch [Security level].

Touch [Security setting].

Enter the password for the security level set with the drawing software.

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.1 Security Level Authentication 521

52

Security level change operation Input operation of password 1. By touching [0] to [9], [A] to [F] key, the password of the changed security level is input. Character types to be input can

be changed by touching the [KEY] button.

2. When correcting the input character, touch [Del] key to delete the correcting character and input the password again.

3. After inputting password, touch the [Enter] key. When the password is not matched, displays the error message.

4. If [OK] button is touched it returns to the password input screen again.

5. If the [] button is touched, it returns to the security setting screen.

About forgetting to return to the original level after changing security level temporarily When use GOT after temporarily changing the security level, do not forget to return the security level to the original level.

2 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.1 Security Level Authentication

13

13.2 Operator Authentication Operator information management

Operator management Operator management function The function enables displaying a list of the operator information and adding, changing, or deleting the operator information to be used. A password for operator authentication can be changed when the password is out of date. Functions for the operator authentication (automatic logout time, authentication method, password expiration date, etc.) can be set. For details on the operator authentication function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of operator management

*1 Refer to the following for display operation of main menu. Page 425 Utility Display

Function Description Reference page Operator management Enables adding, editing, deleting, importing, and exporting the operator information. Page 523 Operator

management function Page 526 Operator management operation

Add Add operator information to the GOT. Page 527 Add operation

Edit Edit the operator information stored in the GOT. Page 529 Edit operation

Delete Delete the operator information stored in the GOT. Page 530 Deletion operation

Import Import the operator information that is already exported to an SD card to the GOT. Page 530 Import operation

Export Export the operator information stored in the GOT to an SD card. Page 531 Export operation

Password change Enables changing passwords to be used for login and logout in/out of the GOT. Page 532 Password change

Function setting Enables setting the automatic logout time and password expiration date. Page 534 Function setting

Operator management

Main menu*1 Security setting

Security level authentication

Touch [Operator info.].

Touch [Security setting].

Touch [Operator].

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 523

52

Display example of operator management Operator information management screen

No. Item Description (a) Operator Name Displays operator names.

(b) ID Displays operator IDs.

(c) Lv Displays security levels for operators.

(d) Update Displays the last updated dates of the operator information.

(e) Operation keys Execution keys for each function

(a)

(e)

(b) (c) (d)

4 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Operator information edit screen Touch the [Add] button or touch the [Edit] button with the operator information selected on the Operator information management screen, and then the Operator information edit screen is displayed. The operator information can be edited.

No. Item Description (a) Operator Name The operator name to be edited is displayed or input an operator name to be added. (Up to 16 alphanumeric

characters)

(b) Operator ID The operator ID to be edited is displayed or input an operator name to be added. (Setting range: 1 to 32766, Maximum number of registrations: 255)

(c) Level Displays the security level for the operator or input the security level for an operator to be added. (0 to 15)

(d) Password Input a password. (Up to 16 alphanumeric characters)

(e) Expiration Switches the setting of the item disabled and enabled.

(f) External auth Switches whether to use or not to use the external authentication.

(g) Ext.auth. ID Displays the external authentication ID in hexadecimal or input an external authentication ID in hexadecimal. The setting range is 4 to 32 alphanumeric characters from A to F and 0 to 9.

(h) Save Saves the setting.

(a)

(b)

(c)

(d)

(e)

(f)

(g)

(h)

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 525

52

Operator management operation 1. Touch [Operator] [Operator info.].

2. The Admin password authentication screen is displayed, and then input the administrator password.

Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button.

When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

3. When the administrator password is correctly input, the Operator information management screen is displayed.

For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. [Add] Page 527 Add operation [Edit] Page 529 Edit operation [Delete] Page 530 Deletion operation [Import] Page 530 Import operation [Export] Page 531 Export operation

4. Touching the [] button displayed on the upper right returns to the previous screen.

6 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Add operation Add operator information to the GOT.

1. Touch the [Add] button.

2. The Operator information edit screen is displayed. Touch the [Next] switch to display an item to be edited, and touch the item.

1)Operator Name If the operator name is touched, a keyboard is displayed. Input an operator name with the keyboard.

Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button. When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key. 2)Operator ID If the operator ID is touched, a keyboard is displayed. Input an operator ID. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button. When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key. 3)Level If the level is touched, a keyboard is displayed. Input an operator level. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button. When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key. When the level of the logged-in operator is changed during editing of the operator information, a new level is not reflected until you log out of the GOT once and log in the GOT again.

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 527

52

4)Password For changing passwords during editing, touch the password. A keyboard is displayed, and then input a password. When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key. When the password input is completed, the New password input confirmation dialog box is displayed. Input the same password.

5)Expration For switching the setting of [Make a permanent password], touch the [Expration] dialog box to switch the setting. [Terminable] [Permanent]

6)External auth To use the external authentication, touch the [External auth] dialog box to switch the setting. [Use] [Disuse]

7)Ext. auth. ID Touch the external authentication ID dialog box to display the ten-key pad for inputting hexadecimal numbers, and input an external authentication ID. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. When the authentication method is set to the external authentication, an external authentication ID can also be input using an external authentication device.

3. When the [Save] button is touched after all items are input, the input operator information is saved. Touching the [] button displayed on the upper right returns to the previous screen.

8 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Saving the setting When the [] button is touched before the [Save] button is touched, the setting contents are not saved and the screen returns to the previous one. To save the setting contents, always touch the [Save] button.

Edit operation Edit the operator information stored in the GOT.

1. Select the operator information to be edited with touching the operator information.

2. Touch the [Edit] button.

3. The Operator information edit screen is displayed. Touch the [Next] switch to display an item to be edited, and touch the item.

(a) Level (b) Password (c) Expiration (f) External auth (g) Ext.auth. ID For how to edit operator information, refer to the following. Page 527 Operator information management

4. When the [Save] button is touched after all items are input, the input operator information is saved. Touching the [] button displayed on the upper right returns to the previous screen.

Saving the setting When the [] button is touched before the [Save] button is touched, the setting contents are not saved and the screen returns to the previous one. To save the setting contents, always touch the [Save] button.

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 529

53

Deletion operation Delete the operator information stored in the GOT.

1. Select the operator information to be deleted with touching the operator information.

2. Touching the [Delete] button deletes the selected operator information. Touching the [] button displayed on the upper right returns to the previous screen.

When GS621.b0 is ON, deletion of operator accounts is prohibited. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Import operation Import the operator information that is already exported to an SD card to the GOT.

1. Touch the [Import] button.

2. The dialog box shown below is displayed.

When the [YES] button is touched, the Admin password authentication screen is displayed. Input the administrator password. Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key.

3. When the administrator password is correctly input, the dialog box shown below is displayed and the operator information stored in an SD card is imported to the GOT.

When GS621.b2 is ON, the [Import] button is inactivated. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

0 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Export operation Export the operator information stored in the GOT to an SD card.

1. Touch the [Export] button.

2. The dialog box shown below is displayed.

3. Touch the following buttons according to the output format for the file. Binary file: [BIN] button CSV file: [CSV] button

4. The dialog box shown below is displayed. Touch the [YES] button to export the information.

5. The dialog box shown below is displayed and the operator information stored in the GOT is exported to an SD card. (file name: AUTHINF.G2U)

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 531

53

Password change

Password change function The passwords to be used for the operator authentication can be changed. For the password change, log into the GOT in advance with the operator name corresponding to the password to be changed.

Display operation of password change

*1 Refer to the following for display operation of main menu. Page 425 Utility Display

Password change

Main menu*1 Security setting

Operator authentication

Touch [Security setting].

Touch [Operator].

Touch [Password change].

2 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Password change operation 1. Touch [Security setting] [Login/Logout] to log into the GOT with the operator ID whose password is to be changed.

2. Touch [Password change] in the operator setting menu, and then the Password change dialog box is displayed.

3. Input the current password on the Password change dialog box.

Character types to be input can be changed by touching the [KEY] button.

When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key.

4. Input a new password.

5. After inputting a new password, input the new password again.

6. When the new password is correctly input, the dialog box shown below is displayed and the password is changed.

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 533

53

Function setting

Function setting function The functions for the operator information can be set. The following items can be set.

Display operation of function setting

*1 Refer to the following for display operation of main menu. Page 425 Utility Display

Item Description Reference page Auth method The authentication method is switched.

[Password], [Ext. auth. ], [Ext. auth. / Password] Auth method

Auto logout time The time from when the last time the GOT is operated until when you automatically log out of the GOT can be set. (1 to 60 minutes, 0 is invalid.)

Auto logout time

Expiration date Set the item for regularly changing the password to be used for the operator authentication. (1 to 1000 days, 0 is invalid.) When the password is out of date after setting the password, the GOT requests the password change.

Expiration date

Ext. auth. ID Initial position

The starting position of an external authentication ID (Number of bytes) can be set from the data read from an external authentication device. (0 to 1998 bytes)

Ext. auth. ID Initial position

Ext. auth. ID Valid byte count

The valid number of bytes for an external authentication ID can be set. (2 to 16 bytes) Ext. auth. ID Valid byte count

Function setting

Main menu*1 Security setting

Operator authentication

Touch [Security setting].

Touch [Operator].

Touch [Function].

4 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication

13

Function setting operation 1. Touch [Operator] [Function], and then the Admin password authentication dialog box is displayed.

2. When the administrator password is correctly input, the Function setting screen in displayed. Touch the [Next] switch to switch the setting screen, and touch an item to be set.

1)Auth method The authentication method is switched. Touching the authentication method switches the selected item in order of [Password] [Ext. auth. ] [Ext. auth. / Password].

2)Auto logout time Touch [Automatic logout time] to display the ten-key pad. Input a setting time. When the input is completed, touch the [ENT] key. 3)Expiration date Touch Expiration date to display the ten-key pad. Input a setting time. When the input is completed, touch the [Enter] key. 4)Ext. auth. ID Initial position The starting position of an external authentication ID (Number of bytes) can be set from the data read from an external authentication device.

5)Ext. auth. ID Valid byte count The valid number of bytes for an external authentication ID can be set. (This setting is available only when [External auth] or [Ext. auth. / Password] is set as the authentication method.)

3. Touching the [] button displayed on the upper right saves the setting contents and returns to the previous screen.

13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.2 Operator Authentication 535

53

13.3 Login/Logout To manage the operator or change the password, log into the GOT.

Display operation of login/logout

Operation of login/logout Login 1. Log into the GOT by inputting an operator name and its password. An external authentication device can be used for logging in.

Logout 1. Touch [Security setting] [Login/Logout], and then the screen shown below is displayed. Touch the [YES] button.

Main menu Security setting

Login

Touch [Security setting].

Touch [Login/Logout].

6 13 SECURITY LEVEL AND OPERATOR SETTINGS 13.3 Login/Logout

14

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY

Page 537 Time Setting and Display The clock data (date and time) are displayed and set in the clock setting menu.

14.1 Time Setting and Display Time setting and display functions Time settings and displaying of the status of GOT built-in battery are possible.

*1 GT2103-P cannot be specified.

Changing times When the time is changed on the Time setting & display screen, the changed time is written in a programmable controller even though [Adjust] or [Broadcast] is set for [Time setting]. As a result, the time of the programmable controller can be changed on the GOT even though [Adjust] is set for [Time setting]. (The clock data of the controller set as [Adjust CH No.] of [Clock data GOT is matched to clock data External (Adjust)] in [GOT Setup] ([Clock Setting]) of GT Designer3 is changed.) For details of [Adjust] and [Broadcast], refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Reference Time setting Set the current time. Time setting

GOT internal battery voltage status*1 Displays GOT internal battery voltage status.

Adjust Synchronize the clock data of the GOT with the clock data of the controller. Adjusting the clock

Broadcast*1 Notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller for synchronization with the GOT.

Broadcasting the clock data

Local time Set the time zone of the local time in the clock data of the GOT. Local time

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 537

53

Clock synchronization method The following shows the clock synchronization method on the GOT.

*1 GT2103-P cannot be specified.

Details of the clock synchronization method For the details of the clock synchronization method, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Clock synchronization method

Description

Adjust Acquire the clock data of the controller and change the clock data of the GOT.

When the GOT is powered on, set the clock data of the GOT to that of the controller. Since the GOT does not have to hold the clock data while the GOT is powered off, no battery is required. (If the GOT needs to hold the clock data at startup, install a battery in the GOT.) To set the controller clock data of the controller, refer to the manual of the controller you use.

Broadcast*1 Notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller to change that of the controller.

At the timing of the trigger, set the clock data of the controller to that of the GOT. Since the GOT must hold the clock data while the GOT is powered off, a battery is required. Set the clock data of the GOT in the utility.

Using Adjust and Broadcast together*1

Acquire the clock data of the controller by Adjust. Then change the clock data of other controllers by Broadcast.

Clock data

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

PLC GOT

Clock data

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

Adjust

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

GOT

Broadcast

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

PLC

2013/4/1 12 : 45 : 07

8 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Time setting Set the current time. The following explanation uses GT2104-R as an example.

Time setting

Display operation of the time setting

Function Description Reference Current time Carry out the display and setup of GOT clock data. Page 540 Current time

GOT internal battery voltage status

Displays GOT internal battery voltage status. Page 541 GOT internal battery voltage status (GT2103-P is excluded.)

Touch [Time setting].

Main menu Time setting

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 539

54

Setting procedure for the time setting Current time Carry out the display and setting of GOT clock data. The setup methods of clock data are shown below.

1. Touch either the date or time to be changed.

2. Enter date or time on the ten-key pad. The following shows the valid range of the date setting. January 1, 2000 to December 31, 2037 The day of the week is displayed automatically according to the input date. "0" to "9": Use these keys to enter numerical values. "ESC": Closes the ten-key window without saving any value entered for the date or time. "AC": Deletes the entire string of numerical characters that are being entered. "DEL": Deletes a digit from a string of numerical characters that are being entered. "ENT": Enters the value for the date or clock that has been entered and closes the ten-key pad window. "+/-": Switches between positive and negative values. (Only positive values are valid for the date or clock setting.) ".": Invalid key (not used)

3. After setting either the date or time, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

Touch the item to be changed.

0 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

GOT internal battery voltage status (GT2103-P is excluded.) Displays battery voltage status.

When the battery voltage is low, replace the battery immediately. Refer to the following for battery replacement procedure. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware)

Display Status Normal Normal

Low/None Low voltage

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 541

54

Adjusting the clock Synchronize the clock data of the GOT with the clock data of the controller. The following explanation uses GT2104-R as an example.

Clock adjustment setting

*1 If [Adjust the clock] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, only [Sampling] is selectable as the trigger type for the clock adjustment in the utility.

*2 If [Adjust the clock] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, [No setting] is displayed in [Device].

Settings of [Adjust] in the utility Configure the settings in the utility and in [GOT Setup] on GT Designer3 by the same method. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Function Description Setting range Time setting Switch the Use/Disuse of Adjust. Disuse/Use

Reference CH No. Set a reference channel of the external controller. 1 to 2

Trigger type Set the trigger type for the clock adjustment.*1

When selecting [Sampling] for [Trigger type], set the sampling interval for the clock adjustment. When selecting [Rise] or [Fall] for [Trigger type], information on the device set as a trigger is displayed.*2

Trigger type: Rise/Fall/Sampling Sampling interval: 1 to 1440

Time zone of target unit Switch Specified/Unspecified of the time zone of target. Unspecified/Specified

Time zone When selecting [Specify the time zone of target unit], set the time zone. GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00

Time difference from GMT Time zone of target is set by specifying the time difference from GMT. Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

2 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Display operation of the clock adjustment

Touch [Time setting].

Main menu

Touch [Use].

Time setting (When using "Adjust")

Touch [Disuse].

Touch [Disuse].

Time setting (When not using "Adjust")

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 543

54

Display operation of the clock adjustment Reference CH No. 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

Trigger Type 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. If you select [Sampling], set the sampling interval for the clock adjustment. Touch the entry box on the left side of [Min.] to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

4 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Set the time zone of target. 1. When specifying the time zone of target, touch the setting item of [Time zone of target].

2. Touch the setting item of [Time zone of target].

3. Touch the setting item to set the time difference from GMT.

4. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 545

54

Broadcasting the clock data Notify the clock data of the GOT to the controller for synchronization with the GOT. The following explanation uses GT2104-R as an example.

Time notification setting

*1 If [Broadcast the clock data] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, only [Sampling] is selectable as the trigger type for the time notification in the utility.

*2 If [Broadcast the clock data] is deselected or [Trigger Type] is set to [Sampling] in [GOT Setup] in the project data, [No setting] is displayed for the device.

Settings of [Broadcast] in the utility Configure the settings in the utility and in [GOT Setup] on GT Designer3 by the same method. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Item Description Setting range Broadcast Switch the Use/Disuse of Broadcast. Disuse/Use

Broadcast CH No. Set a channel used for the time notification. CH 1/CH 2/CH 1,CH 2/None

Trigger type Set the trigger type for the time notification.*1

When selecting [Sampling] for [Trigger type], set the sampling interval for the time notification. When selecting [Rise] or [Fall] for [Trigger type], information on the device set as a trigger is displayed.*2

Trigger type: Rise/Fall/Sampling Sampling interval: 1 to 1440

Time zone of target unit Switch Specified/Unspecified of the time zone of target. Unspecified/Specified

Time zone When selecting [Specify the time zone of target unit], set the time zone. GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00/Custom

Time difference from GMT Time zone of target is set by specifying the time difference from GMT. Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

6 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Display operation of the clock adjustment

Touch [Time setting].

Main menu

Touch [Use].

Time setting (When using "Broadcast")

Touch [Disuse].

Touch [Disuse].

Time setting (When not using "Broadcast")

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 547

54

Setting procedure for the clock adjustment Set a broadcast channel. 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

Trigger Type 1. Touch the setting item to change the selection.

2. If you select [Sampling], set the sampling interval for the clock adjustment. Touch the entry box on the left side of [Min.] to display a software keyboard. Input a value with the keyboard.

3. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

8 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Set the time zone of target. 1. When specifying the time zone of target, touch the setting item of [Time zone of target].

2. Touch the setting item of [Time zone of target].

3. Touch the setting item to set the time difference from GMT.

4. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 549

55

Local time Set the time zone of the local time in the clock data of the GOT. The following explanation uses GT2104-R as an example.

Local time setting Function Description Setting range Local time Switch Spcified/Unspecified the time zone in the clock data of the

GOT. Unspecified/Specified

Time zone of GOT Set the time zone in the clock data of the GOT. GMT-12:00 to GMT+13:00/Custom

Time difference from GMT [Time zone of GOT] is set by specifying the time difference from GMT.

Hour: -12 to 13 Minute: 0, 15, 30, or 45

0 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

14

Display operation of the local time

Touch [Time setting].

Main menu

Touch the setting item.

Time setting (When using "Local time")

Touch [Unspecified].

Touch [Unspecified].

Time setting (When not using "Local time")

14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display 551

55

Set the local time. 1. Touch the setting item to set the time difference from GMT.

2. After changing the settings, touch the [] button to save the changes and close the setting window.

When connecting to an external device which does not have clock function If the GOT is connected to an external device (such as a PLC or microcomputer) that has no clock function, setting [Adjust] or [Broadcast] does not synchronize the clock data between the GOT and external device. For the list of the PLCs having the clock function, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for the controller used For details of [Adjust] and [Broadcast], refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual Time setting and battery To use the time notification function, connect the GOT built-in battery and then configure the time setting. For information on how to connect the GOT built-in battery, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Hardware) Time display The GOT displays the current time to which the local time setting is reflected. For the local time setting, refer to the following. Page 550 Local time Changing times If you have changed the present time of the GOT where the time setting function or the time notification function was being used, the new time setting will be written to the PLC. Thus, you can change the time of the PLC from the GOT even when the time setting function is being used. For details of [Adjust] and [Broadcast], refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

2 14 CLOCK SETTINGS AND BATTERY STATUS DISPLAY 14.1 Time Setting and Display

15

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA Page 553 Data Storage Location Page 558 OS information Page 559 Resource Data Information Page 600 SD Card Access Page 601 SD Card Format Page 605 Clear Data Page 609 Data Copy Page 614 Backup and Restoration Page 636 USB Device Management A system application, project data (screen data), or alarm data which is written in the GOT or SD card can be displayed, and the data can be transferred between the GOT and SD card. The format of the SD card is also possible.

15.1 Data Storage Location Data type and storage location

System The data storage location and transferring (write/read) route for each data type are shown below. Also, the data storage locations are shown below.

*1 For the GT2103-P, the separately sold SD card unit (GT21-03SDCD) is required. *2 Only available to GT2107-W.

Read Upload

Write

Write

Install/ Download PC

GT Designer3

Inserting/ Removing

C drive (Built-in flash memory)

Copy files on Windows

System application

BootOS Project data

Project data Project data

Project data

Install, Write: Upload, Read:

BootOS

System application BootOS

System application

Project data BootOS

Project data

A drive*1

(Standard SD card)

SD card (when installed in GOT)

USB memory (when installed in GOT)

E drive*2

(USB drive)

SD card (when installed in PC)

USB memory (when installed in PC)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.1 Data Storage Location 553

55

The data of the built-in flash memory (Project data, etc.) can be saved even if the battery voltage becomes low.

*1 The SD card can be used from Utility. Page 558 OS information

*2 When using the project data stored in the Standard SD Card (A drive) with the GOT, hold the SD card installed to the GOT.

At maintenance For GT2107-WTBD, GT2107-WTSD

Checking available space of the storage memory To save resource data, check available space of the storage memory.

Item Data type Storage location BootOS Built-in flash memory (C drive)

*1

Basic system application Standard SD card (A drive) Built-in flash memory (C drive)*2

USB memory (E drive) Communication driver

Advanced system application

*1

Project data (Including recipe setting, alarm conditions, time action, and GOT setup.)

Item Data type Storage location Alarm log file Standard SD card (A drive)

Built-in SRAM (D drive) USB memory (E drive)Recipe file

Logging file Standard SD card (A drive) USB memory (E drive)

Image file

BootOS

System application

Project data

Alarm

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

AlarmAlarm

Alarm

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

Recipe Recipe

Read

CopyCopy

Inserting/ Removing

C drive (Built-in flash memory)

D drive (Built-in SRAM)

PC GT Designer3

Copy files on Windows

Install, Write: Upload, Read:

A drive (Standard SD card)

SD card (when installed in GOT)

USB memory (when installed in GOT)

E drive (USB drive)

SD card (when installed in PC)

USB memory (when installed in PC)

Alarm

Recipe

Logging

Hard copy

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.1 Data Storage Location

15

For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R, GT2104-P

Checking available space of the storage memory To save resource data, check available space of the storage memory.

Item Data type Storage location Alarm log file Standard SD card (A drive)

Built-in SRAM (D drive)

Recipe file

Logging file Standard SD card (A drive)

Image file

CopyCopy PC GT Designer3

A drive (Standard SD card)

SD card (when installed in GOT) Inserting/

Removing

SD card (when installed in PC)

C drive (Built-in flash memory)

D drive (Built-in SRAM)

Copy files on Windows

Install, Write: Upload, Read:

Read

Alarm

Recipe Recipe

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

AlarmAlarm

Alarm

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

Alarm

Recipe

Logging

Hard copy

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.1 Data Storage Location 555

55

For GT2103-P

*1 An SD card unit (GT21-03SDCD) which is sold separately is required.

Checking available space of the storage memory To save resource data, check available space of the storage memory.

Item Data type Storage location Alarm log file Standard SD card (A drive)

Built-in flash memory (C drive)

Recipe file

Logging file Standard SD card (A drive)

Image file

Read

CopyCopy PC GT Designer3

A drive*1

(Standard SD card)

SD card (when installed in GOT) Inserting/

Removing

SD card (when installed in PC)

C drive (Built-in flash memory)

Copy files on Windows

Install, Write: Upload, Read:

Alarm

Recipe Recipe

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

AlarmAlarm

Alarm

Recipe Logging

Hard copy

Alarm

Recipe

Logging

Hard copy

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.1 Data Storage Location

15

Checking version of BootOS and basic system application Confirm the basic system application version carefully when installing the BootOS and basic system application. When the basic system application is installed, the GOT checks and compares the basic system application version automatically.

When the BootOS is installed When the BootOS to be installed has the older major version, the GOT displays the installation disapproving message to cancel the installation so that the older version may not be written. (Even when the version of the BootOS to be installed has the same or later version, the version information and the dialog box for selecting continue/not continue will be displayed.)

When a basic system application or communication driver has been installed When a basic system application or communication driver has already been installed, the version information of the basic system application which has been installed and the dialog box for selecting whether to continue the installation or not will be displayed. Moreover, when the different versions will coexist among all applications (basic system application and communication driver) by installing the basic system application, the installation disapproving dialog box will be displayed and the installation process is canceled.

When project data is downloaded The GOT automatically compares the version between the project data to be downloaded and the installed basic system application. When the versions are different, the dialog box confirming whether to install the basic system application together is displayed. The version of each system application that has been installed in the GOT can be checked on the OS information screen.

For the display operation of the screen, refer to the following. Page 558 OS information

Version confirmation of BootOS by rating plate Confirm the version of BootOS installed in the GOT at product shipment by rating plate of GOT rear face.

How to read version 01.02.000.-C

BootOS version (Indicated only when the property of the BootOS is displayed.) Minor version Major version

Hardware version BootOS versionMITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.1 Data Storage Location 557

55

15.2 OS information

Function of OS information Each file name or folder name of the BootOS that runs in the GOT and package data can be displayed in a list.

Display operation of OS information

Display example of system application information

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays the type, name, and version of the file. Page 558 Display example of system

application information

No. Item Description (1) Name Each file name or folder name of the BootOS that runs in the GOT and package data can be displayed in a list.

(2) Version information Displays the software version.

Main menu Main menu

Data control

Touch [Data].

Touch [OS information].

OS information Storage file/folder display screen

(1)

(2)

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.2 OS information

15

15.3 Resource Data Information Alarm information

Function of alarm information This function displays the alarm log files stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card, C: Built-in flash memory, D: Built-in SRAM, or E: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. For details on the alarms, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

The display operation of alarm information GT2107-W

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 562 The display example of alarm

information, Page 564 The display operation of alarm information

G2A CSV conversion Converts the G2A file of an alarm log file to a CSV file. Page 565 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation

G2A TXT conversion Converts the G2A file of an alarm log file to a Unicode text file. Page 565 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation

Delete Deletes the file. Page 566 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 567 Copy operation

Main menu Data control

Select a drive and use alarm log files.

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Touch [Data].

Touch [Alarm info.].

Touch [Resource data].

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 559

56

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P

Select a drive and use alarm log files.

Main menu

Touch [Alarm info.].

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Main menu Main menu

Touch [Alarm info.].

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Select a drive and use alarm log files.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

GT2103-P

Main menu Main menu

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Alarm info.].

Select a drive and use alarm log files.

Drive selection

Data control

Resource Data Information

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 561

56

The display example of alarm information

For GT2104-P

For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

For GT2103-P

(6)

(For GT2107-W)

(1)

(1)

(6)

(2)

(3) (4) (5)

(2)

(3) (4) (5)

(1)

(1)

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Display of creation date and time The creation date and time display is not updated even if a file is created or updated while displaying the alarm information display screen. If the screen currently displayed is closed (by moving the screen to the folder of the upper hierarchy, etc.) and the same screen is displayed again, the updated contents are displayed.

No. Item Description (1) Drive selection Select a drive to display files or folders.

(Data storage drives are displayed even no data storage is installed.)

(2) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(3) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed. Page 564 Alarm information operation

(4) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(5) Date, Time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(6) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 563

56

Alarm information operation The display operation of alarm information 1. If a drive of [Select drive] is touched, the information of the touched drive is displayed.

(For GT2104-P)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2103-P)

(For GT2107-W)

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

2. If a folder name is touched, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If a folder of ". ." is touched, the information of the folder in one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If the button of the scrollbar is touched, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. If a file name is touched, the file is selected.

6. For operations of G2A CSV conversion, G2A TXT conversion, deletion, copy, and graph, refer to the following. G2A CSV, G2A TXT Page 565 G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation Delete Page 566 Deletion operation Copy Page 567 Copy operation

7. If the [] button is touched, the screen is closed.

G2A CSV conversion operation, G2A TXT conversion operation The selected G2A file is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file.

1. Touch the G2A file to be converted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. Touch [Convert].

3. The following dialog box is displayed when touching the following button according to the file type to convert to. CSV file: [CSV] button Unicode text file: [TXT] button

4. Touch the [YES] button. The file is overwritten with the converted file.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 565

56

Deletion operation The selected file is deleted.

1. Touch the file to be deleted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Delete] button is touched, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is deleted. If the [NO] button is touched, the deletion is canceled.

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Copy operation The selected file is copied.

1. Touch the file to be copied.

2. If the [Copy] button is touched, the Select drive screen is displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

3. Select a drive. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 567

56

(For GT2103-P)

4. Select the copy destination folder and touch [Execute]. The file is copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Recipe information

Function of recipe information This function displays the recipe files stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card, C: Built-in flash memory, D: Built-in SRAM, or E: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. For details on the recipe function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of recipe information GT2107-W

Function Description Reference Recipe information screen

File and folder information display

Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 572 Example of advanced recipe information display, Page 573 Recipe information screen

G2P CSV conversion Converts a G2P file of a recipe file to a CSV file. Page 575 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation

G2P TXT conversion Converts a G2P file of a recipe file to a Unicode text file. Page 575 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation

CSV/TXT G2P conversion

Converts a CSV file or Unicode text file to a G2P recipe file. Page 576 CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation

Delete Deletes the file. Page 577 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 578 Copy operation

Main menu

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Recipe info.].Select a drive and use

recipe information.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 569

57

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Recipe info.].

Select a drive and use recipe information.

Main Menu

Drive selection

Data control

Resource Data Information

Touch [Data].

Main menu Main menu

Select a drive and use recipe information.

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Recipe info.].

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

GT2103-P

Touch [Data].

Main menu Main menu

Select a drive and use recipe information.

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Recipe info.].

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 571

57

Example of advanced recipe information display Recipe information screen

No. Item Description (1) Drive selection Select a target drive.

(Data storage drives are displayed even no data storage is installed.)

(2) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(3) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed.

(4) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(5) Date, Time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(6) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

For GT2104-P

For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

For GT2103-P

(1)

For GT2107-W Recipe information screen

(1)

(6)

(2)

(3) (4) (5)

(6)

(3) (4) (5)

(2) (1)

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Recipe information operation Display operation of recipe information 1. If a drive of [Select drive] is touched, the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If a folder name is touched, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If a folder of ". ." is touched, the information of the folder in one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If the button of the scrollbar is touched, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. If a file name is touched, the file is selected.

For GT2104-P

Recipe information Storage file/folder display screen

For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

For GT2103-P

For GT2107-W Recipe information screen

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 573

57

6. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. G2P CSV, G2P TXT Page 575 G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation CSV/TXT G2P Page 576 CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation Delete Page 577 Deletion operation Copy Page 578 Copy operation

7. If the [] button is touched, the screen is closed.

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

G2P CSV conversion operation, G2P TXT conversion operation A recipe file (G2P file) is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file that can be displayed/edited on a personal computer.

1. Touch the G2P file to be converted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. Touch [Convert].

3. Touch the following button in accordance with destination file type. CSV file: [CSV] button Unicode text file: [TXT] button

4. Touch the [YES] button. The file is overwritten with the converted file.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 575

57

CSV/TXT G2P conversion operation A CSV file or Unicode text file is converted to a recipe file (G2P file).

1. Touch the CSV file or Unicode text file to be converted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. Touch the [Convert] button.

3. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is overwritten with the converted file.

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Deletion operation Files to be used in recipe are deleted.

1. Touch the file to be deleted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Delete] button is touched, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is deleted. If the [NO] button is touched, the deletion is canceled.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 577

57

Copy operation Files to be used in recipe are copied.

1. Touch the file to be copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Copy] button is touched, the Select drive screen is displayed.

3. Select a drive. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P)

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

(For GT2103-P)

4. Select the copy destination folder and touch [Execute]. The file is copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Precautions Precautions for operation Precautions during file operation (Create/Delete/Copy/File conversion, etc.) Even if the access to the SD card is inhibited while the GOT is processing files, the processing continues. (Example: Even if the access to the SD card is inhibited while the GOT is copying a file, a file is created.) Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the access to the SD card is inhibited. While the GOT is accessing to other file (Alarm data, etc.) When file processing for the recipe is executed while the GOT is in access to another file (SD card access LED ON), the GOT executes file processing for the recipe after the processing for the other file has completed. Therefore, it may take some time to finish the processing of the recipe file.

Estimation of processing time The process may take time depending on the setting of advanced recipe file to be operated. (The more number of blocks increases, the longer it takes to process recipe folder/file.) The process for creating the first file may take time depending on the setting of advanced recipe file.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 579

58

Logging information

Function of logging information This function displays the logging files stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card or E: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. For details on the logging function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of logging information GT2107-W

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 582 Example of logging

information display, Page 583 Logging information operation

Delete Deletes the file. Page 584 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 585 Copy operation

Main menu

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Logging info.].

Select a drive and use logging data files.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Main Menu

Select a drive and use logging data files.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Touch [Logging info.].

Main menu Main menu

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Select a drive and use logging data files.

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Logging info.].

Touch [Data].

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 581

58

Example of logging information display

No. Item Description (1) Drive selection Select a target drive.

(Data storage drives are displayed even no data storage is installed.)

(2) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(3) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed.

(4) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(5) Date, Time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(6) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(1)

(3) (4)

(2)

(5)

(6)

(1)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

(For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(1) (6)

(3) (4) (5)(2)

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Logging information operation Display operation of logging information 1. If a drive of [Select drive] is touched, the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If a folder name is touched, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If a folder of ". ." is touched, the information of the folder in one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If the button of the scrollbar is touched, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. If a file name is touched, the file is selected.

6. For operation of operating switches, refer to the following. Delete Page 584 Deletion operation Copy Page 585 Copy operation

7. If the [] button is touched, the screen is closed.

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

(For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 583

58

Deletion operation Files to be used in logging are deleted.

1. Touch the file to be deleted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Delete] button is touched, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is deleted. If the [NO] button is touched, the deletion is canceled.

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Copy operation Files to be used in logging is copied.

1. Touch the file to be copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Copy] button is touched, the Select drive screen is displayed.

3. Select a drive. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 585

58

4. Select the copy destination folder and touch [Execute]. The file is copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Precautions Precautions for operation Precautions during file operation (Create/Delete/Copy, etc.) Even if the access to the SD card is inhibited while the GOT is processing files, the processing continues. (Example: Even if the access to the SD card is inhibited while the GOT is copying a file, a file is created.) Therefore, do not pull out the SD card while the "Processing..." message is on the screen after the access to the SD card is inhibited. While the GOT is accessing to other file (Alarm data, etc.) When file processing for the logging is executed while the GOT is in access to other files (SD card access LED ON), the GOT executes file processing for the logging after the processing for other files is completed. Therefore, it may take some time to finish the processing of the logging file.

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Image file management

Function of image file management This function displays the image files stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card or E: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. For details on the hard copy function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of image file management GT2107-W

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders

Displays the kind, name, data size, creation date and time of the file or folder.

Page 589 Display example of image file management, Page 590 Operation of image file management

Delete Deletes the file. Page 591 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 592 Copy operation

Main menu

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Image file].

Select a drive and use image data files.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 587

58

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Main Menu

Select a drive and use image data files.

Touch [Image file].

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Main menu Main menu

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Image file].

Select a drive and use image data files.

Data control

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Touch [Data].

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Display example of image file management

Display of creation date and time The creation date and time display is not updated even if a file is created or updated while the image file management screen is displayed. To display the updated creation date and time, close the screen currently displayed (by moving to the upper hierarchy folder, etc.) and display the screen again.

No. Item Description (1) Drive selection Select a drive to display files or folders.

When an SD card is not installed, the following drives are not displayed. SD card: [A:SD card]

(2) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(3) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed.

(4) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(5) Date, Time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(6) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(3) (4)

(2)

(5)

(6)

For GT2104-P, GT2103-P

For GT2107-W

(6)

(3) (4) (5)(2)

For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 589

59

Operation of image file management Display operation of image file management 1. If a drive of [Select drive] is touched, the information of the touched drive is displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If a folder name is touched, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If a folder of ". ." is touched, the information of the folder in one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If the button of the scrollbar is touched, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. If a file name is touched, the file is selected.

6. For the operations of the delete, copy, and rename, refer to the following. Delete Page 591 Deletion operation Copy Page 592 Copy operation

7. If the [] button is touched, the screen is closed.

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Deletion operation The selected file is deleted.

1. Touch the file to be deleted. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Delete] button is touched, the screen mentioned below is displayed. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is deleted. If the [NO] button is touched, the deletion is canceled.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 591

59

Copy operation The selected file is copied.

1. Touch the file to be copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. If the [Copy] button is touched, the Select drive screen is displayed. Select a drive. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

3. If the copy destination folder is touched, the screen display is changed to the folder of copy destination. At this time, it cannot be copied into the same folder where the file exists. Select other folders.

(For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

4. If touch the [Execute] button, the file is copied. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 593

59

Operation log information

Function of operation log information This function displays the operation log files stored in each drive (A: Standard SD card or E: USB drive). The functions below can be carried out for files. Only GT2107-W supports this function. For details on operation logs, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Display operation of operation log information GT2107-W

Function Description Reference Information display of files and folders Displays name, data size, creation date and time of file or folder. Page 595 Display example of operation log

information, Page 596 Operation of operation log information

G2O CSV conversion Converts an operation log file (G2O file) to a CSV file. Page 597 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation

G2O TXT conversion Converts an operation log file (G2O file) to a Unicode text file. Page 597 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation

Delete Deletes the file. Page 598 Deletion operation

Copy Copies the file. Page 599 Copy operation

Main menu Data control

Select a drive and use operation log information.

Resource Data InformationDrive selection

Touch [Data].

Touch [Resource data].

Touch [Operation log].

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Display example of operation log information

No. Item Description (1) Drive selection Select a drive to display files or folders.

(Data storage drives are displayed even no data storage is installed.)

(2) Kind Indicates whether the displayed name is file or folder. Displays the extension for a file and "DIR" for a folder.

(3) Name Displays the file name or folder name. For the long file/folder name, entire part may not be displayed.

(4) Size Displays the size of the file displayed in Name.

(5) Date, Time Displays the creation date and time of each file.

(6) Operation switch Execution switch of each function.

(6)

(2)

(3) (4) (5)

(1)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 595

59

Operation of operation log information Display operation of operation log information 1. If a drive of [Select drive] is touched, the information of the touched drive is displayed.

2. If a folder name is touched, the information of the touched folder is displayed.

3. If a folder of ". ." is touched, the information of the folder in one upper hierarchy is displayed.

4. If the button of the scrollbar is touched, the screen scrolls up/down by one line.

5. If a file name is touched, the file is selected.

6. For G2O CSV conversion, G2O TXT conversion, deleting, copying, and renaming, refer to the following. G2O CSV or G2O TXT conversion Page 597 G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation Delete Page 598 Deletion operation Copy Page 599 Copy operation

7. If the [] button is touched, the screen is closed.

When the Prohibit Operation Log Information Operation signal (GS522.b3) is turned on, the [Del], [Copy], and [Convert] buttons are not displayed. For the details, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

G2O CSV conversion operation, G2O TXT conversion operation A selected G2O file is converted to a CSV file or Unicode text file.

1. Touch the G2O file to be converted.

2. Touch [Convert].

3. The destination selection screen appears. Select the destination.

4. The following dialog box is displayed when touching the following button according to the file type to convert to. CSV file: [CSV] button Unicode text file: [TXT] button

5. Touch the [YES] button. The converted file is created.

6. If a file with the same name exists, the overwrite confirmation dialog appears. Touch the [YES] button to overwrite the file. Touch the [NO] button to cancel the conversion.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 597

59

Deletion operation The selected file is deleted.

1. Touch the file to be deleted.

2. If the [Delete] button is touched, the dialog box mentioned below is displayed. If the [YES] button is touched, the file is deleted. If the [NO] button is touched, the deletion is canceled.

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information

15

Copy operation The selected file is copied.

1. Touch the file to be copied.

2. If the [Copy] button is touched, the Select drive screen is displayed.

3. Select a drive.

4. Select the copy destination folder and touch [Execute]. The file is copied.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.3 Resource Data Information 599

60

15.4 SD Card Access Functions of SD card access When the GOT is turned on, an SD card can be installed or removed to/from the GOT without damage to the data in the SD card.

Display operation of SD card access

Operation of SD card access 1. Touch a setting item to change the setting. [Permissions] [Access inhibit] When installing or removing an SD card, always set [Access inhibit].

Data control

Main menu Main menu

SD card access

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.4 SD Card Access

15

15.5 SD Card Format

Function of SD card format An SD card is formatted.

Display operation of SD card format GT2107-W

Main menu

Touch [Data]. Touch [Drive format].

Data control

SD card format Drive selection

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.5 SD Card Format 601

60

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Touch [Data].

Main Menu Data control

Touch [Drive format].

Drive selectionSD card format

Touch [Data].

Main menu Main menu

Data control

Drive selectionSD card format

Touch [SD card format].

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.5 SD Card Format

15

Operation of SD card format 1. Install an SD card to the GOT. For installation/removal procedure of an SD card, refer to the following. GT21-03SDCD General Description

2. Touch and select the drive to format by drive selection. (For GT2107-W)

(For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

3. If the [FORMAT] button is touched, the password input screen is displayed. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.5 SD Card Format 603

60

4. Type and touch the [Enter] key. The dialog box shown below will appear. (The password is fixed to 1111.) Confirm the contents of the dialog box, and touch the [YES] button to format the SD card. To cancel the format, touch the [NO] button. (For SD card)

(For USB drive)

5. When the formatting is completed, the completion dialog mentioned below is displayed.

6. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

Restrictions on formatting When using an unformatted SD card in the GOT, format it by a personal computer. The GOT cannot format the unformatted SD card. The format of the GOT does not change the file system (Example: FAT16) of the SD card and inherits the file system before the format.

1 1 1 1

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.5 SD Card Format

15

15.6 Clear Data Clear data functions This function deletes the project data, resource data, and internal devices (GD and GB) that are written to the GOT.

Clear data display

GT2107-W

Main menu

Touch [Data]. Touch [Clear data].

Data control

Clear data

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.6 Clear Data 605

60

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

Touch [Data].

Main Menu Data control

Clear data

Touch [Clear data].

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.6 Clear Data

15

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Clear data Clear data

Data control

Main menu Main menu

Touch [Data].

Data control

Touch [Clear data].

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.6 Clear Data 607

60

Clear data operation 1. Touch to select the data to delete. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

2. The dialog box below is displayed for confirmation. Touch the [YES] button to delete the data, or the [NO] button to cancel.

Canceling deletion Data deletion cannot be canceled once the [YES] button is pressed at the confirm deletion prompt. Double check before touching the [YES] button.

Touch the data to delete.

Touch the data to delete.

Touch

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.6 Clear Data

15

15.7 Data Copy The project data and basic system application are transferred by using an SD card.

Copy from the SD card to the GOT Data can be copied from the SD card to the GOT when the GOT is powered on. Refer to the following. Page 695 Installation Using Data Storage When installing or removing an SD card Always set [Permissions] on the GOT. For details, refer to the following. Page 600 SD Card Access Removing the USB drive The USB device should be in the removable status. For the setting method, refer to the following. Page 636 USB Device Management

Display operation of data copy

GT2107-W

Main menu

Touch [Data].

Data control

Data copy

Touch [Data copy].

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.7 Data Copy 609

61

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Touch [Data].

Main Menu Data control

Touch [Data copy].

Data copy

Main menu Main menu

Data control

Data copy

Touch [Data].

Touch [Data copy].

Data control

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.7 Data Copy

15

Operation of data copy 1. Select the copy direction, or the copy source and destination. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R) Select the copy source and destination. The copy source and destination are selectable from [GOT], [SD card], and [USB drive].

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P) The selection mark is displayed on the side of the selected key. GOT SD card: Copy from the GOT to the SD card SD card GOT: Copy from the SD card to the GOT

2. After selecting the copy direction, or the copy source and destination, touch the [OK] button. To abort copy, touch the [ABORT] button.

(For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Touch

Touch

Touch

Touch

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.7 Data Copy 611

61

3. Confirm the copy direction and copy target. When they are set correctly, touch the [OK] button. To change the setting, touch the [CANCEL] button. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

4. The dialog box below is displayed for confirmation. Touch the [YES] button to start copying and [NO] button to cancel. (For GT2105-Q, GT2104-R, GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

5. While the copy is executed, the dialog box below is displayed. Copying data from the GOT to the SD card

Copying data from the SD card to the GOT

Touch

Touch

Touch

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.7 Data Copy

15

6. Copy is completed. Copying data from the GOT to the SD card Touch the [] button to close the screen. (For GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, GT2104-R)

(For GT2104-P, GT2103-P)

Copying data from the SD card to the GOT The GOT automatically restarts.

If an error occurs during copy, an error message appears. For details of error messages, refer to the following. Page 613 Error display

Error display When copying is not available between the GOT and the memory card, check the following contents according to the GOT error display.

Error message Remedy Memory card is not attached. Install an memory card to the GOT.

GOT type is unmatch. The model set for the data in the SD card does not match with that of the copy target GOT. Use the same model data as that of the copy target GOT.

Write protection switch ON. The write protection switch of the SD card is ON. Turn off the write protection switch.

Available package data is not existed. There is no data to be a copy target in the copy source. Store the data to be copied in the copy source and copy it again.

Please check source and destination. The combination of your copy source and copy destination is not correct. Change settings to correct the combination of your copy source and copy destination.

Touch

Touch

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.7 Data Copy 613

61

15.8 Backup and Restoration GT2104-PMBLS and GT2103-PMBLS do not support this function because they are not equipped with the SD card interface.

Backup and restoration The setting information of the controller connected to the GOT (including sequence programs, parameters, and set values)can be saved (backed up) to the data storage installed to the GOT and the data can be restored to the controller if necessary. The following shows the features of the backup and restoration.

For GT2107-W The save destination for backup data is required to be set. For information on how to set the save destination, refer to the following. Page 506 Setting the storage location for backup and restoration

Systems can be backed up and restored without using a personal computer, and this shortens downtime. The setting information of the controller connected to the GOT can be backed up or restored. By using the setting information that was backed up, the information can be restored from the connected GOT even while the controller is replaced due to its failure. Thus, the system can be restored easily.

The same system can be created without using a personal computer. By restoring the backed up information to the controller of another system, the same system can be created without using a personal computer.

Security can be enhanced. By setting a password to limit browsing and changing the setting information, the security at the backup or restoration operation is enhanced.

Data storage

Setting information of the controller can be backed up to an SD card.

The backed up information of the controller can be restored.

Password authentication

Password authentication

Data storage

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

System configuration This section describes the system configuration of the backup/restoration function. For connection type settings and precautions for the communication unit, cable, and connection type, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Product) For GT Works3 Version1

GOT The following shows the GOT that supports the backup/restoration function. GT21 (Except GT2104-PMBLS and GT2103-PMBLS)

Target controller

*1 Use the PLC CPU with the function version B or later. *2 To restore the backup data including special parameters, use a CPU with either of the following versions.

Version of FX3U(C): 3.10 or later Version of FX3G(C): 2.00 or later

Connection type This function can be used in the following connection type. ( : Applicable, : Partly restricted, : Inapplicable)

*1 When a LCPU is connected, use the L6ADP-R2. *2 When a CC-Link IE Field Network Ethernet adapter is used, the backup/restoration function cannot be used. *3 The data cannot be restored to the QCPU in the factory shipment status or whose memory is formatted.

Required hardware An SD card is required to back up and restore data.

Controller Model MELSEC iQ-F FX5U, FX5UC, FX5UJ

QCPU (Q mode) Basic model *1 Q00JCPU, Q00CPU, Q01CPU

High performance model *1 Q02CPU, Q02HCPU, Q06HCPU, Q12HCPU, Q25HCPU

Universal model Q00UJCPU, Q00UCPU, Q01UCPU, Q02UCPU, Q03UDCPU, Q04UDHCPU, Q06UDHCPU, Q10UDHCPU, Q13UDHCPU, Q20UDHCPU, Q26UDHCPU, Q03UDECPU, Q04UDEHCPU, Q06UDEHCPU, Q10UDEHCPU, Q13UDEHCPU, Q20UDEHCPU, Q26UDEHCPU, Q50UDEHCPU, Q100UDEHCPU, Q03UDVCPU, Q04UDVCPU, Q06UDVCPU, Q13UDVCPU, Q26UDVCPU

LCPU L02CPU, L06CPU, L26CPU, L26CPU-BT, L26CPU-PBT, L02CPU-P, L06CPUP, L26CPU-P, L02SCPU, L02SCPU-P

FXCPU*2 FX0, FX0S, FX0N, FX1, FX2, FX2C, FX1S, FX1N, FX1NC, FX2N, FX2NC, FX3U, FX3UC, FX3G, FX3GC, FX3S

Function Connection type between GOT and controller

Name Description Direct CPU connection (serial)

Serial communication connection

Ethernet connection

Backup/restoration Backing up or restoring the settings of the controller connected to the GOT

*1 *3 *2 *3

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 615

61

Backup/restoration target data The following shows the backup/restoration target data. The data other than the following cannot be backed up or restored.

Basic model QCPU

*1 The file register in the Flash card installed to the CPU is always restored and overwritten without any notice.

High Performance model QCPU

*1 The file register in the Flash card installed to the CPU is always restored and overwritten without any notice. *2 Only the backup operation is available.

Universal model QCPU

*1 The file register in the Flash card installed to the CPU is always restored and overwritten without any notice. *2 Only the backup operation is available.

Item Description File name Parameter Parameter to operate the PLC PARAM.QPA

Intelligent function module parameter

Parameter for the intelligent function module IPARAM.QPA

Sequence program Program for the operation by the CPU MAIN.QPG

SFC program Sequence program in the SFC format MAIN-SFC.QPG

File register*1 File register data MAIN.QDR

Device comment Device comment to be stored to the PLC MAIN.QCD

Device initial value Initial value setting of devices MAIN.QDI

Item Description File name Parameter Parameter to operate the PLC PARAM.QPA

Intelligent function module parameter

Parameter for the intelligent function module IPARAM.QPA

Program Program for the operation by the CPU (including SFC) ***.QPG

Device comment Device comment to be stored to the PLC ***.QCD

Boot setting file Batch file to start a program from the ROM or others AUTOEXEC.QBT

Device initial value Initial value setting of devices ***.QDI

File register*1 File register data ***.QDR

Sampling trace file*2 Sampling trace data to collect the specified device data continuously at the specified timing

***.QTD

Failure history data*2 Record of the self check results ***.QFD

Programmable controller user data

Data created by users and stored to the memory card ***.*** (Any name)

Item Description File name Parameter Parameter to operate the PLC PARAM.QPA

Intelligent function module parameter

Parameter for the intelligent function module IPARAM.QPA

Program Program for the operation by the CPU (including SFC) ***.QPG

Device comment Device comment to be stored to the PLC ***.QCD

Boot setting file Batch file to start a program from the ROM or others AUTOEXEC.QBT

Device initial value Initial value setting of devices ***.QDI

File register*1 File register data ***.QDR

Sampling trace file*2 Sampling trace data to collect the specified device data continuously at the specified timing

***.QTD

Programmable controller user data

Data created by users and stored to the memory card ***.*** (Any name)

File for storing device data Device data that the SP.DEVST and S.DEVLD instructions use DEVSTORE.QST

Drive headline sentence Drive headline sentence QN.DAT

Remote password Remote password setting 00000000.QTM

Monitor sequence extension Data to speed up the monitoring from other stations MONITOR.Q0*

Latch data backup file The file where the backup data is stored by the latch data backup function to the standard ROM

LCHDAT00.QBK

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

LCPU

*1 The file register in the Flash card installed to the CPU is always restored and overwritten without any notice. *2 Only the backup operation is available.

FXCPU

*1 The backup and restoration can be performed only when the FX3U(C) or FX3G(C) series is used. *2 The backup and restoration can be performed only when the FX3U(C) series is used. *3 This data exists only in the FX3U-32MT-LT-2.

Data for each software

Item Description File name Parameter Parameter to operate the PLC PARAM.QPA

Intelligent function module parameter

Parameter for the intelligent function module IPARAM.QPA

Program Program for the operation by the CPU (including SFC) ***.QPG

Device comment Device comment to be stored to the PLC ***.QCD

Boot setting file Batch file to start a program from the ROM or others AUTOEXEC.QBT

Device initial value Initial value setting of devices ***.QDI

File register*1 File register data ***.QDR

Sampling trace file*2 Sampling trace data to collect the specified device data continuously at the specified timing

***.QTD

Programmable controller user data

Data created by users and stored to the memory card ***.*** (Any name)

File for storing device data Device data that the SP.DEVST and S.DEVLD instructions use DEVSTORE.QST

Drive headline sentence Drive headline sentence QN.DAT

Remote password Remote password setting 00000000.QTM

Monitor sequence extension Data to speed up the monitoring from other stations MONITOR.Q0*

Latch data backup file The file where the backup data is stored by the latch data backup function to the standard ROM

LCHDAT00.QBK

Data logging setting file Data logging setting LOGCOM.QLG LOG01.QLG to LOG10.QLG

Menu definition file Menu definition file MENUDEF.QDF

Item Description File name Parameter Parameter to operate the PLC INFO.FPG

Device comment Device comment to be stored to the PLC

Sequence program Program for the operation by the CPU

Special program*1 Positioning setting/Initial value parameter

File register File register data

Extension file register*2 Extension file register data

Built-in CC-Link/LT setting*3 CC-Link/LT parameter

Special parameter*1 Parameter for special adaptors and special blocks stored in the main unit

Item Description File name Label program Data for GX Developer PROJINFO.CAB

Symbolic data Symbolic data for PX Developer #FBDQINF.BIN

Symbolic information

Simple project (with label)

GX Works2 data SRCINFOM.CAB SRCINFOM.C32

Structured project GX Works2 data SRCINFOI.CAB SRCINFOI.C32

New symbolic information

Simple project (with label)

GX Works2 data SRCINF1M.CAB SRCINF2M.CAB SRCINF1M.C32 SRCINF2M.C32

Structured project GX Works2 data SRCINF1I.CAB SRCINF2I.CAB SRCINF1I.C32 SRCINF2I.C32

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 617

61

Backup data Storing backup data Only one piece of backup data can be saved for each channel. When the backup operation is executed multiple times to the same channel, the backup data is overwritten.

Backup data storage location The backup data is stored to an SD card with the following folder structure.

Folder for backup data Backup data is stored in each folder and each folder name (YYMMDDXX) is determined as follows.

Access range

Access range for each connection type The following shows the target location of the backup/restoration for each connection type.

When the multi-channel function is used When the multi-channel function is used, data is backed up or restored per channel.

Backup/restoration of the multiple CPU system The batch backup of all CPUs can be executed for the multiple CPU system. Backing up of the CPU No. 1 to 4 cannot be specified.

Connection type Target Serial communication connection Host station

Ethernet connection Host station

SD card

BACKUP

SYS1BKUP

SYS2BKUP

YYMMDDXX Backup data storage folder

Date when the data was backed up (01 to 31)

00 (Fixed) YYMMDDXX

Month when the data was backed up (01 to 12)

Year when the data was backed up (Last two digits of the year)

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Precautions

Precautions for backing up data Data that cannot be backed up The current values of devices and the device memory cannot be backed up. To collect the current values of the devices, use the recipe function. For how to use the recipe function, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual To collect the device memory, use GX Developer.

Backup target file name When characters other than the ones of the shift JIS code and the ASCII code are used in a file name, the file name may not be displayed properly after data is backed up to the GOT. To use the backup/restore function, use characters of the shift JIS code or ASCII code in file names.

Backup of the intelligent function module parameters To back up the intelligent function module parameters (IPARAM.QPA), only the parameters that can be stored to the PLC CPU are the backup target. To back up parameters other than the ones above, GX Configurator that is compatible with the modules or GX Works2 is required. For the intelligent function module parameters that can be stored to the PLC CPU, refer to the following. GX Works2 Version 1 Operating Manual (Intelligent Function Module)

Compatibility of the backup data The backup data that is used by GT21 cannot be used by GT27 or GT25. The backup data that is used by GT27 and GT25 cannot be used by GT21.

Precautions for restoring data Communication status of the GOT and the controller to execute the restoration To execute the restoration, the target controller must be able to communicate with the GOT. When the target controller cannot communicate with the GOT, data cannot be restored.

STOP status at the restoration The PLC CPU goes into the STOP status by using the remote STOP before the restoration. Since the remote STOP cannot be used for the FXCPU at the restoration, users must change the PLC's status to the STOP status. For the CNC (C80 or C70), the CNC ladder is in the STOP status. After the restoration is completed, this STOP status is not canceled. Restart each controller.

Canceling the restoration When the restoration is canceled, not all the data is written to the controller and the controller may not operate properly. When the restoration is canceled, execute the restoration again. The STOP status is not canceled even though the restoration is canceled. Restart the controller by the user.

Configuration of the controller at the restoration The configuration of the controller must be the same as the one at the backup. When the configuration of the controller at the restoration differs from the one at the backup, the restoration cannot be executed. When the configuration of the controller at the restoration is the same as the one at the backup, the restoration can be executed even though the connection type or CH No. does not match. When the FXCPU is connected, the model, memory cassette (whether it is installed or not), and memory capacity of the memory cassette must be the same as the ones at the backup.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 619

62

Operation of the controller The controller may operate unexpectedly by changing a set value or device value at the restoration. To execute the restoration, sufficiently check the data to be restored and the operation of the controller.

Precautions for backing up and restoring data Password for the backup/restoration When the password on the controller side is changed after the password for the backup/restoration has been set, the password for the backup/restoration needs to be changed. For how to set a password for the backup/restoration, refer to the following. Page 622 Security and password

Precautions for using GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Do not perform the following operations in GT Designer3 (GOT2000) while the backup or restoration is executed.

When the operations above are performed, the backup or restoration processing is canceled.

Precautions for using GX Developer Do not access the target controller of the backup or restoration using GX Developer while the backup or restoration is

executed. Accessing the target controller cancels the backup or restoration processing. Do not execute the backup or restoration while the target controller is accessed using GX Developer. If doing so, a communication error occurs in GX Developer. (The backup or restoration processing is executed.)

CPU to which a security key is set The data in the CPU to which a security key is set cannot be backed up or restored. To back up or restore the data, review the CPU setting. When both the CPU with a security key and the one without a security key exist in the target controller of the backup or restoration, only the data in the CPU without a security key can be backed up or restored.

Precautions for using the QCPU Restoring data to the QCPU in the factory shipment status or whose memory is formatted can be performed only in the following cases. When the single CPU system is used: The connection type is the direct CPU connection (serial). When the multiple CPU system is used: The connection type is the direct CPU connection (serial). However, the restoration cannot be executed at once to multiple CPUs in the multiple CPU system including the QCPU that is in the factory shipment status or whose memory is formatted. Execute the restoration for each CPU.

Operation in GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Installing the BootOS Writing the package data and installing a communication driver, basic system application, and advanced system application

Restore the data to CPU No.1.

Reset CPU No.1.

Restore the data to CPU No.2.

Reset CPU No.2.

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Precautions for using the FXCPU When a memory cassette is installed When a memory cassette is installed, the data in the memory cassette is backed up. When a memory cassette is not installed, the data in the built-in memory is backed up.

Keyword setting The following table shows whether the backup/restore function can be executed or not for each keyword setting. (: Available, : Not available)

Keyword at the restoration The keyword of the restoration target FXCPU is held at the restoration. For how to set or clear the keyword of the FXCPU, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's Manual (Utility) Programming manual for the FXCPU used

Backup data including the symbolic information When the restoration target FXCPU does not support the symbolic information, the backup data including the symbolic information cannot be restored.

Function Protect that cannot be canceled With keyword Without keywordWrite

Protect R/W Protect All

operation protect

Write Protect R/W Protect All operation protect

Protect Protect Protect Protect Clear Protect Clear Protect Clear (Trigger) Backup

Restoration

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 621

62

Security and password By setting a password for the backup/restore function, the authentication using a password can be conducted at the backup or restoration. The password for the backup/restoration and the password on the controller side are used for the authentication.

The following shows the passwords used at the backup or restoration.

Inputting the password on the controller side is not required at the backup or restoration after the first backup (setting of the password for the backup/restoration). (The authentication of the password on the controller side is conducted automatically.) Therefore, users have the following merits on the security.

Before setting the password for the backup/restoration When the password for the backup/restoration is forgotten, the backup and restoration cannot be executed. When the password for the backup/restoration is forgotten, format the SD card used or use a new SD card to back up the data again.

For how to set a password for the backup/restoration, refer to the following. Page 623 Setting the password for the backup/restoration For how to use the password for the backup/restoration after the setting, refer to the following. Page 625 How to use the password for the backup/restoration

Password Description Password for the backup/restoration This is a password for the authentication at the backup or restoration.

Set this password with the GOT at the first backup. To set this password, a password on the controller side has to be set in advance.

Password on the controller side This is a password set to the backup/restoration target file of the controller. Set this password using the setting software of the controller when the file is written to the controller.

User Merit Administrator Disclosing the password on the controller side to operators on site is not required.

(This prevents from browsing or editing the setting information of the controller by a person other than the administrator.)

Operators on site Data can be backed up or restored by using the password for the backup/restoration only. (Inputting the password on the controller side is not required.)

SD card

Restoration

Backup

Authentication of the password for backup/restoration Automatic authentication of the password on the controller side

Authentication of the password for backup/restoration Automatic authentication of the password on the controller side

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Setting the password for the backup/restoration The password for the backup/restoration can be set only when the following conditions are satisfied at the first backup. A password has been set to the backup target file of the controller. The authentication using the password on the controller side is required at the first backup. The following shows the operation procedure at the first backup. For details of the operation screen, refer to the following. Page 628 Display operation of backup and restoration

*1 For the details, refer to the following. Page 628 Display operation of backup and restoration

No

No

Start

Touch [Backup] in main menu. (First backup)*1

Is there any password set for the file to be backed up?

Input the password on the controller side. (For the second file or later, the automatic authentication is conducted using the last input password. Only when the automatic authentication has failed, inputting the password is required.)

Is the password correct?

File is backed up.

Is there any other file?

Is there any other units? (When a multiple CPU system is used)

Set the password for the backup/restoration using 32 characters or less (alphanumeric characters and symbols only).

Backup is completed.

Yes

Yes

No

No

Yes

Yes

For other than FXCPU

For FXCPU

If a keyword has been set, clear it.

Is there any other controller that is to be backed up?

(When a controller list file exists)

No

Yes

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 623

62

Setting a password To secure the security, using eight characters or more that cannot be easily guessed as the password for the backup/restoration is recommended. If the password is compromised, a system with the same configuration may be created. Pay full attention to manage the password. Keyword for the FXCPU To back up or restore data in the FXCPU, clear the keyword in advance. Page 633 Keyword operations

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

How to use the password for the backup/restoration The following shows the operation procedure of the backup after the password for the backup/restoration has been set. For details of the operation screen, refer to the following. Page 628 Display operation of backup and restoration

Backup

*1 For the details, refer to the following. Page 628 Display operation of backup and restoration

Start

Touch [Backup] on the main menu. (Second backup or later)*1

Input the password for the backup/restoration.

Automatic authentication is conducted using the password on the controller side saved in the backup setting (in units of files).

File is backed up.

Input the changed password on the controller side manually.

Backup is completed.

No

Yes (for other than FXCPU)

No

No

No

No

No

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Is there any password set for the file to be backed up?

Is there any other units? (When a multiple

CPU system is used)

Was the password on the controller side changed?

Is the password correct?

Is the password correct?

Is there any other file?

Set the password for the backup/restoration using 32 characters or less (alphanumeric characters and symbols only).

If a keyword has been set, clear it. Yes (for FXCPU)

Is there any other controller that is to be backed up?

(When a controller list file exists)

No

Yes

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 625

62

Precautions for backing up data after the password on the controller side has been changed When the password on the controller side is being input manually and inputting the password is canceled to stop the backup, all the files that have been backed up before the cancellation are discarded.

Restoration The following shows the operation procedure of the restoration after the password for the backup/restoration has been set.

*1 For the details, refer to the following. Page 628 Display operation of backup and restoration

Start

Touch [Restore] on the main menu.*1

Input the password for the backup/restoration.

Automatic authentication is conducted using the password on the controller side saved in the backup data.

Input the changed password on the controller side manually.

File is restored.

Restoration is completed.

No

Yes (for other than FXCPU)

No

No

No

No

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Is the password correct?

Is the password correct?

Is there any other file?

Is there any password set for the file to be restored?

Is there any other units? (When a multiple CPU system is used)

If a keyword has been set, clear it. When the PLC is not in the STOP status,

change its status to the STOP status.

Yes (for FXCPU)

Is there any other controller that is to be backed up?

(When a controller list file exists)

No

Yes

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Precautions for restoring data after the password on the controller side has been changed When the password on the controller side is being input manually and inputting the password is canceled to stop the restoration, only the files that have been restored before the cancellation are restored. When only a part of the files are restored, some data mismatch may occur in the whole system.

Restoration starts. When the password on the controller side has been changed, verify the password.

Inputting a password

ControllerSD card SD card

SD card

SD card

Controller

Controller

When inputting a password is canceled, the restoration will be canceled and only the files that have been restored before

the cancellation will be restored.

When the input password is correct, the restoration will be completed.

Mismatch

Controller

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2

File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

File 1 File 2 File 3

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 627

62

Display operation of backup and restoration

For a controller other than FXCPU, the [Keyword] switch is not displayed.

Main menu Main menu

Data control

Touch [Data].

Touch [Backup/ restore].

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Backup operation This section describes the backup operation screen. The screen operation procedure varies depending on the PLC CPU model used and whether or not passwords have been set. For details of the operating procedure, refer to the following. Page 622 Security and password

1. Touch [Backup].

2. Touch [Execute]. Touch operations on the switches ([CPU No.1], [CPU No.2], [CPU No.3], and [CPU No.4]) are invalid.

3. When the screen shown below appears, touch [YES].

4. When the screen shown below appears, touch [OK], and input a password using the key window.

5. If a password has been set for the program of the PLC CPU, the screen shown below appears. Touch [OK], and enter the password in the key window.

When inputting passwords have been finished, the backup processing will be executed.

6. The screen shown below will be displayed during execution.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 629

63

7. When the backup is completed, the screen shown below appears. Touch [OK].

For FXCPU, the following screen appears. Touch [OK] and input a password.

0 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Restoration operation This section describes the restoration operation screen. The screen operation procedure varies depending on the PLC CPU model used and whether or not passwords have been set. For details of the operating procedure, refer to the following. Page 622 Security and password

1. Touch [Restore].

2. Select a CPU No. to be restored from the switches ([CPU No.1], [CPU No.2], [CPU No.3], and [CPU No.4]). If the controller is FXCPU, touch operations on the switches ([CPU No.1], [CPU No.2], [CPU No.3], and [CPU No.4]) are invalid.

3. Touch [Excute].

4. When the screen shown below appears, touch [YES].

5. When the screen shown below appears, touch [OK], and input a password using the key window.

6. If a password has been set for the program of the PLC CPU, the screen shown below appears. Touch [OK], and enter the password in the key window.

When inputting passwords have been finished, the restoration processing will be executed.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 631

63

7. The screen shown below will be displayed during execution.

8. When the restoration is completed, the screen shown below appears. Touch [OK].

2 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Keyword operations When the connected FX series PLC is protected by a keyword, the keyword protection can be removed.

1. Touch [Keyword].

2. The screen shown below appears. Remove the protection for the FX series PLC. Page 472 Keyword

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 633

63

Errors and corrective actions

Common to backup and restoration

Backup

Problem Cause Corrective action Backup data cannot be found. Backup data has not been saved in the installed

SD card. An SD card is not on the drive specified as the storage location for backup settings.

Install an SD card in which the backup settings are saved. Check the utility for the storage location for backup data.

The input password is invalid and the backup/restoration cannot be executed.

The password was forgotten or the input password is incorrect.

Get the password for the backup data from the system or device administrator.

Format the SD card or install a new SD card, and perform the backup again.

The backup/restoration of an FXCPU sequence program cannot be performed.

The sequence program has been protected with a block password.

Clear the block password setting for the sequence program.

An error occurs in the communication with the controller during the backup/ restoration. The backup/restoration cannot be performed.

The communication settings or the communication driver of the GOT are incorrect.

Check if the communication settings or communication driver of the GOT are correct.

The GOT is not recognized because the controller's parameters are incorrect.

Check if the controller's parameters have been correctly set using a tool for the controller, such as GX Developer.

The controller is not powered on. Power on the controller.

Cables are not correctly connected. Check the cables.

Problem Cause Corrective action Backup data cannot be written to an SD card.

No SD card has been installed. Install an SD card in the drive specified as the storage location for the backup settings/backup data.

There is no available space on the SD card. Install an SD card that has sufficient space. Delete unnecessary files on the SD card.

The SD card is write protected. Enable writing data to the SD card. File attributes cannot be changed on the GOT. Change the attributes on a personal computer.

The drive does not exist. Check if the drive specified as the storage location for the backup settings/backup data exists (if an SD card has been installed).

Setting information (files/data) cannot be acquired from the controller.

There is a problem that prevents the communication with the controller.

Check the following settings. GOT side Are cables correctly connected? Has a correct communication driver been installed? Are communication settings correct?

Controller side Have parameters been set? Are cables correctly connected? Is the power on?

Since a password has been set to the file, the backup cannot be performed to the file.

The password was forgotten or the input password is incorrect (first backup). The file password has been changed.

Get the file password from the system or device administrator.

4 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration

15

Restoration Problem Cause Corrective action Setting information (files/data) cannot be written to the controller.

There is a problem that prevents the communication with the controller.

Check the following settings. GOT side Are cables correctly connected? Has a correct communication driver been installed? Are communication settings correct?

Controller side Have parameters been set? Are cables correctly connected? Is the power on?

The controller in the backup data and the actual controller are different.

Check if the selected backup data is for the target system. Check if the restoration target controller is the same controller

as the one used when the backup was performed or an equivalent.

Since a password has been set to the file, the restoration cannot be performed to the file.

The password of the file written in the controller has been changed.

Get the file password from the system or device administrator.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.8 Backup and Restoration 635

63

15.9 USB Device Management Only available to GT2107-W.

Function of the USB device management This function displays a list of the USB peripheral device connection status in the GOT. Also, this screen is used to remove the USB peripheral device from GOT.

Display operation of the USB device management

Main menu Data

USB device management

Touch [Data].

Touch [USB device].

6 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.9 USB Device Management

15

USB device status display operation 1. When a USB memory is installed, the [Stop] button is displayed in the [Attach] column. Touch the [Stop] button when removing the USB memory.

2. Touch the [Stop] button in the [Attach] column to display the following dialog. Touch the [YES] button to remove the USB peripheral device. Touch the [NO] button to cancel removing the USB device.

3. When the preparation of removal is ready, the dialog box shown below is displayed. To close the dialog box, touch the [OK] button.

1.

15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.9 USB Device Management 637

63

MEMO

8 15 CONTROL OF VARIOUS DATA 15.9 USB Device Management

16

16 DEBUG Page 639 Device Monitor Function Page 653 FX List Editor Page 683 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function The debug includes functions to check the PLC system status and to improve troubleshooting efficiency. The following is available as the debug.

16.1 Device Monitor Function For a controller connected to the GOT, forcibly turning on or off devices of the controller and changing the set value or present value are available.

System configuration This section describes the controller names and connection types between the GOT and a controller that are applicable to the device monitor function. For details of communication units and cables for each connection type, refer to the following manual. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual for GT Works3 Version1

Target controller

Item Description Reference Device monitor For a controller connected to the GOT, forcibly turning on or off devices of the

controller and changing the set value or present value are available. Page 639 Device Monitor Function

FX list editor The sequence program of the FXCPU can be changed. Page 653 FX List Editor

FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function

The communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP stored in the CPU can be changed.

Page 683 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function

Controller Connection type RCPU Ethernet connection, Serial communication connection

FX5CPU Ethernet connection, Direct CPU connection (serial)

QCPU (Q mode), LCPU Ethernet connection, Direct CPU connection (serial), Serial communication connection, CC-Link connection (via G4)

QnACPU Direct CPU connection (serial), Serial communication connection

ACPU, QCPU (A mode) Direct CPU connection (serial)

FXCPU Ethernet connection, Direct CPU connection (serial)

Inverter Inverter connection

Microcomputer Microcomputer connection (Ethernet), Microcomputer connection (Serial)

MODBUS MODBUS(R)/TCP connection, MODBUS(R)/RTU connection

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 639

64

Required system application

Checking method of the version of basic system application and communication driver Check the version of the basic system application and communication driver installed in the GOT at [System Application Information] of the utility. Refer to the following for details. Page 558 OS information

Devices that can be monitored For details on the device names that can be monitored and the scope of monitoring, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Precautions

Monitoring and testing real number data Real number data cannot be monitored and tested. All word devices containing real number data are monitored in integer data (binary data).

Monitoring devices in 32-bit (two-word) module When monitoring word devices (T, C, D, W, etc.) in 32-bit (two-word) module, those with 32 bits of data remaining are monitored. Devices with 16 bits (one-word) of data remaining are not monitored. If an odd number is specified for the first monitor device number, the last device number of the specified controller will not be displayed. (Example) When the data entry of the QnACPU is monitored in units of 32 bits from odd numbers (D1, D3...)

Setting the network No., station No., and CPU No. Setting of the network No., station No., and CPU No. may be required depending on the connection type. In this case, register the device after setting the network No., station No., and CPU No.

System application Version Basic system application -

- Communication driver Ethernet(MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC), Gateway -

Ethernet(FX), Gateway

MODBUS/TCP Master, Gateway

SERIAL(MELSEC)

MELSEC-A

MELSEC-FX -

CC-Link(G4) -

FREQROL 500/700/800, Sensorless servo

Microcomputer connection

MODBUS/RTU Master

D1017 D1018 D1019 D1020 D1021 D1022 D1023 (Device name)

Unit of monitor display Nothing displayed

0 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

Display operation of device monitor

GT2107-W

Device monitor

Debug

Channel Setting

Main menu

Touch [Debag].

Touch [Device monitor].

Select a channel.

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 641

64

GT2105-Q

Device monitor

Debug

Main Menu Main Menu

Touch [Debug].

Touch [Device monitor].

Select a channel.

Channel Setting

2 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

GT2104-R

Device monitor

Debug

Main Menu Main Menu

Touch [Debug].

Touch [Device monitor].

Select a channel.

Channel Setting

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 643

64

GT2104-P, GT2103-P

Device monitor

Main menu Main menu

Main menu

Debug

Touch [Debug].

Touch [Device monitor].

Select a channel.

Channel Setting

4 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

Information displayed on the device monitor screen and key functions

Device monitor screen The information displayed on the device monitor screen is described below.

No. Item Settings 1) Device name Displays the device name.

2) Device No. Displays the device number.

3) Bit device ON/OFF Timer/Counter contact ON/OFF

Displays ON/OFF information of bit devices and timer/counter contacts : ON

: OFF

4) Data type DW: Indicates that the device value is a 32-bit (two-word) module. Nothing displayed: Indicates that the device value is a 16-bit (one-word) module.

5) Present value of word device Present value and set value of timer/ counter*1

[Decimal number] 16-bit (one-word) module: Six digits (including a digit for a sign) are displayed. (Display example: -12345) 32-bit (two-word) module: Ten digits (including a digit for a sign) are displayed. (Display example: - 123456789) [Hexadecimal number] 16-bit (one-word) module: Four digits are displayed. (Display example: H AB12) 32-bit (two-word) module: Eight digits are displayed. (Display example: H ABCDE123)

6) Counting method Displays the counting method when registering the counters from C200 to C255. UP: Up count mode DOWN: Down count mode

7) Reset coil ON/OFF Displays the reset coil state when registering the timer/counter for the FXCPU. : ON

: OFF

8) Network No. Sets or displays the network No. when the PLC is on the network.

9) Station No. Sets or displays the station No. when the station No. is assigned to the PLC.

1) 2) 8) 9) 10)

4)

3)

5)

6)

7)

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 645

64

*1 When a timer or counter of the ACPU, QnACPU, or FXCPU is registered, the set value of the timer or counter is displayed.

Key functions The following table describes the key functions displayed on the device monitor screen.

10) CPU No. specification 0 to 4: This item must be set only when the GOT is connected to the Q series CPU in the multiple CPU system or QnUCPU. Changing the CPU No. cancels the registration for all the devices. Page 648 Device Monitor Function

Key switch Function DEV Switches the screen to the device registration key window for registering devices to be monitored.

Page 648 Device registration

TEST Switches the quick test mode between enabled and disabled states. Page 650 Quick test

DEC/HEX Switches the numerical notation of word device values between decimal and hexadecimal numbers.

CH1 or CH2 Switches the channel to be displayed.

Scrolls the data list up and down by one line and displays the devices before or after the device which is currently registered and placed in the top or bottom line.

: Scrolls the list up by one line to display the device number right before the device number displayed in the top line.

: Scrolls the list down by one line to display the device number right after the device number displayed in the bottom line.

Exits the device monitor, and then the screen returns to the debug screen.

No. Item Settings

6 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

Basic operation of device monitor The following explains basic operations of the device monitor.

*1 For the details, refer to the following. Page 648 Device registration

*2 For the details, refer to the following. Page 650 Quick test

With no registered device With registered devices

Register devices if necessary.*1

Execute the quick test if necessary.*2

Switch the numerical notation of word device values between decimal and hexadecimal numbers if necessary.

Debug

DEV TEST DEC

Touch [Device monitor].

Touch Touch Touch

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 647

64

Device registration The following explains the procedures for device registration.

For the keyboard operations, refer to the next page.

No. Item Settings 1) Data type 32: Indicates that the device value is a 32-bit (two-word) module.

Nothing displayed: Indicates that the device value is a 16-bit (one-word) module.

2) Device name Set the device name and device number to be monitored.

3) Device No.

When the GOT is connected with a Q series CPU in the multiple CPU system or QnUCPU

1)

When the GOT is connected with a CPU other than a Q series CPU in the multiple CPU system and QnUCPU

When multiple devices need to be registered, repeat the procedures.

Enter the CPU No. with the ten-key, and touch the ENT key.

Touch the key.DEV

Set 1) to 3) using the keyboard, and touch the ENT key. The device registration is completed.

Keyboard

Specify the CPU No. of the device to be registered when connecting the GOT to a Q series CPU in the multiple CPU system or QnUCPU.

Device monitor

Touch

Touch

Keyboard

2) 3)

8 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

Keyboard operations Keyboard functions

Input procedures

Precautions for device registration Data type Device monitor screens display the data type as shown below. DW: 32-bit (two-word) module Nothing displayed : 16-bit (one-word) module CPU No. specification Changing the CPU No. after registering devices cancels the registration for all the devices. Check the CPU No. before registering the devices. Station No. specification Changing the station No. after registering devices cancels the registration for all the devices. Check the station No. before registering the devices. N/W (Network) No. specification Changing the N/W No. after registering devices cancels the registration for all the devices. Check the N/W No. before registering the devices. Holding registered devices The registration for the devices is not canceled after exiting the device monitor. Restarting the GOT cancels the registration for all the devices. The number of registered devices The number of registered devices must be within the maximum number of devices that can be displayed on the GOT. For registering an additional device, the registration for the device in the top line is canceled and the additional device is displayed in the bottom.

Device name keyboard

Select a data type. [32]: Sets to the two-word. [16]: Sets to the one-word.

Ends the device registration. Deletes all input numbers. Registers the input device. (The device registration is completed.)

Displays other device names.

Device name keyboard

Input a device name. (Ex: D)

Select a data type. (Ex: 16 bits)

Input a device number. (Ex: 12)

Touch the [16] key.

Touch the [32] key.

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 649

65

Quick test

The quick test operation procedure for monitor devices is described below.

WARNING Before performing the quick test operations of device monitor (such as turning ON or OFF bit device, changing the word device current value, changing

the settings or current values of the timer or counter), read through the manual carefully and make yourself familiar with the operation method. During quick test operation, never change the data of the devices which are used to perform significant operation for the system. False output or malfunction can cause an accident.

Device monitor

Enable the quick test mode.

(1) Quick test of bit devices (2) Quick test of word devices

Touch

Check that the quick test operation is enabled.

0 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

Quick test of bit devices (Operation example) Change the status of the bit device M14 from OFF to ON .

The selected bit device is switched from (OFF) to (ON).

Touch .

Touch the bit device whose ON/OFF status is to be switched.

The device name and device number of the selected bit device are highlighted.

16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function 651

65

Quick test of word devices (Operation example) Change the device value of word device D200 from 43 to 100. Conditions: Data range: 16 bits, device value display format: decimal number

Touch the device value to be changed.

Input a device value using the keyboard. Input 100 in this operation example.

Touch the key.ENT

The device value of D200 is changed from 43 to 100.

2 16 DEBUG 16.1 Device Monitor Function

16

16.2 FX List Editor Available to GT2107-W, GT2105-Q, and GT2104-R. The MELSEC-FX list editor can change the sequence programs on the FX PLC. The following example explains about GT2104-R.

Display operation of FX list editor

GT2107-W

Cannel SettingFX list editor

DebugMain menu

Touch [Debag].

Touch [FX list editor].

Select a channel.

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 653

65

GT2105-Q, GT2104-R

Debug

Main Menu Main Menu

Touch [Debug].

Touch [FX list editor].

Cannel SettingFX list editor

Select a channel.

4 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Parameters and sequence programs are easy to maintain. You can check or partly correct, change or add FX PLC parameters and sequence programs simply by operating keys. You can easily edit sequence programs without preparing any peripheral unit other than the GOT.

Errors that occur during list editing can be checked easily. Error messages, error codes, and number of steps for errors that occur in the FX PLC can be checked. Details can be checked immediately even for errors that occur during list editing.

Commands and devices can be searched and displayed. Commands and devices used in sequence programs can be searched. The correction position can be searched for cases such as when you want to correct a specific device.

Changed

(Example of changing sequence program commands)

LD X000 OUT Y020 LD X001

LD X000 OUT Y030 LD X001

Searched device M800

Displays the searched device.

LD M 800 OUT T 10

K 100 LD X 002

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 655

65

Specifications

System configuration This section describes the system configuration of the MELSEC-FX list editor. For the setting method in each connection form, used communication unit/cable and cautions on connection form, refer to the following manual. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual For GT Works3 Version1

Controllers that can be edited with the MELSEC-FX list editor

*1 FX list editor is not applicable to for MELSEC iQ-F series.

Connection type This function can be used in the following connection types. (: Applicable, : Partly restricted, : Inapplicable)

*1 MELSEC-FX list editor cannot be used when using CC-Link IE field network Ethernet adapter. *2 Available only when using FX3 series.

Target controller*1

FX CPU

Function Connection type between GOT and PLC

Name Description Direct CPU connection (serial) Ethernet connection*1

MELSEC-FX list editor Sequence program writing, parameter setting, PLC diagnostics and keyword registration, etc.

*2

6 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Functions list and monitor conditions The following shows the memory that can be monitored by the MELSEC-FX list editor and the FX PLC status conditions. (: Can be monitored : Can be monitored under certain conditions : Cannot be monitored)

*1 The operation is available only when the protect switch is OFF. *2 The available memory differs depending on the FX PLC being used.

For details, refer to the following. The hardware manual of the FX PLC being used

Access range For the FXCPU in Ethernet connection, the GOT can monitor only the host station. The access range other than the above is the same as the access range when the GOT is connected to a controller. For details of the access range, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Product) For GT Works3 Version1

Function Memory that can be monitored *2 FX PLC status

Reference

Built-in memory

RAM memory cassette

EEPROM memory cassette, flash memory cassette

EPROM memory cassette

Reading sequence programs

Displaying sequence programs

RUN/STOP Page 665 Displaying sequence programs

Searching commands/devices

Page 667 Searching commands/devices

Writing sequence programs

Writing commands *1 For Stop only Page 669 Writing commands

Changing operands/set values

Page 672 Changing operands, set values

Inserting commands Page 669 Writing commands

Deleting commands Page 673 Deleting commands

Sequence program all clear Page 674 Sequence program all clear

PLC diagnostics RUN/STOP Page 675 PLC diagnostics

Parameter setting Display Page 676 Parameter setting

Setting *1 For Stop only

Keyword RUN/STOP Page 678 Keyword

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 657

65

Precautions

Using other peripheral equipment for sequence program/parameter change When using the MELSEC-FX list editor, do not change programs or parameters in the PLC CPU from other peripheral equipment. If programs or parameters are changed, exit the MELSEC-FX list editor once and start the MELSEC-FX list editor again. If the program on one PLC is changed carelessly from multiple units of peripheral equipment (including GOT), the contents of the program in the PLC CPU and the peripheral equipment may not be the same, resulting in an unintended operation of the PLC CPU.

Sequence program change Stop the FX PLC before changing (writing, inserting, deleting) a sequence program or changing parameters. Operation is not possible with the FX PLC running.

If you press the [GO] key but the system does not proceed to the next operation (for example, a search) Check the input contents (applied instruction number, device value, etc.).

When using list monitor Only devices to be used for basic instructions can be monitored. The status of devices (word, bit) to be used for application instructions cannot be monitored.

8 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Display operation

Operation to display The following describes the outline for displaying the operation screen of the MELSEC-FX list editor.

*1 For information on how to set a special function switch, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

*2 For details on the operation method, refer to the following. Page 678 Keyword

Start

Turn on the power to the GOT.

The MELSEC-FX list editor is started.

Display the utility. Touch the special function switch. *1

Starting from the utility Starting from the special function switch (MELSEC-FX list editor) set in the project data

End

Enter the keyword. *2

After the utility is displayed, touch [Debug] [MELSEC-FX List editor] from the main menu.

When no keyword is registered in the connected FX PLC

When a keyword is registered in the connected FX PLC

Set the Channel No.

Set the channel number of the controller targeted to the MELSEC-FX list editor.

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 659

66

How to display the utility For how to display the utility, refer to the following. Page 423 Utility Function List If the project data has not been downloaded The MELSEC-FX list editor can be started from the utility even if the project data has not been downloaded to the GOT.

0 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Changing screens This section describes how to change the screen.

*1 With setting special function switches (FX list monitor), the list monitor can be started on the monitor screen. When the list monitor is started on the monitor screen, the list editor cannot be used. For how to set special function switches, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Utility Main Menu or

user-created monitor screen

Start

Communication setting window

[ChNo.]

[PLC diagnostics]

[Parameter setting]

MORE

MORE

CLR OP

GO

[Keyword setup]

[List Monitor]

OP

CLR

GO

GO

GO

*1

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 661

66

Operation procedures This section describes the contents of the MELSEC-FX list editor and the key functions displayed on the screen.

Key arrangement and a list of key functions The arrangement and functions of the keys displayed on the MELSEC-FX List Editor window are described below.

Displayed contents

No. Item Display contents 1) Channel No. Displays the currently selected channel number.

Touching "ChNo." displays the communication setting window. The communication setting window is not displayed if the MELSEC-FX list editor is started from the FX ladder monitor.

2) Mode Displays a mode for MELSEC-FX list editor. Page 664 Selection and operation of modes [Monitor] is displayed when the list monitor is executed. Page 680 List monitor

3) Error message Displays the contents of errors that occur with the MELSEC-FX list editor. Page 682 Error messages and corrective actions

4) List display area Displays the sequence program in list format (12 digits). The position (line) that can be edited is displayed with a bar.

5) Key area Displays the keys that can be used with the MELSEC-FX list editor.

4)

1)

5)

3)

2)

2 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Key functions The table below shows the functions of the keys that are used for the operation on the MELSEC-FX list editor screen.

Keyboard switching Touching the MORE button switches the command keyboard 1 and command keyboard 2. When you touch the button for a keyboard function, the optimum keyboard for input for that function is displayed automatically.

Key Function Displays the currently selected channel number. The communication setting window is not displayed if the MELSEC-FX list editor is started from the FX ladder monitor.

Selects a mode for MELSEC-FX list editor. Page 664 Selection and operation of modes

Displays the PLC diagnostics, parameter setting, and keyword selection menu.

Switches between command keyboard 1 and command keyboard 2. Page 663 Keyboard switching

When inputting commands: Cancels the key input when only part of the command has been input. Page 682 Action for an incorrect key input When option menu is displayed: Closes the option menu. Commands cannot be deleted with this key. Page 673 Deleting commands

Space key. This key is used when setting timers and counters, writing applied commands, etc.

Displays the list from a specified step number when the step number is input.

Moves the list display area bar up and down and switches the line being edited.

Determines the key operation.

Inputs commands, device names, etc. The key contents depend on the input contents. The commands that can be used differ depending on the target FX PLC. Refer to the manual for the FX PLC to be used.

Exits the MELSEC-FX list editor.

,

, etc.

Touch

Touch

Command keyboard 1 Command keyboard 2

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 663

66

Selection and operation of modes The MELSEC-FX list editor has four modes: READ, WRITE, INSERT, and DELETE. Select an appropriate mode for the intended operation. For details on the operation method, refer to the following. Page 665 Displaying sequence programs Page 667 Searching commands/devices Page 669 Writing commands Page 672 Changing operands, set values Page 673 Deleting commands Page 674 Sequence program all clear Page 675 PLC diagnostics Page 676 Parameter setting Page 678 Keyword Page 680 List monitor Page 682 Action for an incorrect key input Page 682 Error messages and corrective actions

How to change modes Touch the MODE button. Each time you touch this button, the mode changes.

In the case the mode cannot be changed In the following cases, the mode can be changed to the READ mode only. If you try to change to other than READ mode, an error message is displayed. To change to other than READ mode, take the action below.

Error message Cause Corrective action PLC is running The FX PLC is in the RUN status. Stop the FX PLC.

Can not write. The protect switch of the EEPROM memory cassette is on. Switch off the protect switch of the EEPROM memory cassette.

The EPROM memory cassette is enabled. Set a memory other than EPROM as the memory to write to.

Touch the button.

The current mode is displayed.

4 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Displaying sequence programs Sequence programs are read from the FX PLC to the GOT and displayed. There are two displaying methods: specifying the step number, and scrolling one screen at a time.

Display using cursor keys Operation

Example Scroll one line upward or downward.

Display specifying the step number Operation

Example Displaying step number 123.

When the specified step number is the operand of an applied instruction If the specified step number is a timer (T) or counter (C) set value or the operand of an applied instruction, that command section is displayed at the head.

Scroll with OR

128 MPP

129 DIV 23

D56

K200

128 MPP

129 DIV 23

D56

K200

128 MPP

129 DIV 23

D56

K200

Scrolling one line upward Scrolling one line downward

STEP GOInput the step number.

STEP

GO

Input the step number

Step number

0 LD X 000

1 OUT Y 000

2 LDI M 100

3 MOV 12

123 MOV 12

K 200

D 58

128 MPP

123

3 MOV 12

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 665

66

Display scrolling one screen at a time Operation

Example Displaying with scrolling one screen at a time.

MODE GO

(Read mode)

MODE

GO

Set the READ mode.

Displaying with scrolling

one screen at a time.

123 MOV 12

K 200

D 58

128 MPP

< WRITE >

< READ >

6 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Searching commands/devices Displays a command or device by searching it in sequence program from Step 0.

Command search Operation

*1 If the command you want to search for is not on the keyboard, touch the key to switch to the other keyboard. When searching for an applied instruction, touch the key and input the applied instruction number. When searching for a label, touch or and input the pointer number. Page 669 Writing commands

*2 Input only when searching for commands requiring a device name and device number. *3 After the search results are displayed, you can continue searching with the same conditions by touching the key. Touching any key

other than the key ends the search.

Example Searching for LD M8000

Pointer (P, I) searches For pointer searches, only labels are searched. Pointers specified as operands in applied instructions are not searched.

MODE

(Read mode)

*1 *2 *3

Select the command to search for.

Input the device name and device number.

GO GO

MORE FNC

P I

GO GO

M 8 0 0 0 GO

GO (Continue to search with the same conditions)

MODE

LD

< WRITE >

< READ >

Search command

Select the command to search for.( )

Set the READ mode.

3 MOV 12

8 LD M 8000

9 OUT T 10

K 100

12 LD X 002

24 LD M 8000

25 OUT T 0

K 100

28 OUT T 1

LD

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 667

66

Device search Operation

*1 After the search results are displayed, you can continue searching with the same conditions by touching the key. Touching any key other than the key ends the search.

Example Searching for LD M8000

Devices that cannot be searched The following devices cannot be searched. Pointers, interrupt pointers Constant K, constant H, constant E Digit specification of bit device Special function unit/block buffer memory Devices specified with the operand of an applied instruction Pointers and interrupt pointers can be searched for with command searches. Page 667 Command search

* 1

MODE SP GO GO Input the device name and device number.

(Read mode)

GO GO

GO (Continue to search with the

same conditions)

GO

MSP 8 0 0 0

MODE

Search device

Set the

READ mode.

3 MOV 12

8 LD M 8000

9 OUT T 10

K 100

12 LD X 002

24 LD M 8000

25 OUT T 0

K 100

28 OUT T 1

M8000< WRITE >

< READ >

8 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Writing commands Writes a sequence program to the FX PLC. (Overwrite/Insert)

Writing basic commands Operations Inputting command only (Ex.: ANB, ORB command etc.)

Inputting command and device (LD, AND commands etc.)

Inputting command, No. 1 device, No. 2 device (MC, OUT (T, C) commands, etc.)

Moving the cursor to the position to write the command When starting to write a command, place the cursor on the command line (the line on which the step number is displayed). You cannot write a command with the cursor on an operand or set value line.

MODE GOStop the FX PLC Input the command

For overwriting: (WRITE mode)

For insertion: (INSERT mode)

MODE

GO

Stop the FX PLC

Input the device name and device number

Input the command

For overwriting: (WRITE mode)

For insertion: (INSERT mode)

GOSP

MODEStop the FX PLC Input the device name and device numberInput the command

For overwriting: (WRITE mode)

For insertion: (INSERT mode)

Input the device name and device number

Command line (Place the cursor on this line.)

Operand, set value line (Cannot operate on this line.)

2 LDI M 100

3 MOV 12

D 0

D 10

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 669

67

Example Writing ORB command

Inputting LD X000

Inputting OUT T100 K19

ORB GO

MODE

Set the WRITE or INSERT mode

With or , move the cursor to the position to overwrite/insert the command.

Stop the FX PLC

4 LDI X 004 5 AND X 005 6 NOP 7 NOP

4 LDI X 004 5 AND X 005 6 ORB 7 NOP

< READ >

< WRITE >

0XLD GO

MODE

Set the

WRITE or

INSERT

mode.

Stop the FX PLC

0 NOP

1 NOP

2 NOP

3 NOP

0 LD X 000

1 NOP

2 NOP

3 NOP

< READ >

< WRITE >

With or , move the

cursor to the position to

overwrite/insert the command.

OUT

SP K 19 GO

100T

100 OUT M 100

101 NOP

102 NOP

103 NOP

100 OUT M 100

101 OUT T 100

103 NOP

100 OUT M 100

101 OUT T 100

K 19

104 NOP

MODE

< READ >

< WRITE >

With or , move the

cursor to the position to

overwrite/insert the command.

Set the

WRITE or

INSERT

mode.

Stop the FX PLC

0 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Writing applied instructions Operation

*1 (double word command) and (pulse execution format command) can also be input after the applied instruction number is input. *2 Inputting in the order is also possible. *3 When a command specifies multiple devices for operations, input the key followed by the device name and device number.

Moving the cursor to the position to write the command When starting to write a command, place the cursor on the command line (the line on which the step number is displayed). You cannot write a command with the cursor on any other line.

Commands using a text string constant for a command operand (such as ASC command) With the MELSEC-FX list editor, text string constants cannot be written as operands. (such as ASC commands) Use GX Developer for writing such commands.

Example Input "DMOVP D0 D2".

Applied instruction number

*1

*1

*2

Stop the FX PLC

Input the device name and device number.

MODE

P SP GO

FNC D

For overwriting: (WRITE mode)

For insertion: (INSERT mode)

D P P D

2 LDI M 100

3 MOV 12

D 0

D 10

Command line (Place the cursor on this line.)

Operand, set value line (Cannot operate on this line.)

SPD 1 2 P

SPD 0 D 2 GO

MODE

FNC

200 NOP

201 NOP

202 NOP

203 NOP

200 FNC

201 NOP

202 NOP

203 NOP

200 DMOVP 12

203 NOP

200 DMOVP 12

D 0

D 2

209 NOP

*1

< READ >

< WRITE >

Set the

WRITE or

INSERT

mode.

With or , move the

cursor to the position to

overwrite/insert the command.

Stop the FX PLC

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 671

67

Changing operands, set values Changes the operand section of an applied instruction and OUT (T, C) command set value.

Operation

*1 For decimal numbers, input K, then the number. For hexadecimal numbers, input H, then the number.

Moving the cursor to the line on which the operand or set value is to be changed When starting to change an operand or a set value, place the cursor on the line of the operand or set value to be changed (the line on which the step number is not displayed). If you place the cursor on the command line, the input operation is not possible.

Example Changing "MOV D0 D10" to "MOV D0 D123"

MODE SP GO

(Read mode)

Stop the FX PLC Input the device name and device number

D 1 2 3SP GO

MODE

3 MOV 12

D 0

D 10

8 LD M 10

3 MOV 12

D 0

D 123

8 LD M 10

< READ >

< WRITE >

Set the

WRITE

mode.

Stop the FX PLC

Move the cursor to the changed

location with or

2 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Deleting commands Deletes one command at a time from a sequence program.

Operation

When moving the cursor to the position where the command is to be deleted Place the cursor on the command line (the line on which the step number is displayed). You cannot delete the command if the cursor is placed on the line of an operand or set value.

Example Deleting "OUT T10 K100"

MODE GOStop the FX PLC Move the cursor to the command to be deleted.

(DELETE mode)

GO

8 LD M 10

9 OUT T 10

K 100

12 LD X 002

8 LD M 10

9 LD X 002

10 OR X 020Z1

13 AND D 1500.F

MODE

STEP

Set the

DELETE

mode.

Move the cursor to the command to be

deleted with , or the key.

< READ >

Stop the FX PLC

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 673

67

Sequence program all clear Clears all the sequence programs.

Operation

Example Clears all the sequence programs.

Items cleared when All Clear for a sequence program is performed When All Clear is executed, the parameters before program execution are initialized and Latch Clear is executed. The memory space becomes the default value, the comment area a 0 block, the file register space a 0 block, and keywords unregistered. After All Clear, set the above parameters etc. again.

(WRITE mode)

MODE NOP A GOStop the FX PLC

MODE OK

OK

Cancel

NOP

A GO

! Caution

The program will be erased.

Press "OK" to continue.

0 NOP

1 OUT Y 000

2 LDI M 100

3 MOV 12

0 NOP

1 NOP

2 NOP

3 NOP

< WRITE >

< READ >

Stop the FX PLC

Set the

WRITE

mode.

4 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

PLC diagnostics Displays the FX PLC error message, error code, and step at which the error occurred.

Operation

PLC diagnostics screen The following describes the contents displayed on the PLC diagnostics screen and the function of on-screen key.

Displayed contents

Error details For details of the FX PLC errors, refer to the following. Programming manual for the FXCPU used

Key function The table below shows the functions of the keys that are used for the operation on the PLC diagnostics screen.

No. Item Display contents 1) Error message Displays the error message. (I/O configuration error/PLC hardware error/PC/HPP communication error/Serial communication

error/Parameter error/Syntax error/Circuit error/Operation error)

2) Detail Displays the error code.

3) Step Displays the step number in the sequence program at which the error occurred. (This is displayed only for a syntax error, circuit error, or operation error.)

Key Function Exits the PLC diagnostics.

OP

GO

FX list editor

Select [PLC diagnostics] with or

1) 2) 3)

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 675

67

Parameter setting Sets FX PLC parameters.

Parameters that can be changed and change targets Parameters that can be changed The parameters that can be changed with the MELSEC-FX list editor and the target FX PLCs are as follows. : Can be set/changed : Cannot be set/changed

*1 When connecting an FX0(S), set "0". Setting other than "0" causes a parameter error. *2 When the parameters are initialized, the display on the MELSEC-FX list editor is different from the FX PLC default values, but do not

change the latch range. Changing the latch range causes an error.

Change targets When a memory cassette is mounted, the parameters in the memory cassette are targeted for changes.

Operation

*1 When checking parameters (not changing), it is not necessary to stop the PLC.

Item Target CPU

FX0(S)/ FX0N

FX1 FX2(C) FX1S FX1N(C) FX2N(C) FX3S FX3G(C) FX3U(C)

Memory space setting

File register space setting *1

Latch range setting *2 *2 *2

RUN terminal setting

Initialization of parameters

*1 Stop the FX PLC

OP

GO

FX list editor

Select [Parameter setting] with or

6 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Parameter setting screen The following describes the contents displayed on the PLC diagnostics screen and the function of on-screen key.

Displayed contents

Memory space for kana comments after changing memory space, file register space If the memory space is set smaller than the total of the file register space and kana comment space, the kana comment space is automatically reduced. (With the MELSEC-FX list editor, the kana comment space is not displayed.) Note that if any setting as described below is made, the kana comment space is reduced. (Settings that reduce kana comment space and the kana comment space after setting change) Settings resulting in Nm < Nf 500 + Nk 500 + 500

Nm: Memory space after change (steps) Nf: File register space after change (blocks) Nk: Comment space before change (blocks) Settable range and default value The settable range and the default value depend on the FX PLC type. For details of the settable range and the default value, refer to the following. Programming manual for the FXCPU used

Key functions The table below shows the functions of the keys that are used for the operation on the parameter setting screen.

No. Item Display contents 1) Memory capacity Sets the memory space (number of steps).

If you touch the section , you can change the memory space.

2) File reg. capacity Sets the memory space (number of blocks) allocated to the file register. Touch the section and input the number of blocks.

3) Latch range Sets the latch range (power failure hold area). Touch the number display section and input the value.

4) RUN terminal input Sets whether or not to use one of the FX PLC input terminals for RUN input. Touch the section and set the device to be set for the RUN terminal.

5) Default Initializes the parameters

Key Function Initializes the parameters

Completes the changed setting contents.

Ends parameter setting.

1) 2) 3)

4)

5)

Kana comment space (steps) after setting change = 500

Nm-Nf 500-500

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 677

67

Keyword Registers, deletes, releases protection for, and sets protection for the FX PLC keywords.

Function usability of the MELSEC-FX list editor for keyword protection levels The functions that can be used with the MELSEC-FX list editor depend on the keyword protection level. : Available, : Unavailable

*1 When the 2nd keyword is set to an FX PLC that supports 2nd keyword, it becomes " " (cannot be used). *2 The names within the parentheses ( ) are for when a keyword + 2nd keyword is set.

Operation

Function Keyword protection level Reference

All operation protect(All on- line operation protect)*2

Read/Incorrect write protection (Read/write protect)*2

Erroneous write prohibition(Write protect)*2

Keyword not registered/ keyword protection canceled

Reading sequence programs

Displaying sequence programs

Page 665 Displaying sequence programs

Searching commands/devices

Page 667 Searching commands/devices

Writing sequence programs

Writing commands Page 669 Writing commands

Changing operands/ set values

Page 673 Deleting commands

Inserting commands Page 669 Writing commands

Deleting commands Page 673 Deleting commands

Sequence program all clear Page 674 Sequence program all clear

PLC diagnostics *1 Page 675 PLC diagnostics

Parameter setting Page 676 Parameter setting

OP

GO

FX list editor

Select [Keyword setup] with or

8 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Keyword screen and protection level When [Keyword setup] is selected with the MELSEC-FX list editor, the keyword screen is displayed. For the keyword operation, refer to the following. Page 472 Keyword

Keywords For details of the keyword, refer to the following. Programming manual for the FXCPU used

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 679

68

List monitor The status of contacts and coils in a sequence program is displayed.

Operation

Starting list monitor with special function switches (FX list monitor) With setting special function switches (FX list monitor), the list monitor can be started on the monitor screen. When the list monitor is started on the monitor screen, the list editor cannot be used. For how to set special function switches, refer to the following. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

OP

GO

FX list editor

Select [List Monitor] with or

When the list monitor is started on the FX list editor screen, the step numbers displayed on the FX list editor screen is displayed on the list monitor screen.

0 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

Displays and key functions The following describes the displays for the list monitor.

*1 The status of contacts and coils is displayed as below.

No. Item Display contents 1) List display area*1 The status of contacts and coils is displayed on the left of device displays.

2) Keys The same operations as in the READ mode of the FX list editor can be executed. Page 665 Displaying sequence programs

3) [] Ends the list monitor. (When the list monitor is executed on the FX list editor screen, the screen is switched to the FX list editor screen.)

Type of instruction Description Status

Displayed Not displayed LD, AND, OR (Contact instruction (Normal open)) Contact ON OFF

LDI, ANI, ORI (Contact instruction (Normal close)) Contact OFF ON

OUT, SET TC: Coil ON OFF

Except TC: Contact ON OFF

RST TC: Reset ON OFF

Word device Value: 0 Value: Except 0

Except TC and word device: Contact

OFF ON

MC, STL Contact ON OFF

LDP, ANDP, ORP, LDF, ANDF, ORF (Rise or fall contact instruction)

Not monitored Always not displayed

2)

1)

3)

16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor 681

68

Action for an incorrect key input If an incorrect key is input, cancel the input contents.

Operations Before touching the key (before reading/writing the input contents) Before touching the key, touch the key.

After touching the key (after reading/writing the input contents) Write the command again. Page 669 Writing commands Commands finalized by writing and inserting operations are revised (overwritten) with the program writing.

Error messages and corrective actions This section describes the error messages displayed when the MELSEC-FX list editor is executed, and corrective action.

How to erase an error message An error message is not erased even if the cause of the error is eliminated. To erase an error message, touch a key on the MELSEC-FX list editor screen.

Error message Description Corrective action Can not display while protected. The all-operation protect, anti-plagiarism, or

incorrect write protect keyword is set. Check the protected operation. Clear the keyword protection or delete the keyword. Page 678 Keyword

Can not operate while protected.

PLC parameter error. An FX PLC parameter is defective. Set correct parameters in the FX PLC.

PLC communications error. The communication with the FX PLC is defective. Check the FX PLC, cable, and GOT for abnormality. Check whether the communication settings are correct or not.

PLC is running. A writing operation etc. has been made while the FX PLC is running.

Stop the FX PLC.

Can not write. The memory to write to is EPROM. The protect switch of the EEPROM is on.

Set other than EPROM for the memory to write to. Switch off the protect switch of the EEPROM.

Step number is out of a range. The specified step number exceeded the maximum number.

Specify a step number below the maximum value.

Not found. The specified command cannot be found. Proceed to the next operation.

Not found. The specified device cannot be found. Proceed to the next operation.

Step overflow. The program may exceed the available space. (Writing is not executed.)

Check the program memory space and delete commands to keep it within the space. Page 673 Deleting commands

Command error. An invalid command (non-existent command) was specified.

Input the correct command.

Protected by a block password. The sequence program is protected by a block password at the PLC reading.

Release the block password for the sequence program.

GO GO CLR

GO

2 16 DEBUG 16.2 FX List Editor

16

16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function In GX Works2, the communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP stored in the CPU can be changed. This function is not available when the communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP is not set in advance in the CPU.

Communication setting in the CPU In GX Works2, set in advance the communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP to the CPU. For the details of the communication setting, refer to the following. FX3U-ENET-ADP User's manual Connection type for the FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function This function can be used only when the connection between the GOT and FXCPU is the direct CPU connection (serial). GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Product)

Specifications

System configuration This section describes the system configuration of the FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function. Refer to the following for details. GOT2000 Series Connection Manual

Required basic system application

Connection type (: Applicable, : Partly restricted, : Inapplicable)

Communication setting items The table below shows the communication setting items and setting range.

*1 Set the value "0.0.0.0" when not using the subnet mask pattern and default router IP address.

OS Version Basic system application -

Communication driver MELSEC-FX -

Function Connection type between GOT and controlle

Name Description Direct CPU connection (serial)

GOT multi-drop connection

FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function

The communication set value of the FX3U-ENET- ADP stored in the CPU can be changed.

Communication setting items Setting range Remark IP address 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254 If a value outside the setting range is entered, the error message "SET

NUMBER IS INCORRECT." appears.Subnet mask pattern*1 192.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.252

Default router IP address*1 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254

16 DEBUG 16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function 683

68

Display operation of FX3U-ENET-ADP communication setting function

When the communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP has not been stored in the CPU

When reading from the CPU is protected by the keyword

When the communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP has been stored in the CPU

Main menu Main menu

Main menu

Debug

Channel setting

Touch [FX3U-ENET-ADP].

Set a channel.Touch OK.

Touch OK.

Touch .

Touch [Debug].

4 16 DEBUG 16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function

16

Setting operation 1. Touch the numerical part of the octet to be changed among the 1st to 4th octets.

2. When the numeric pad appears, enter a numerical value in up to three digits, and touch the [ENT] key.

If a numerical value outside the setting range is entered, the following error message appears. Enter a numerical value again.

For the details of the setting range, refer to the following. Page 683 Specifications

3. The changed IP address is displayed. At this time, the changed communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP is not written to the CPU. Touch the [] key.

4. The following screen appears, then touch the [YES] key.

5. When the screen shown below appears, the changed communication set value of the FX3U-ENET-ADP is written normally to the CPU.

To validate the setting, power off the CPU, and then power it on. Change the setting of the subnet mask pattern and default router IP address using the same procedure if necessary. An error message appears in the following cases. Touch the [OK] key to return to step 1, and perform the setting again.

Touch the numerical part of the octet to be changed.

Touch

Touch .

Touch YES.

16 DEBUG 16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function 685

68

When the CPU is running The following error message appears. Stop the running status of the CPU.

When a communication error occurs Set the communication between the GOT and the CPU to the normal status.

When the memory cassette is write-protected Set to OFF the write-protect switch of the memory cassette.

When writing to the CPU is protected by the keyword Clear the protection by the keyword against writing.

When the CPU stores the symbolic information When the setting such as IP address is changed using this function and then the program is read by the programming tool from the CPU that stores the symbolic information, the following warning appears. However, the changed value is read correctly. Convert and compile the project again.

6 16 DEBUG 16.3 FX3U-ENET-ADP Communication Setting Function

17

17 MAINTENANCE Page 687 Touch Panel Calibration Page 690 Touch Panel Check Page 692 Clean

17.1 Touch Panel Calibration

Touch panel calibration setting function Touch panel reading error can be corrected. Normally the adjustment is not required, however, the difference between a touched position and the object position may occur as the period of use elapses. When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, correct the position with this function.

Run Stop Run Stop

Before adjustment After adjustment

The [Run] will operate though you intended to touch the [Stop] button.

The [Stop] button can be touched without fail.

17 MAINTENANCE 17.1 Touch Panel Calibration 687

68

Touch panel calibration setting display operation

Main menu Main menu

Calibration

Main menu

Touch [Maintenance].

Touch [Calibration].

8 17 MAINTENANCE 17.1 Touch Panel Calibration

17

Touch panel calibration operation Touch [+] displayed on the screen with the finger one by one to make the setting.

1. Touch the center of [+] displayed on the upper left precisely.

2. Touch [+] displayed on the lower left.

3. Touch [+] displayed on the upper right.

4. Touch [+] displayed on the lower right.

5. Step 4 completes the calibration process, and the [Maintenance] window will reappear.

Touch panel calibration error If touch panel calibration results in inoperability of the panel, the following message will appear.

[YES] button: Returns to the touch panel calibration screen. [NO] button: Aborts calibration without saving any changes to the touch panel setting.

17 MAINTENANCE 17.1 Touch Panel Calibration 689

69

17.2 Touch Panel Check

Touch panel check function The touch panel check function checks if there is any dead zone area.

Display operation of Touch panel check

Notes on Touch panel check If the touched part is not color-filled, there are the following two possible causes. 1. Display part failure 2. Touch panel failure In that case, contact your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service.

Main menu Main menu

Touch panel check

Main menu

Touch [Maintenance].

Touch [Panel check].

0 17 MAINTENANCE 17.2 Touch Panel Check

17

Touch panel check operations If touching [Panel check] of self-check, a black-filled screen is displayed over the entire screen area.

1. Touch a part of the screen. The touched part becomes a color-filled display as shown below. Yellow: GT2107-W, GT2105-QTBDS, GT2104-R White: GT2104-P, GT2103-P Gray: GT2105-QMBDS Up to 40 parts become color-filled displays.

2. If [] on the upper right is touched, the screen returns to the self-check.

Checking the upper right part of the screen Only the upper right part of the screen cannot be color-filled. If the screen returns to the maintenance by touching the upper right part, judge that the upper right area operates normally.

Black-filled screen

White color

17 MAINTENANCE 17.2 Touch Panel Check 691

69

17.3 Clean In utility, the screen can be set as not to be effected by touching the screen when clean with clothes. For cleaning method, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's manual (Hardware) 9. MAINTENANCE AND INSPECTION

Display operation of clean

Display operation of clean 1. Touching the [] key closes the screen. Even if touch points other than the upper left corner and upper right corner of the

screen, the GOT does not operates.

For details of cleaning method, refer to the following. GOT2000 Series User's manual (Hardware) 9. MAINTENANCE AND INSPECTION

Main menu Main menu

Clean

Main menu

Touch [Maintenance].

Touch [Clean].

Touch

2 17 MAINTENANCE 17.3 Clean

18

18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION Page 694 Preparation before Installation Page 695 Installation Using Data Storage To execute the GOT utility, install the BootOS and system applications on the C drive (built-in flash memory) of the GOT, or set the boot drive of the package data to [A:SD card] and insert an SD card with the package data into the GOT. (BootOS is installed in the GOT at factory shipment. It is not necessary to install BootOS when upgrading of it is unnecessary.) This chapter explains the installation using GOT.

*1 When execute installation with a USB memory, the system applications have to be installed in GOT in advance. The GT2105-Q, GT2104-R, GT2104-P, and GT2103-P do not support the USB memory.

Refer to the following for the installation which uses GT Designer3. GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual The following BootOS and system application are necessary to execute the utility. BootOS Operating system required for control of the GOT and communication between the personal computer and the GOT It is installed at factory shipment. (BootOS can be installed from GT Designer3, or the SD card. When the installation has completed, the GOT is initialized to be the factory shipment status. Also, the basic system applications must be pre-installed in the GOT when the BootOS is installed again.) Basic system application System application required for the GOT operations including the monitoring function, installation and deletion of the system application or project data, touch key control, and display of the screen, guidance, user-created screen, and utility screen. It is not installed in the GOT at factory shipment. Install it from GT Designer3 or the data storage.

When GOT is remote, installed easily using a data storage

The GOT can starts without a system application installed.

Install the SD card in GOT

Install the SD card in GOT

Set the OS boot drive to [A:Built-in SD card].

Install a data storage in the GOT.Data storage

Install from GOT to GOT using a data storage.

SD card

BootOS or system application installation

BootOS or system application installation

Data storage

GOT

*1

*1

GT Designer3 Data storage GOT

GOT Data storage GOT

Write system

application

Write system

application

System application

upload

GT Designer3

GOT

GOT

GOT

18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 693

69

18.1 Preparation before Installation For the installation using GOT, the data storage that is storing BootOS or the system application is required. There are the following three methods for the installation of BootOS and system application.

[To Memory Card] from GT Designer3 GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Uploading from another GOT (the package data has been installed) Page 696 Installation Using Data Storage

Using an SD card that stores data with OS boot drive set to A drive GT Designer3 (GOT2000) Screen Design Manual

Precautions when installing BootOS and the package data into an SD card When installing BootOS and the package data into the SD card, be sure to execute by the utility of another GOT or GT Designer3. The installation is not executed properly with the SD card to which data is uploaded from the utility of GOT or copied by software other than GT Designer3. Note the available capacity of the SD card. The available capacity of BootOS and system applications can be confirmed by [To Memory Card] or [Write Option] of GT Designer3.

Write Option

Available space of the data

Available space of the system application

4 18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 18.1 Preparation before Installation

18

18.2 Installation Using Data Storage There are the following two types for the installation of BootOS and system applications using a data storage.

Installing when starting the GOT Page 695 Installing when starting the GOT All the system applications and project data stored in the data storage are transferred to the GOT when powering on the GOT. This installing method is effective in the following cases. The GOT utility cannot be displayed. The system application is not installed.

Installing using the data control function (Utility) Page 695 Installing using the data control function (Utility) By operating the utility, select the system application or project data stored in the data storage and transfer them to the GOT.

Precautions on installing BootOS, system applications Installing both BootOS and system applications After completing BootOS installation, install system applications. When installing BootOS, the built-in flash memory in the GOT is initialized and goes to the status at factory shipment. (All system applications and project data are erased.)

Installation cannot be interrupted. Do not perform any of the following during a BootOS or system application installation. Failure to do so may result in installation failure, causing the GOT malfunction. Powering off the GOT Pressing the reset button of the GOT Removing the data storage If the installation failure and the GOT malfunction occur, take the following action. If BootOS installation failed: Please consult your local Mitsubishi (Electric System) Service center or

representative. If the basic system application installation failed: Page 695 Installing when starting the GOT

BootOS is installed in the GOT at factory shipment. It is not necessary to

install BootOS when not upgrading it.

18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 18.2 Installation Using Data Storage 695

69

Installing when starting the GOT

When installing with an SD card 1. Power OFF the GOT, and install the SD card where the BootOS, system application or project data is stored in the SD

card interface of the GOT.

2. Power on the GOT. While touching the lower right side of the GOT screen, power on the GOT. (1-point press installation function)

3. The BootOS or system application is installed in the built-in flash memory. Do not pull out the SD card or power OFF the GOT.

4. The GOT restarts automatically after the installation is completed.

5. After confirming normal restart, confirm that the SD card access LED is not lit, and remove the SD card from the SD card interface of the GOT.

Installing using the data copy function (Utility)

Operation procedure 1. Power OFF the GOT, and attach the SD card which stores the basic system application and communication driver to the

GOT.

2. While touching the upper left corner of the GOT screen, power ON the GOT.

3. When the screen shown on the left appears, select the [Data copy]. For details of install, refer to the following. Page 609 Data Copy

Touch [Data copy].

6 18 BOOTOS AND SYSTEM APPLICATION 18.2 Installation Using Data Storage

19

19 ERROR MESSAGE LIST Page 697 GOT Error Messages and Corrective Actions

19.1 GOT Error Messages and Corrective Actions The following shows the error messages and corrective actions displayed on the GOT.

Error message Action SCREEN DOES NOT EXIST. Specified base screen does not exist in the project data.

Specified base screen is out of the permissible area. Specify the existing base screen.

SCREEN ERROR The monitored device No. is out of the permissible area of the targeted PLC CPU. Set the device within the range that can be monitored by the monitored PLC CPU and parameter settings.

COMM. ERROR Error occurred while writing in the device. Check the cable omission and the status of the PLC.

DEVICE ERROR. Error occurred while writing in the device. Correct the device.

SET NUMBER IS INCORRECT. The input value was illegal when writing to the device. Check the input value.

PLC IS RUNNING. The operation, which could not be performed during RUN of PLC CPU, was performed. Stop the PLC CPU.

CAN NOT WRITE. The memory cassette installed in the PLC CPU is EPROM or E2PROM, and it is in a protected status. Confirm the memory cassette installed in PLC CPU.

THIS FUNC IS PROTECTED. The key word is set in PLC CPU. Cancel the key word.

CAN NOT USE THE FUNCTION.

The function cannot be used with the package data configuration written in the GOT. Review the package data configuration. Install the latest version of GT Designer3 and write the package data again to the GOT.

DATA IS NOT FOUND. The package data is not downloaded or the package data is not sufficient. Download the package data.

PASSWORD IS INCORRECT. The input password does not match the security level password or the utility start-up password. Check the target password.

Password cannot be changed because you are not logged in.

When authenticating the operator, the password cannot be changed before logging in. Log in.

The password does not match, the GOT cannot be booted.

The passwords for transmitting the data from package data on Drive C and package data directly started from memory card do not match, so the GOT cannot be started. Match the data transmission passwords.

19 ERROR MESSAGE LIST 19.1 GOT Error Messages and Corrective Actions 697

69

Revisions * The manual number is given on the bottom left of the back cover.

Revision date * Manual Number Revision Sep. 2013 SH(NA)-081195ENG-A First printing : GT Designer3 Version1.100E

Nov. 2013 SH(NA)-081195ENG-B Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.104J Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed Abbreviations and generic terms changed Compatible with wireless LAN connection (to be supported soon) Ethernet setting revised

Jan. 2014 SH(NA)-081195ENG-C Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.108N Specifications for IP address duplication changed

Apr. 2014 SH(NA)-081195ENG-D Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.112S Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed Abbreviations and generic terms changed Utility function list changed Functions added to the display setting A function added to the operation log information Error messages added

Jun. 2014 SH(NA)-081195ENG-E Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.117X Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed R motion monitor supported CNC monitor supported CNC data I/O supported CNC machining program edit supported Recipe operation supported Label name resolution information supported Error messages added

Jul. 2014 SH(NA)-081195ENG-F Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.118Y Abbreviations, generic terms, and icon indications changed Display method and list of the system alarm changed

Oct. 2014 SH(NA)-081195ENG-G Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.122C The description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS has been changed. The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT21 is supported. GT2512-S is supported. GT2512-S supports the CNC monitor, CNC data I/O, and CNC machining program edit. The IP filter is supported. System alarms have been added.

Jan. 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-H Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.126G The description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS has been changed. The system launcher is supported. The iQSS utility is supported. The backup/restoration function has been expanded.

Apr. 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-I Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.130L The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. Functions have been added to the operator authentication. The sequence program monitor (R ladder) is supported. The motion program editor is supported. The motion program I/O is supported. System alarms have been added.

May 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-J Writing errors have been corrected.

Jun. 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-K Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.134Q The USB host setting has been changed. The property screen for data management has been changed. System alarms have been added.

Oct. 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-L Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.144A The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The access point mode has been added to the wireless LAN function. The license management for the GOT Mobile function is supported. System alarms have been added.

Dec. 2015 SH(NA)-081195ENG-M Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.150G The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT2512F-S, GT2510F-V, and GT2508F-V are supported. The GOT Mobile information is supported. The file manager is supported.

8

May 2016 SH(NA)-081195ENG-N Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.155M The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT2105-Q, GT2104-PMBDS2, and GT2104-PMBLS are supported. The file menu screen of the multimedia function now displays information on the number of files. The CNC monitor 2 is supported. The drive recorder is supported. System alarms have been added.

Aug. 2016 SH(NA)-081195ENG-O Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.160S The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The ANDON connection is supported. The GOT2000 series Ethernet communication unit (GT25-J71E71-100) is supported. System alarms have been added.

Oct. 2016 SH(NA)-081195ENG-P Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.165X The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT27-V and GT25-V support the CNC monitor 2. The setting to enable or disable the ladder editor (R ladder) has been added for the sequence

program monitor. The CC-Link IE Field Network diagnostics is supported. System alarms have been added.

Jan. 2017 SH(NA)-081195ENG-Q Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.170C GT2107 is supported.

Apr. 2017 SH(NA)-081195ENG-R Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.175H The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT2510-WXTSD, GT2510-WXTBD, GT2507-WTSD, and GT2507-WTBD are supported. The GOT internal device monitor is supported. The USB barcode reader is supported. The operator management function has been extended. System alarms have been added.

Jun. 2017 SH(NA)-081195ENG-S Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.180N The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT2505-V and GT2506HS-V are supported.

Oct. 2017 SH(NA)-081195ENG-T Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.185T The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The sequence program monitor (R ladder) has been renamed the sequence program monitor (iQ-R

ladder). The operator authentication supports the use of sub administrators. The operation log information supports the display type switching. System alarms have been added.

Dec. 2017 SH(NA)-081195ENG-U Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.190Y Saving recipe data to the SRAM user area is supported. The SRAM management function supports recipe data. Corrective actions for system alarms have been added. The device monitor supports R00CPU, R01CPU, and R02CPU.

Apr. 2018 SH(NA)-081195ENG-V Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.195D The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT2506HS-V supports the CNC monitor 2. The servo amplifier graph is supported. GT21 supports the IP filter.

Jul. 2018 SH(NA)-081195ENG-W Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.200J The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. GT27, GT25, and GT23 support Ethernet printers. GT27, GT25, and GT23 support the file print.

Oct. 2018 SH(NA)-081195ENG-X Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.205P Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed. The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The network drive is supported. GT2505-V and GT2505HS-V support the CNC monitor 2. [ClockPhase(Extend)] has been added to the RGB display settings. System alarms have been added.

Jan. 2019 SH(NA)-081195ENG-Y Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.210U The corrective action for a system alarm has been corrected.

Apr. 2019 SH(NA)-081195ENG-Z Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.215Z Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The internal device has been added to the functions of the SRAM management. GT21 supports Ethernet printers. The internal device has been added to the clear data function.

Revision date * Manual Number Revision

699

70

2013 MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION

Jul. 2019 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AA Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.220E Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. CC-Link IE TSN has been added as a communication driver in the communication setting. The corrective action for a system alarm has been corrected.

Oct. 2019 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AB Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.225K The network monitor supports the CC-Link IE TSN connection. The backup/restoration function supports the GOT data package acquisition at the timing of the

trigger backup.

Jan. 2020 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AC Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.230Q The backup/restoration function supports FX5UJ. The R motion SFC monitor is supported. The motion SFC monitor is renamed to Q motion SFC monitor. System alarms have been added.

Apr. 2020 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AD Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.235V The corrective action for a system alarm has been corrected. System alarms have been added. GT27, GT25, and GT23 support the password history settings for the operator authentication. GT27 and GT25 support the vision sensor monitor.

Jun. 2020 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AE Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.240A The abbreviations, generic terms, icon indications have been changed. The company name of TOSHIBA MACHINE CO., LTD. has been changed to SHIBAURA MACHINE

CO., LTD.

Aug. 2020 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AF Partial corrections.

Oct. 2020 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AG Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.245F Ethernet connection with the Hitachi S10VE controller is supported. GT2107-W supports the operation log information.

Jan. 2021 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AH Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.250L Description of SAFETY PRECAUTIONS changed Abbreviations, generic terms, and model icons have been changed. GT2512-WX supports the motion program editor. GT2512-WX supports the motion program I/O.

Apr. 2021 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AI Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.255R The user memory (RAM) size has been added to the displayed items on the GOT information screen. The sequence program monitor (iQ-F ladder) is supported.

Jul. 2021 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AJ Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.260W Changed the name of the direct CPU connection to the direct CPU connection (serial). The corrective action for a system alarm has been corrected.

Oct. 2021 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AK Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.265B The CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field Network diagnostics function is supported. Connection to LS IS PLC XGT is supported. Connection to YASKAWA robot controller YRC1000 is supported.

Apr. 2022 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AL Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.275M Partial corrections.

Jul. 2022 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AM Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.280S System alarms have been added.

Oct. 2022 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AN Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.285X System alarms have been added.

Jan. 2023 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AP Compatible with GT Works3 Version1.290C The name of the communication driver for Ethernet connection to ALLEN-BRADLEY PLC or OMRON

PLC has been changed.

This manual confers no industrial property rights or any rights of any other kind, nor does it confer any patent licenses. Mitsubishi Electric Corporation cannot be held responsible for any problems involving industrial property rights which may occur as a result of using the contents noted in this manual.

Revision date * Manual Number Revision

0

Warranty Please check the following product warranty details before using this product.

If any faults or defects (hereinafter "Failure") found to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi occurs during use of the product within the gratis warranty term, the product shall be repaired at no cost via the sales representative or Mitsubishi Service Company. However, if repairs are required onsite at domestic or overseas location, expenses to send an engineer will be solely at the customer's discretion. Mitsubishi shall not be held responsible for any re-commissioning, maintenance, or testing on-site that involves replacement of the failed module.

The gratis warranty term of the product shall be for thirty-six (36) months after the date of purchase or delivery to a designated place. Note that after manufacture and shipment from Mitsubishi, the maximum distribution period shall be six (6) months, and the longest gratis warranty term after manufacturing shall be forty-two (42) months. The gratis warranty term of repair parts shall not exceed the gratis warranty term before repairs.

Failure occurring from inappropriate storage or handling, carelessness or negligence by the user. Failure caused by the user's hardware or software design.

Failure caused by unapproved modifications, etc., to the product by the user. When the Mitsubishi product is assembled into a user's device, Failure that could have been avoided if functions or structures,

judged as necessary in the legal safety measures the user's device is subject to or as necessary by industry standards, had been provided.

Failure that could have been avoided if consumable parts designated in the instruction manual had been correctly serviced or replaced.

Replacing consumable parts such as a battery, backlight, and fuse. Failure caused by external irresistible forces such as fires or abnormal voltages, and Failure caused by force majeure such as

earthquakes, lightning, wind and water damage. Failure caused by reasons that could not be predicted by scientific technology standards at the time of shipment from

Mitsubishi. Any other failure found not to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi or that admitted not to be so by the user.

(1) Gratis Warranty Term

(2) Gratis Warranty Range (a) The customer shall be responsible for the primary failure diagnosis unless otherwise specified.

If requested by the customer, Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or its representative firm may carry out the primary failure diagnosis at the customers expense. The primary failure diagnosis will, however, be free of charge should the cause of failure be attributable to Mitsubishi Electric Corporation.

(b) The range shall be limited to normal use within the usage state, usage methods, and usage environment, etc., which follow the conditions and precautions, etc., given in the instruction manual, user's manual and caution labels on the product.

(c) Even within the gratis warranty term, repairs shall be charged in the following cases.

Gratis Warranty Term and Gratis Warranty Range

(1) Mitsubishi shall accept onerous product repairs for seven (7) years after production of the product is discontinued. Discontinuation of production shall be notified with Mitsubishi Technical Bulletins, etc.

(2) Mitsubishi shall not accept a request for product supply (including spare parts) after production is discontinued.

Onerous repair term after discontinuation of production

Overseas, repairs shall be accepted by Mitsubishi's local overseas FA Center. Note that the repair conditions at each FA Center may differ.

Overseas service

Regardless of the gratis warranty term, Mitsubishi shall not be liable for compensation to: Exclusion of loss in opportunity and secondary loss from warranty liability

The specifications given in the catalogs, manuals, or technical documents are subject to change without prior notice. Changes in product specifications

(1) In using the Mitsubishi graphic operation terminal, the usage conditions shall be that the application will not lead to a major accident even if any problem or fault should occur in the graphic operation terminal device, and that backup and fail-safe functions are systematically provided outside of the device for any problem or fault.

(2) The Mitsubishi graphic operation terminal has been designed and manufactured for applications in general industries, etc. Thus, applications in which the public could be affected such as in nuclear power plants and other power plants operated by respective power companies, and applications in which a special quality assurance system is required, such as for Railway companies or Public service shall be excluded from the graphic operation terminal applications. In addition, applications in which human life or property could be greatly affected, such as in aircraft, medical, railway applications, incineration and fuel devices, manned transportation equipment, recreation and amusement devices, safety devices, shall also be excluded from the graphic operation terminal. Even for the above applications, however, Mitsubishi Electric Corporation may consider the possibility of an application, provided that the customer notifies Mitsubishi Electric Corporation of the intention, the application is clearly defined and any special quality is not required after the user consults the local Mitsubishi representative

Product application

(1) Damages caused by any cause found not to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi. (2) Loss in opportunity, lost profits incurred to the user by Failures of Mitsubishi products. (3) Special damages and secondary damages whether foreseeable or not, compensation for accidents, and compensation for

damages to products other than Mitsubishi products. (4) Replacement by the user, maintenance of on-site equipment, start-up test run and other tasks.

701

70

Intellectual Property Rights Trademarks MELDAS, MELSEC, iQ Platform, MELSOFT, GOT, CC-Link, CC-Link/LT, and CC-Link IE are trademarks or registered trademarks of Mitsubishi Electric Corporation in Japan and other countries. Microsoft, Microsoft Access, Excel, SQL Server, Visual Basic, Visual C++, Visual C#, Windows, Windows NT, Windows Server, and Windows Vista are trademarks of the Microsoft group of companies. MODBUS is a trademark of Schneider Electric SA. DeviceNet is a trademark of ODVA (Open DeviceNet Vendor Association, Inc.). VNC is a registered trademark of RealVNC Ltd. in the United States and other countries. Unicode is a trademark or registered trademark of Unicode, Inc. in the United States and other countries. PictBridge is a registered trademark of Canon Inc. Adobe and Adobe Reader are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated. Oracle and JavaScript are registered trademarks of Oracle Corporation and/or its affiliates in the United States and other countries. QR Code is a trademark or registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED in Japan, the United States, and/or other countries. Anybus is a registered trademark of HMS Industrial Networks AB. Android and Google Chrome are trademarks or registered trademarks of Google Inc. IOS is a trademark or registered trademark of Cisco in the U.S. and other countries and is used under license. Safari and iPhone are trademarks of Apple Inc. registered in the United States and other countries. The iPhone trademark is used under license from AIPHONE CO., LTD. Intel and Intel Core are trademarks or registered trademarks of Intel Corporation in the United States and other countries. Other company and product names herein are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners. Copyrights The screens (screenshots) are used in accordance with the Microsoft Corporation guideline.

2 SH(NA)-081195ENG-AP

SH(NA)-081195ENG-AP(2301)MEE MODEL: GOT2000-U-UTILITY-E MODEL CODE: 1D7MJ6

Specifications subject to change without notice.

When exported from Japan, this manual does not require application to the Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry for service transaction permission.

HEAD OFFICE : TOKYO

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the GOT2000 Mitsubishi works, you can view and download the Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the User's Manual for Mitsubishi GOT2000 as well as other Mitsubishi manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The User's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Mitsubishi GOT2000. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Mitsubishi GOT2000 GT23 Utility User's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.